F
I
O
A
W
T
N
E
D
R
U
H
A
C
N
D
A
B
O
T
O
K
O
This Owner Handbook is intended to show the vehicle's operating conditions.
For the enthusiast user who wants to have insights, curiosities and detailed information about the characteristics and functions
of the vehicle, Fiat Professional gives the opportunity to consult a dedicated section which is available in electronic format.
ONLINE VEHICLE OWNER HANDBOOK
The following symbol
is reported within the text of the Owner Handbook, next to the subjects for which details are provided.
Go to the www.mopar.eu/owner website and access your personal area.
The “Maintenance and care” page includes all the information about your vehicle and the link to access eLUM, where you will find
all the details of the Owner Handbook.
Alternatively, to access this information, go to the Internet website at http://aftersales.fiat.com/elum/.
The eLUM website is free and will allow you, among many other things, to easily consult the on-board documents
of all the other vehicles of the Group.
Have a nice reading and happy motoring!
Dear Customer,
We would like to congratulate and thank you for choosing a Fiat Ducato.
We have written this handbook to help you get to know all the features of your vehicle and use it in the best possible way.
Here you will find information, advice and important warnings regarding vehicle use and how to achieve the best performance
from the technical features of your Fiat Ducato.
You are advised to read it right through before taking to the road for the first time, to become familiar with the controls and
above all with those concerning brakes, steering and gearbox; at the same time, you can understand the vehicle behaviour on
different road surfaces.
This document also provides a description of special features and tips, as well as essential information for the safe driving, care
and servicing of your Fiat Ducato over time.
After reading it, you are advised to keep the handbook inside the vehicle, for an easy reference and for making sure it remains
on board the vehicle should it be sold.
In the attached Warranty Booklet you will also find a description of the Services that Fiat offers to its customers, the Warranty
Certificate and the detail of the terms and conditions for maintaining its validity.
We are sure that these will help you to get in touch with and appreciate your new vehicle and the service provided by the people
at Fiat.
Enjoy reading. Happy motoring!
IMPORTANT
This Owner Handbook describes all Fiat Ducato versions. As a consequence, you should only consider the
information related to the trim level, engine and version that you have purchased. All data contained in this
publication are purely indicative. FCA Italy S.p.A. can modify the specifications of the vehicle model described in
this publication at any time, for technical or marketing purposes. For further information, contact a Fiat Dealership.
READ THIS CAREFULLY
REFUELLING
Only refuel with automotive diesel conforming to the European specification EN590. The use of other products or mixtures
may damage the engine beyond repair and consequently invalidate the warranty, due to the damage caused.
STARTING THE ENGINE
Make sure that the handbrake is engaged; set the gear lever to neutral; fully depress the clutch pedal without pressing the
accelerator, then turn the ignition key to MAR and wait for the warning lights
and
to switch off; turn the ignition key to
AVV and release it as soon as the engine has started.
PARKING ON FLAMMABLE MATERIAL
The catalytic converter develops high temperatures during operation. Do not park on grass, dry leaves, pine needles or other
flammable material: fire hazard.
RESPECTING THE ENVIRONMENT
The vehicle is fitted with a system that allows continuous diagnosis of the emission-related components in order to help
protect the environment.
ELECTRICAL ACCESSORIES
If, after buying the vehicle, you decide to add electrical accessories (with the risk of gradually draining the battery), visit a
Fiat Dealership. They can calculate the overall electrical requirement and check that the electrical system of the vehicle can
support the required load.
SCHEDULED SERVICING
Correct maintenance enables the vehicle to perfectly maintain performance and safety characteristics, its environmental
friendliness and low running costs over time.
THE OWNER HANDBOOK CONTAINS...
... important information, advice and warnings for correct use, driving safety and maintenance of your vehicle over time.
Particular attention should be paid to information marked with the following symbols: (personal safety), (environmental
protection), (vehicle integrity).
USE OF THE OWNER HANDBOOK
OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS
Each time direction instructions (left/right or forwards/backwards) about the vehicle are given, these must be intended as
regarding an occupant in the driver's seat. Special cases not complying with this rule will be specified as appropriate in the text.
The figures in the Owner Handbook are provided by way of example only: this might imply that some details of the image do
not correspond to the actual arrangement of your vehicle. In addition, the Handbook has been conceived considering vehicles
with steering wheel on the left side; it is therefore possible that on vehicles with steering wheel on the right side, the position or
construction of some controls is not exactly mirror-like with respect to the figure.
To identify the chapter with the information needed you can consult the index at the end of this Owner Handbook.
Chapters can be rapidly identified with dedicated graphic tabs, at the side of each odd page. A few pages further there is a
key for getting to know the chapter order and the relevant symbols in the tabs. There is in any case a textual indication of the
current chapter at the side of each even page.
WARNINGS AND PRECAUTIONS
While reading this Owner Handbook you will find a series of WARNINGS to prevent procedures that could damage your
vehicle.
There are also PRECAUTIONS that must be carefully followed to prevent incorrect use of the components of the vehicle, which
could cause accidents or injuries.
Therefore all WARNINGS and PRECAUTIONS must always be carefully followed.
WARNINGS and PRECAUTIONS are recalled in the text with the following symbols:
personal safety;
vehicle integrity;
environmental protection.
NOTE These symbols, when necessary, are indicated besides the title or at the end of the line and are followed by a number.
That number recalls the corresponding warning at the end of the relevant section.
SYMBOLS
Some vehicle components have coloured labels whose symbols indicate precautions to be observed when using this
component.
A plate summarising these symbols can also be found under the bonnet.
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING Any modification or alteration of the vehicle might seriously affect its safety and road holding, thus causing accidents,
in which the occupants could even be fatally injured.
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
SAFETY
STARTING AND DRIVING
IN AN EMERGENCY
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
MULTIMEDIA
CONTENTS
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
In-depth knowledge of your new
vehicle starts here.
The handbook that you are reading
simply and directly explains how it is
made and how it works.
That’s why we advise you to read it
seated comfortably on board, so that
you can see what is described here for
yourself.
THE FIAT CODE SYSTEM ............... 8
THE KEYS..................................... 8
IGNITION DEVICE .......................... 9
ELECTRONIC ALARM................... 10
DOORS ...................................... 11
SEATS........................................ 16
STEERING WHEEL....................... 23
REAR-VIEW MIRRORS ................. 24
EXTERIOR LIGHTS ....................... 25
HEADLIGHTS .............................. 29
CEILING LIGHTS.......................... 29
CONTROLS ................................ 30
WINDOW WASHING .................... 33
HEATING AND VENTILATION ........ 35
HEATING AND VENTILATION
CONTROLS ................................ 36
MANUAL CLIMATE CONTROL
SYSTEM ..................................... 36
AUTOMATIC CLIMATE
CONTROL SYSTEM ..................... 37
ADDITIONAL HEATER .................. 38
INDEPENDENT ADDITIONAL
HEATER ..................................... 38
ELECTRIC WINDOWS .................. 42
BONNET..................................... 42
HEAD RESTRAINTS ..................... 43
INTERIOR FITTINGS ..................... 44
TACHOGRAPH ............................ 45
SELF-LEVELLING AIR
SUSPENSION.............................. 46
ACCESSORIES PURCHASED BY
THE OWNER ............................... 47
7
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
THE FIAT CODE
SYSTEM
IN BRIEF
This is an electrical engine locking
system which increases protection
against attempted theft of the vehicle.
It is automatically activated when the
ignition key is removed.
Each key contains an electronic
device which modulates the signal
emitted during ignition by an aerial
built into the ignition device. The
signal, which changes each time the
engine is started, is the "password",
by means of which the control unit
recognises the key and enables
starting.
1)
Operation
Each time the vehicle is started turning
the ignition key to MAR, the Fiat CODE
system control unit sends a recognition
code to the engine control module to
deactivate the immobiliser.
The code is sent only if the Fiat CODE
system control unit has recognised the
code transmitted from the key.
Each time the ignition key is turned
to STOP, the Fiat CODE system
8
deactivates the functions of the engine
control module.
Irregular operation
If the code has not been recognised
correctly during starting, the
symbol
or warning light on the instrument
panel turns on accompanied by the
corresponding message on the display
(see the explanations in the “Warning
lights and messages" chapter).
In this case, turn the key to STOP and
then to MAR; if it is still locked, try
again with the other keys that come
with the car. Contact a Fiat Dealership
if you still cannot start the engine.
WARNING Each key has its own code
which must be stored by the system's
control unit. Contact a Fiat Dealership
to have new keys (up to 8) stored with
a code.
symbol
Activation of
or warning light while
driving
If the
symbol or warning light
switches on, this means that the
system is running a self-diagnosis (for
example due to a voltage drop).
If the
symbol or warning light
stays on, contact a Fiat Dealership.
IMPORTANT
1) The electronic components inside
the key may be damaged if the key is
subjected to strong shocks. In order
to ensure complete efficiency of the
electronic devices inside the key, it should
never be exposed to direct sunlight.
THE KEYS
MECHANICAL KEY
The metal part (A) fig. 1 of the key is
fixed.
The key operates:
the ignition device;
the door lock;
opening and closing of the fuel tank
cap.
1
F1A0008
KEY WITH REMOTE
CONTROL
The metal insert (A) fig. 2 is retractable
and operates:
the ignition device;
the door lock;
opening and closing of the fuel tank
cap.
To extract/retract the metal insert,
press the (B)fig. 2 button.
WARNING
1) Button (B) should only be pressed when
the key is away from the body, in particular
from the eyes and from objects that can
be spoilt (e.g. clothes). Do not leave the
key unattended to avoid the button being
accidentally pressed while it is being
handled, e.g. by a child.
IMPORTANT
1) Used batteries are harmful to the
environment. You can dispose of them
either in the correct containers as
specified by law or by taking them to a
Fiat Dealership, which will deal with their
disposal.
2
IGNITION DEVICE
The key can be turned to 3 different
positions fig. 3:
STOP: engine off, key can be
extracted, steering locked. Some
electrical devices (e.g. sound system,
central door locking system, etc.) can
operate;
MAR: driving position. All electrical
devices are enabled;
AVV: engine starting (unstable
position).
F1A0004
Button
is used for unlocking the
front doors.
Button
locks all the doors.
Button
is used for unlocking the
load compartment doors.
1)
When the doors are locked, if one or
more doors are not closed correctly,
the LED and direction indicators start
flashing quickly.
3
F1A0009
The ignition device is fitted with an
electronic safety system that requires
the ignition key to be turned back to
STOP if the engine does not start,
before the starting operation can be
repeated.
2) 3) 4) 5)
1)
9
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
STEERING LOCK
Activation
When the device is at STOP, remove
the key and turn the steering wheel
until it locks.
Deactivation
Move the steering wheel slightly as you
turn the ignition key to MAR-ON
Extracting the ignition key
for versions with automatic
transmission
The ignition key can be removed only if
the gear lever is in position P.
If the engine is switched off with the
gear lever in position P; move the lever
to P within 5 seconds. Then it will
be possible to remove the ignition
key for about 30 seconds. If the
described conditions and times are
not respected, the ignition key will be
automatically locked.
To remove the ignition key, turn it to
MAR and then to STOP repeating the
procedure described above.
WARNING
2) If the ignition device has been tampered
with (e.g. attempted theft), have it checked
over by a Fiat Dealership before driving
again.
10
3) Always remove the key when you
leave your vehicle to prevent someone
from accidentally operating the controls.
Remember to engage the handbrake.
Engage first gear if the vehicle is parked
uphill or reverse gear if the vehicle is
parked downhill. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
4) Never extract the key while the vehicle
is moving. The steering wheel will
automatically lock as soon as it is turned.
This also applies to cases in which the
vehicle is towed.
5) It is absolutely forbidden to carry
out any aftermarket operation involving
steering system or steering column
modifications (e.g. installation of anti-theft
device) that could adversely affect
performance, invalidate the warranty,
cause serious safety problems and
also result in the vehicle not meeting
type-approval requirements.
ELECTRONIC ALARM
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The alarm, in addition to all the remote
control functions described previously,
is controlled by the receiver located
under the dashboard near the fuse
box.
Activation
With the doors and bonnet closed and
the ignition key either turned to STOP
or removed, point the key with the
remote control towards the vehicle and
press and release the lock button.
Excluding some markets, the system
produces an acoustic signal (beep) and
enables door locking.
The switching on of the alarm is
preceded by an self-diagnosis stage:
if a fault is detected, the system
produces another acoustic signal.
In this case, turn the alarm off by
pressing the "release doors/release
load compartment" button, check that
the doors and bonnet are properly
closed and turn the alarm back on by
pressing the lock button.
If a door or the bonnet is not properly
shut, it will be excluded from the testing
by the alarm system.
If the alarm produces an acoustic
signal even when the doors and
bonnet are correctly closed, a fault
has occurred in the operation of the
system. Contact a Fiat Dealership.
WARNING The alarm does not come
on when the central locking is activated
using the metal insert in the key.
WARNING The alarm is adapted to
meet requirements in various countries.
Deactivation
Press the door release/load
compartment release button on the key
with remote control.
The following operations are performed
(excluding some markets):
direction indicators flash twice;
there are two short acoustic signals
(beeps);
doors are unlocked.
WARNING The alarm does not
switch off when the central opening is
activated using the metal insert in the
key.
Disabling
To permanently disable the alarm (e.g.
during a long period of inactivity),
simply lock the vehicle by turning the
metal insert of the key with remote
control in the lock.
WARNING If the batteries of the key
with the remote control run out or the
system fails, the alarm can be switched
off by placing the key in the ignition
switch and turning it to MAR.
DOORS
DOOR CENTRAL
LOCKING/UNLOCKING
Locking from the outside
With the doors shut, press button
on the remote control fig. 4 - fig. 5 or
insert the metal insert (A) in the lock
of the door on the driver's side and
turn it clockwise. The doors will only be
locked if all doors are shut.
To extract the metal insert, press the
button (B).
If one or more of the doors is open
after the button
on the remote
control is pressed, the direction
indicators and the LED in the button
(A) fig. 7 will flash quickly for about 3
seconds. With the function on, the
button (A) fig. 7 is disabled.
on the remote
Pressing button
control twice in quick succession to
activate the dead lock device (see the
"Dead lock device" paragraph).
4
F1A0112
5
F1A0113
Door unlocking from the outside
Briefly press button
fig. 4 or
fig. 5, according to the version, to
remotely unlock the front doors, switch
on the roof lights in a timed manner
and flash the direction indicators.
11
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
will be locked only if all the doors are
properly shut.
6
F1A0114
Turn the metal insert anticlockwise
fig. 6 in the driver's side door lock to
unlock all the doors. With the battery
disconnected, access to the vehicle
will only be possible by unlocking the
driver's door using the mechanical
lock.
Locking/unlocking doors from the
inside
Press the button (A) fig. 7 to lock the
doors and press it again to unlock
them. Locking / unlocking is centralised
(front and rear).
When the doors are locked, the LED in
button (A) is on and, when the button
is pressed again, all the doors are
centrally unlocked and the warning light
is switched off.
When the doors are unlocked, the LED
is off and pressing the button again
centrally locks all the doors. The doors
12
7
F1A0303
Following the locking of the doors
using:
remote control
door pawl
it will not be possible to unlock using
the button (A) fig. 7 on the dashboard.
WARNING With the central locking on,
pulling the opening lever for one of the
front doors causes the central locking
to be switched off. Individual doors can
be unlocked by pulling the opening
handle of one of the rear doors.
If a power supply is not present (blown
fuse, battery disconnected, etc.) it is,
however, possible to lock the doors
manually.
After exceeding 20 km/h, all the
doors will be locked automatically
if the Setup menu function has been
selected (see explanations in "Knowing
the instrument panel" sector of the
“Multifunction display" paragraph).
MECHANICAL LOCK OF
PASSENGER SIDE CAB
DOOR
This is a device which allows the
passenger side cab door to be locked
mechanically, to prevent it from
being opened from the outside, if no
power supply is available (battery
disconnected).
The device in fig. 8 can be engaged
only with the passenger side cab door
open.
Proceed as follows:
Insert the key in device (A) and move
it upward as shown to lock the door
fig. 8.
Close the door.
Check that the door has locked by
trying the outside handle.
To unlock the device, operate the
inside handle of the passenger side cab
door or, if battery power has been
restored, press button
or
(per
versions/markets where it is provided)
on the key with remote control.
A
8
F1A0494
LOCKING/UNLOCKING
THE LOAD
COMPARTMENT
The activation of the locking is signalled
by the LED in the button.
The LED comes on in the following
cases:
after each door lock command
generated by the button (D) fig. 9 or by
in the dashboard;
button
when the instrument panel is
activated;
upon opening of one of the front
doors;
when the door is locked at 20 km/h
(if activated from the menu).
The lock is turned off when one of the
load compartment doors is opened
or on a door release request (load
compartment or centralised) or an
unlocking request from the remote
control/door catch.
9
F1A0116
DEAD LOCK DEVICE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
It is a safety device that disables
operation of the interior handles.
Press the lock/unlock button (A) fig. 7
to prevent opening the doors from
inside the passenger compartment in
the event of an attempted break-in (e.g.
when a window is broken).
The dead lock device therefore offers
the best possible protection against
break in attempts. We recommend
engaging it whenever the vehicle is
parked and left unattended.
among the dashboard controls flashes
to indicate that the device has been
turned on.
If one or more of the doors is not
perfectly shut, the dead lock device
will not be activated, thus preventing a
person getting into the vehicle through
the open door and, on shutting, it,
remaining stuck inside the passenger
compartment.
Device deactivation
The system is disabled automatically on
every door in the following cases:
if the mechanical key is turned to the
opening position in the driver's door;
by unlocking the doors using the
remote control;
by turning the ignition key to the
MAR position.
SLIDING SIDE DOOR
7) 8)
To open the sliding side door, lift the
handle (A) fig. 10 and accompany the
door in the opening direction.
6)
Device activation
The dead lock device is automatically
activated on every door with two short
presses on the button
on the key
with remote control fig. 4.
The direction indicators flash 3 times
and the LED on the button (A) fig. 7
13
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
10
F1A0117
The sliding side door is equipped with a
stop that prevents it sliding beyond the
end of its travel when opening.
To close, operate the exterior handle
(A) (or the corresponding interior
handle) and push to closed.
In any case, make sure that the door
is correctly attached to the device that
holds it fully open.
To ensure that the sliding side door
always operates correctly during the
winter (at low temperatures), lubricate
the gasket thoroughly: contact the Fiat
Service Network.
CHILD SAFETY DEVICE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
This system prevents the sliding side
doors being opened from the inside.
The device fig. 11 can be engaged only
with the sliding side door open:
(1) position - Device not engaged
(door may be opened from the inside).
(2) position - Device engaged (door
locked)
12
F1A0120
Manual opening of the first swing
door from the inside
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Pull the lever (B) fig. 13 in the direction
indicated by the arrow.
11
F1A0143
The device stays on even if the doors
are electrically unlocked.
Manual closure of the first swing
door from the outside
Turn the key clockwise or press the
button
on the key with remote
control. Close the left door first,
followed by the right door.
9)
DOUBLE REAR SWING
DOOR
10) 11)
Manual opening of the first swing
door from the outside
Turn the key anticlockwise fig. 6 or
press the
button on the remote
control and turn handle (A) fig. 12 in the
direction of the arrow.
14
13
F1A0121
Manual opening of the second
swing door
Pull the lever (C) fig. 14 in the direction
indicated by the arrow.
The double rear swing doors have two
opening positions: the first to an angle
of approximately 90° and the second
is approximately 180°; on some trim
versions/markets 270° opening is also
available.
To open the swing doors to 180°,
or 270° (for versions/markets where
provided), proceed as follows:
reach the 90° door opening position;
keep pulling the door to press a
force to allow them to open to 180°
or to 270° (for versions/markets where
provided).
fig. 15 on the electric window control
panel.
REAR FOOTBOARD
(for goods carrier van versions)
12) 13) 14) 15) 16)
2)
15
F1A0123
MOVING FOOTBOARD
(for versions/markets, where provided)
When the side door of the passenger
compartment or luggage compartment
is opened, a footboard emerges from
the lower part of the floorpan fig. 16 to
make it easier to board the vehicle.
The vehicle can be equipped with a
rear retractable footboard (A) fig. 17,
which aids climbing into and out of the
rear load compartment.
The footboard can slide under the
vehicle when not used so as not
to increase the vehicle external
dimensions.
The footboard slides manually both
when opening and closing.
12) 13) 14) 15) 16)
2)
17
F1A0410
WARNING
14
F1A0122
Electric locking from inside
Close the two rear swing doors (first
left, then right) and press the button (D)
16
F1A0119
6) Once the dead lock device is engaged
it is impossible to open the doors from
inside the vehicle. Before engaging the
system please therefore check that there
is no-one left on board. If the remote
control battery is flat, the system can be
15
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
16
disengaged only by inserting the key
metal insert in either of the door locks as
described previously: in this case the
device remains active only for the rear
doors.
7) Before leaving the vehicle parked with
sliding doors open, always check that the
latch is engaged.
8) Do not move the vehicle with side doors
open.
9) Always use this device when carrying
children.
10) This spring loaded system has
activation forces that were designed for
optimum comfort. Accidental knocks
or a strong gust of wind may release
the springs and let the doors close
spontaneously.
11) With the doors opened to 180 degrees
and 270 degrees, no locking system is
effective. Do not use this opening with the
vehicle parked on a gradient or when it is
windy.
12) It is forbidden to drive the vehicle with
the footboard open.
13) Do not use the retracted footboard for
getting up or down the load compartment.
14) Make sure that the footboard is
suitably locked by the provided retaining
systems before, after and during its use.
An incomplete opening or closing might
cause an improper movement of the
footboard with risks arising for the operator
and external users.
15) Before setting off after parking or
before moving the vehicle in any way,
ensure the footboard is fully stowed away.
Because the movement of the footboard is
controlled by that of the sliding side door,
incomplete stowing of the footboard or
non-closure of the rear doors is indicated
on the
by the lighting of a warning light
instrument panel.
16) The footboard lightly projects from the
vehicle even if retracted; therefore, when
rear parking sensors are provided, their
operating range is lightly reduced.
IMPORTANT
2) The footboard presence may reduce
the ramp approach angles; it is therefore
recommended, in case of a very steep
ramp, to be very careful in order not to
damage the footboard.
SEATS
17)
3)
Longitudinal adjustment
Lift lever (A) fig. 18 and push the seat
forwards or backwards: in the driving
position, you should be able to rest
your arms on the rim of the steering
wheel.
18)
18
F1A0021
Height adjustment
To raise the seat: while seated, move
the lever (B) fig. 18 (front part of the
seat) or the lever (C) fig. 18 (rear part
of the seat) upwards and lift your body
weight off the part of the seat that must
be raised.
To lower the seat: while seated,
move the lever (B) (front part of the
seat) or the lever (C) (rear part of the
seat) upwards and press your body
weight off the part of the seat that must
be lowered.
Backrest angle adjustment
Turn knob (D) fig. 18.
19)
Lumbar adjustment
Operate the knob (E) fig. 19 to adjust.
SEAT WITH REVOLVING
BASE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
It may be turned through 180° toward
the seat on the opposite side. Operate
the control (A) fig. 22 to turn the seat.
Before turning the seat, it must be
moved forward and only then adjusted
longitudinally fig. 23.
19
F1A0022
SPRUNG SEAT
The seat is equipped with a mechanical
spring system and hydraulic shock
absorber to ensure maximum comfort
and safety. The system of springs also
effectively absorbs impact from uneven
road surfaces.
See the description in the "Seats"
paragraph for forwards/backwards
adjustments, height adjustments,
backrest adjustment, lumbar
adjustment and armrest adjustment.
Ballast weight adjustment
Use the knob (A) fig. 20 to set the
desired adjustment according to your
body weight, in the range 40 kg to 130
kg.
20
F1A0023
SEATS WITH
ADJUSTABLE ARMRESTS
The driver's seat may be equipped
with an armrest that can be raised and
adjusted for height. Operate the wheel
(A) fig. 21 to adjust.
20) 21)
22
21
F1A0025
F1A0024
1
23
2
F1A0026
17
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
REVOLVING SEAT WITH
SEAT BELT
(for versions/markets, where provided)
It is equipped with a three-point seat
belt fig. 24, two adjustable armrests (for
their adjustment, see the "Seats with
adjustable armrests" paragraph) and
a head restraint with adjustable height
(adjusting it, see the "head restraints"
paragraph).
22)
Height adjustment
Operate the controls (B) fig. 25 or (C)
fig. 25 to raise or lower the front/rear
part of the seat, respectively.
Seat rotation
It may be turned through 180° toward
the seat on the opposite side and
approximately 35° toward the door. It
may be locked in driving position or at
180°.
Operate the lever (D) fig. 26 (located
on the right side of the seat) to turn the
seat.
Before turning the seat, it must be
moved forward and only then adjusted
longitudinally fig. 23.
23)
24
F1A0027
Backrest angle adjustment
Operate the lever (A) fig. 25.
26
25
18
F1A0028
F1A0029
Heated seats
(for versions/markets, where provided)
With the key turned to MAR, press
button (E) fig. 27 to switch the function
on/off.
27
F1A0030
CAPTAIN CHAIR
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The vehicle may be equipped with the
Captain Chair fig. 28, which, depending
on the version, may have various
adjustments (revolving or fixed, with
seat belt, etc.).
For the various adjustments refer to the
explanations in the "Revolving seat with
seat belt" paragraph above.
FLAP ON BENCH
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The seat is equipped with a fold-down
flap that can be used as a document
support surface. To use, pull the tab
(A) fig. 29 and lower the flap. The flap is
equipped with two cup holder indents
and a support surface with a paper
holder clip.
CARGO SPACE
(For versions/markets, where provided)
Depending on the version, you
can request an additional load
compartment fig. 30 located behind the
cab.
31
28
F1A0345
30
29
F1A0031
F1A0041
TRAY UNDER THE SEAT
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Under the driver's seat, there is a tray
(A) fig. 31, which can be easily removed
by sliding it out of the clips on the
support base.
F1A0032
SEAT BASE PLASTIC
COVERS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The front trim (A) fig. 32 can be opened
by using the release handle (B) fig. 32
at the top.
This gives access to the tray under
the seat (see "Tray under the seat"
paragraph).
To make it easier to open the
front cover and gain access to the
compartment, the seat must be as far
back as possible.
To allow removal of the front cover,
it must be turned as far forward as
possible and withdrawn from the hooks
on the lower side by pulling toward the
front of the vehicle.
24)
19
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
When the seat is restored to its normal
position, it engages with the retaining
device without the need to operate the
lever again.
On the one-piece Panorama seat in the
second row both side seats are fixed.
32
F1A0033
PANORAMA VERSIONS
Adjustment of passenger seat
reclining backrest
Turn knob (A) fig. 33.
Folding middle seat backrest (2nd 3rd row)
Lift the lever (C) fig. 33 and tilt the
backrest forward.
A hard surface on the back of the
middle seat is for use as an armrest
and table with cup holders.
Operate the lever to reposition the
backrest.
To lower the backrest of the middle
seat in the second row, remove the
head restraint to make it easier to
adjust the backrest of the middle seat
in the first row.
COMBI VERSIONS
Easy Entry position
Lift the lever (A) fig. 34 and tilt the
backrest forward.
33
34
F1A0035
Stacked position
Proceed as follows:
remove the head restraints from the
easy entry position;
lift the lever (B) fig. 35 (located under
the lever (A) fig. 34) with your right
hand;
turn the backrest by 5° towards the
rear area;
fold forward the backrest with your
left hand.
25)
F1A0034
Access to second row seats
To access the second row of seats,
operate the lever (B) fig. 33 on the right
outside seat in the first row and tilt the
backrest forward, accompanying it with
your left hand.
35
20
F1A0036
Removing the bench
WARNING At least two people are
needed to remove the bench.
Proceed as follows to remove the
bench:
from the stacked position, operate
the levers (C) and (D) fig. 36, rotating
them forward (as specified on
the adhesive label on the lower
crossmember);
lift seat base forward;
bring the seat to an upright position;
from the upright position, operate the
levers (E) and (F) fig. 37 turning them
upwards;
raise the bench from the floor and
remove it.
26)
36
37
F1A0038
FLEX FLOOR REAR SEAT
To release the seat, proceed as
follows:
operate the rear release lever (A)
fig. 38 to aid releasing the safety catch
underneath it (movement (1));
pull the black knob (B) fig. 38
(movement (2));
lift the lever (A) (movement (3)), over
the retaining slider (C) fig. 39 (on the
side) which holds the system in raised
position during the operations.
39
F1A0389
When the base has been locked, it
will be possible to move the seat by
accompanying it with both hands to
move it forwards or backwards fig. 40.
It will also be possible to disassemble
it by pulling it at the points in which
its catches are free with respect to
the holes in the tracks; in that position
(easily found by sliding the base a little
and simultaneously pulling it out) the
seat can easily be removed fig. 41.
F1A0037
40
38
F1A0390
F1A0388
21
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
not happen, check that the seat is in
the exact locking position in relation
to the rail (moving the seat backwards
or forwards a few millimetres until it is
properly attached).
41
F1A0391
After the sliding and removal
operations, the seat should be refitted
and secured to the rails on the floor
before driving, as follows:
fit the base on the rails;
push the latch lever downwards
fig. 42 with sufficient force, until the
system locks.
42
F1A0392
WARNING The locking system is only
secured when the safety clip under the
lever locks it horizontally. If this does
22
Once the quick-release base is locked
in position, it will be as in the first
stage, in other words with the retaining
lever perfectly parallel to the floor
guaranteeing that the seat is securely
fastened in the selected position.
The seat can be turned 180º toward
the seat on the opposite side. To turn
it, see the "Seat with revolving base"
paragraph.
4-SEATER BENCH
SEAT (Crew Cab Van
versions)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
For specific versions, the vehicle
features a 4-seater rear bench seat.
The bench has a bottle holder cavity at
the side (A) fig. 43.
The seat can be tilted manually to
allow access to the load compartment
fig. 44.
43
F1A0393
44
F1A0394
WARNING
17) All adjustments must be made with the
vehicle stationary.
18) After releasing the adjustment lever,
always check that the seat is locked on
the guides by trying to move it back and
forth. If it is not locked, the seat may move
unexpectedly and make you lose control of
the vehicle.
19) For maximum safety, keep the
backrest upright, lean back into it and
make sure the seat belt fits closely across
your chest and pelvis.
20) Before putting on the seat belt, ensure
that the armrests are vertical (see "Seat
belts" paragraph).
21) Before unfastening the belts and
getting out of the vehicle, ensure that the
outer armrest (door side) is fully raised.
22) All adjustments must be made with
the vehicle stationary. In particular, while
turning the seat, take care that it does not
interfere with the handbrake lever.
23) Ensure the seat is locked in driving
position before starting up the vehicle.
24) Do not place heavy loads on the
flap with the vehicle in motion because
they could be thrown against the vehicle
occupants in the event of sudden braking
or impacts, causing severe injury.
25) Do not travel with passengers seated
in the 3rd row with the 2nd row bench
folded over. Do not place objects of any
type on the backrest of the 2nd row bench
folded over: in the event of impact or sharp
braking they could be thrown against the
occupants of the vehicle casing serious
injury. For more information, see the
contents of the adhesive plate located
under the bench.
26) When refitting the bench, ensure that it
is correctly locked to the floor guides.
IMPORTANT
3) The fabric upholstery of your vehicle is
designed to withstand the normal wear
and tear of your vehicle for a long time.
You are however recommended to avoid
strong and/or continuous scratching
with clothing accessories such as metal
buckles, studs, Velcro fastenings and
the like, as these items cause stress of
the cover fabric that could lead to yarn
breaking and damage the upholstery.
STEERING WHEEL
The steering wheel position can be
adjusted axially.
To adjust, proceed as follows:
release the lever fig. 45 by pulling it
towards the steering wheel (position
(2));
adjust the steering wheel;
release lever by pushing it forwards
(position (1)).
27) 28)
45
F1A0040
WARNING
27) All adjustments must be carried out
only with the vehicle stationary and the
engine off.
28) It is absolutely forbidden to carry
out any aftermarket operation involving
steering system or steering column
modifications (e.g. installation of anti-theft
device) that could adversely affect
performance, invalidate the warranty,
cause serious safety problems and
also result in the vehicle not meeting
type-approval requirements.
23
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
REAR-VIEW
MIRRORS
INTERIOR MIRROR
Lever (A) fig. 46 can be used to move
the mirror to two different positions:
normal or anti-glare.
48
46
F1A0353
DOOR MIRRORS
Mirrors with manual adjustment
To adjust the mirrors, manually operate
on each of the two glasses of each
mirror.
29)
Power Mirrors
The electrical adjustment can only be
carried out with the ignition key in the
MAR position.
To adjust the mirrors, turn knob (B)
fig. 47 to one of the four positions:
(1) left mirror, (2) right mirror, (3) left
wide angle and (4) right wide angle
(positions (3) and (4) available on short
24
arm external rear-view mirrors, Tempo
Libero versions and on all medium and
long arm rear-view mirrors).
After rotating the knob (B) on the mirror
to be adjusted, move it in the direction
shown by the arrows to adjust the
selected glass.
47
F1A0042
Mirror folding with manual
adjustment
When required (for example when
the mirror causes difficulty in narrow
spaces or during an automatic vehicle
wash) it is possible to fold the mirrors
manually moving them from position (1)
to position (2) fig. 48.
If the mirror has been accidentally
rotated forwards (position (3)), for
example due to an impact, it must be
manually returned to position (1).
30)
F1A0043
Mirror folding with electrical
adjustment
(for versions/markets, where provided)
When required (for example when
the mirror causes difficulty in narrow
spaces or during an automatic vehicle
wash) it is possible to fold the mirrors
either electrically or manually moving
them from position (1) to position (2)
fig. 48.
49
F1A0044
Electric folding
To fold the mirrors electrically, press
rocker button (A) fig. 49 in point (2) . To
bring the mirrors back to open position,
press point (1) of the button.
WARNING If the mirrors are folded
electrically, they should be returned to
the open position electrically: do not try
to return the mirrors manually to driving
position.
Manual folding
To fold the mirrors manually, move
them from position (1) fig. 48 to
position (2). If the mirrors have been
folded manually, they can be returned
to the opening position both manually
and electrically.
WARNING To take the mirrors
electrically to the opening position,
press point (2) of the rocker button (A)
fig. 49 until you hear an engagement
"click", then press again point (1) of the
button.
Folding forwards
The mirrors can be manually folded
forwards (position (3) fig. 48) or brought
to the opening position (2) again
manually if they have been accidentally
rotated forwards (for example due to an
impact).
If the mirrors have been rotated
forwards manually or due to an impact,
they can be returned to the opening
position both manually and electrically.
To take the mirrors electrically to the
opening position, press point (2) of
the rocker button (A) fig. 49 until you
hear an engagement "click", then press
again point (1) of the button.
WARNING If the mirrors have been
manually folded by mistake to position
(3) fig. 48, the mirror moves to an
intermediate position.In this case,
manually rotate the mirror to position
(1), then press point (2) of the rocker
button (A) fig. 49 to return the mirror to
position (2) until a "click" is heard, then
press point (1) of the button to bring it
back to position (1).
Defrosting/demisting (for
versions/markets where provided)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Mirrors are fitted with resistors that will
activate when turning the heated rear
window on (by pressing button
).
WARNING
29) As the driver's exterior mirror is
curved, it may slightly alter the perception
of distance of the reflected image. Further,
the reflective surface of the lower part of
the exterior mirrors is parabolic to increase
the field of view. The size of the reflected
image is reduced and gives the impression
that the reflected object is further away
than it is.
30) While driving the mirrors must remain
in position (1).
EXTERIOR LIGHTS
IN BRIEF
The left stalk includes the controls for
the exterior lights.
The exterior lights can only be
switched on when the ignition key is
in the ON position.
LIGHTS OFF
Knurled ring turned to symbol
fig. 50.
WARNING This function is timed and
will turn off automatically after several
minutes.
25
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
50
F1A0064
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHTS (DRL)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
With the ignition key turned to MAR
and the selector wheel turned to
position fig. 50 the day lights
are automatically activated; the
other lights and interior lighting
remain off. The automatic operation
of the daytime running lights can
be activated/deactivated, for
versions/markets where provided,
via the display menu (refer to the
explanations in the "Display" section
of the "Knowing the instrument panel"
chapter).
If the daytime running lights are
deactivated, no light comes on when
the ring is turned to .
31)
26
DIPPED BEAM
HEADLIGHTS/SIDE
LIGHTS
With the ignition key turned to MAR,
turn the twist switch to
fig. 51.
If dipped headlights are activated, the
daytime running lights switch off and
the side lights and dipped headlights
switch on.
warning light switches on in the
The
instrument panel.
When the ignition key is turned to
STOP or removed and the ring from
, all the side
position to position
lights and the number plate lights come
on.
The
warning light switches on in the
instrument panel.
51
The
warning light switches on in the
instrument panel.
To turn the main beams off, pull the
stalk towards the steering wheel again
(dipped beams will come back on).
52
F1A0066
FLASHING THE
HEADLIGHTS
Pull the stalk towards the steering
wheel (1st unstable position) regardless
of the position of the ring.fig. 53 The
warning light switches on in the
instrument panel.
F1A0065
MAIN BEAM HEADLIGHTS
When the ring nut is at
, pull the
stalk towards the steering wheel (2nd
unstable position)fig. 52.
53
F1A0067
AUTOMATIC HIGH BEAM
(High Beam Control)
headlights
In order not to dazzle other road
users, the main beam headlights
are automatically turned off when
approaching oncoming vehicles or
when following a vehicle travelling in the
same direction.
The system is activated with the menu
item and by rotating the light selector to
the
position.
When the main beam headlights are
activated for the first time, pulling the
stalk to turn them on activates the
is
function and the warning light
displayed; if the main beam headlights
are actually on, the relevant blue
warning light
is displayed as well.
If the driving speed is over 40 km/h and
the function is activated, pulling the
stalk again to the main beam headlight
position deactivates the function.
If the driving speed is below 15 km/h
and the function is activated, the
function switches the main beam
headlights off. Pulling the stalk again
to the main beam headlight position
is interpreted as a request for the
main beam headlights to stay on,
therefore the blue warning light
on
the instrument panel turns on and the
main beam headlights stay on until the
speed exceeds 40 km/h again. The
function is enabled again automatically
when 40 km/h is exceeded
.
If the stalk is pulled again in this
condition, to request main beam
headlight deactivation, the function
remains off and the main beam
headlights switch off.
Rotate the ring to the position
fig. 51 to deactivate the automatic
function.
turn off the corresponding headlight
daytime running light (DRL).
Lane change function
If you wish to signal a lane change,
place the left stalk in the unstable
position for less than half a second.
The direction indicator on the side
selected will be activated for 5 flashes
and then go out automatically.
32) 33)
PARKING LIGHTS
These lights can be turned on only with
the ignition key at STOP or extracted
by turning the ring on the left stalk first
to position and then to positions
or
.
The
warning light switches on in the
instrument panel.
DIRECTION INDICATORS
Take the stalk to the (stable) position
fig. 54:
up (position (1)): to activate the right
direction indicator;
down (position (2)): activates the left
direction indicator.
Warning light or will blink on the
instrument panel.
When the daytime running lights are
on (in the versions without LEDs and
for versions/markets, where provided),
activating the direction indicators will
54
F1A0068
"FOLLOW ME HOME"
DEVICE
This device allows the illumination of
the space in front of the vehicle for a
preset time.
Activation
With the ignition key in the STOP
position or extracted, pull the stalk
towards the steering wheel fig. 55 and
move it within 2 minutes of the engine
switching off.
27
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
Each time the stalk is moved, the lights
stay on for an extra 30 seconds up to
a maximum of 210 seconds; then the
lights are switched off automatically.
The
warning light on the
instrument panel will light up and the
corresponding message will appear in
the display (see “Warning lights and
messages" paragraph) for as long as
the function is activated.
Activation
Turn the ring to position
fig. 56: this
turns the side lights and the dipped
beam headlights on simultaneously and
automatically depending on the exterior
brightness conditions.
55
F1A0069
The warning light comes on when the
stalk is operated and stays on until the
function is automatically deactivated.
Each movement of the stalk only
increases the amount of time the lights
stay on.
Deactivation
Keep the stalk pulled towards the
steering wheel fig. 55 for more than 2
seconds.
28
AUTOMATIC HEADLIGHT
SENSOR (dusk sensor)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
It detects variations in brightness
outside the vehicle depending on the
light sensitivity setting: the greater the
sensitivity, the less outside light needed
to activate the exterior lights.
The sensitivity of the dusk sensor may
be adjusted, using the "Setup menu"
on the display.
56
F1A0070
Deactivation
The main beam headlights will go
out followed by the side lights after
approximately 10 seconds, when the
sensor is deactivated.
The sensor is not capable of detecting
the presence of fog. Therefore, in these
circumstances, the lights have to be
turned on manually.
WARNING
31) The daytime running lights are an
alternative to the dipped beam headlights
for driving during the daytime in countries
where it is compulsory to have lights on
during the day while driving, and they
are also permitted in those countries
where this is not obligatory. Daytime
running lights cannot replace dipped beam
headlights when driving at night or through
tunnels. The use of daytime running lights
is governed by the highway code of the
country in which you are driving. Comply
with legal requirements.
32) The system is based on recognition
via a camera. Particular environmental
conditions may affect the correct
recognition of traffic conditions. Therefore,
the driver is always responsible for the
correct use of the main beam headlight
function in compliance with the laws in
force. Rotate the ring to position
to
deactivate the automatic function.
33) If the camera loses its position due to
a load variation, the system may not work
temporarily to allow the camera to perform
an auto-calibration.
HEADLIGHTS
LIGHT BEAM DIRECTION
The correct alignment of the headlights
is essential for the comfort and safety
of the driver and other road users. To
ensure the best visibility when travelling
with the headlights on, the headlight
alignment must be correct. Contact a
Fiat Dealership to have the headlights
checked and adjusted.
HEADLIGHT ALIGNMENT
CORRECTOR
This device works with the ignition key
in the MAR position and the dipped
headlights on.
Headlight alignment adjustment
Press
or
on the control panel
fig. 57.
The instrument panel display shows the
position in relation to the adjustment
set.
WARNING Check the alignment of the
light beams each time the weight of the
load transported changes.
CEILING LIGHTS
MODE
57
F1A0326
FOG LIGHTS ALIGNMENT
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Contact a Fiat Dealership to have the
headlights checked and adjusted.
ADJUSTING THE
HEADLIGHTS WHEN
ABROAD
The dipped beam headlights are
aligned for operation in the country
where the vehicle was originally
purchased. When in countries where
you drive on the other side of the
road, you need to alter the light
beam direction by affixing a specially
designed self-adhesive film in order not
to dazzle the vehicles travelling in the
opposite direction.
This film is provided by Lineaccessori
MOPAR and is available at Fiat
Dealerships.
FRONT ceiling LIGHT
WITH SPOT LIGHTS
Switch (A) fig. 58 is used to switch
on/off the ceiling light bulbs. With
switch (A) in central position: lights (C)
and (D) switch on/off when the front
doors are opened/closed. With switch
(A) pressed to the left, lights (C) e (D)
stay off. With switch (A) pressed to the
right, lights (C) e (D) stay on.
58
F1A0074
Lights switch on/off progressively.
Switch (B) is a spot light; when the roof
light is off, it switches the following on
individually:
light (C) if pressed on the left side;
light (D) if pressed on the right side.
The timed period ends automatically
when the doors are locked.
29
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
Ceiling light timing
On some versions, to facilitate getting
in/out of the vehicle at night or with
poor lighting, two different timed
modes are available:
for entering the vehicle;
for leaving the vehicle.
LED COURTESY LIGHT IN
LOAD COMPARTMENT
It is located on the inside the load
compartment fig. 59.
59
F1A0489
The switch (A) can be used to turn it on
and off:
position
: the courtesy light is
always on;
position
: the courtesy light
switches on when the front door, side
door and rear swing door is opened.
It switches off automatically after 10
seconds from when all the doors are
closed. It also switches on when the
movement of a person is detected
30
in the load compartment, and then
switches off automatically after a
few seconds from the end of the
movement;
OFF position: the courtesy light is
always off.
In any case, if the switch is left in on
position, the ceiling light switches off
automatically 15 minutes after the
engine switching off.
REMOVABLE COURTESY
LIGHT
(for versions/markets, where provided)
It is used as both a fixed light and a
portable electric torch.
When the removable light is connected
to its fixed mount fig. 60, the electric
torch battery is automatically
recharged.
With the vehicle stationary and the
ignition key either turned to STOP or
removed, the ceiling light is recharged
for a maximum of 15 minutes.
60
F1A0077
CONTROLS
HAZARD WARNING
LIGHTS
They are turned on by pressing switch
(A) fig. 61, regardless of the position of
the ignition key.
61
F1A0306
Warning lights
and
are lit up in
the instrument panel when this device
is activated. Press the switch (A) again
to turn the lights off.
Emergency braking
(for versions/markets, where provided)
In the event of emergency braking
the hazard warning lights come on
automatically, as do the
and
warning lights in the panel. The function
switches off automatically when the
nature of the braking changes.
FOG LIGHTS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
fig. 62 with the
Press button
side/tail lights on to turn the fog lights
on. Instrument panel warning light
comes on. Press the button again to
switch the lights off.
MODE
63
MODE
62
F1A0331
REAR FOG LIGHT
These lights come on, with the dipped
headlights on or with the side lights
and fog lights on (for versions/markets
where provided) by pressing the button
fig. 63. Instrument panel warning
light
comes on. Press the button
again to turn the lights off, or turn off
the dipped beams and/or the front fog
lights (where provided).
MODE
F1A0323
FOG LIGHTS / REAR FOG
LIGHTS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
With the dipped beam headlights on,
use the button (A) fig. 64 to turn on the
front/rear fog lights, as follows:
first press: turns on the fog lights,
the
warning light on the instrument
panel will turn on;
second press: turns on the rear fog
lights, the
warning light on the
instrument panel will turn on;
third press: front/rear fog lights off.
64
F1A0438
PARKING LIGHTS
These lights can be turned on only with
the ignition key at STOP or extracted
by turning the ring on the left stalk first
to position and then to positions
or
. The
warning light switches
on in the instrument panel.
ECO FUNCTION
(For versions/markets, where provided)
To activate the function press the ECO
fig. 64 button. When the function is
enabled, the corresponding LED on the
button turns on together with an icon
and a message on the display.
This function is memorised, so when
the vehicle is started again, the system
keeps the setting it had before the
engine was stopped. Press the ECO
button again to disable the function
and restore the normal driving setting.
In the event of a malfunction with the
function on, the system automatically
31
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
disables the ECO function and restores
the normal driving setting.
HEATED REAR WINDOW
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Press button (A) fig. 65 to switch the
device on. The device will be switched
off automatically after approximately 20
minutes.
66
65
F1A0330
BATTERY
DISCONNECTION
FUNCTION
(DISCONNECTOR)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The battery disconnection function is
enabled with the ignition key in the
BATT position, as illustrated on the
dedicated plate located in the area
shown in fig. 66.
To turn the ignition key to BATT
position, press the button (A) (red)
fig. 67.
The battery will be disconnected, by
interrupting the earth lead, about 7
minutes after the key is turned to the
BATT position.
This 7 minute period is necessary to:
allow the driver to get out of the
vehicle and lock the doors using the
remote control;
DOOR LOCKING
To lock all doors at the same time,
press the button (A) fig. 68, located on
the centre console, regardless of the
ignition key's position.
68
67
32
F1A0082
guarantee that all the vehicle
electrical systems have been
deactivated.
With the battery disconnected, access
to the vehicle will only be possible by
unlocking the driver's door using the
mechanical lock.
To restore the battery connection,
insert the ignition key and turn it to
the MAR position, the vehicle can be
started normally at this point.
If the battery is disconnected, it may
be necessary to set certain electrical
devices again (e.g. clock, date, etc.).
F1A0083
F1A0303
The LED on the button switches on
when the doors are locked.
69
F1A0085
The electric window panel there is a
button (D) fig. 69, which independently
unlocks/locks the load compartment.
WINDOW WASHING
IN BRIEF
With the stalk in position (B), turn ring
(F) to select one of four different speeds
for the flick operation mode:
very slow flick
- - slow flick
- - - medium flick
- - - - fast flick
(C) continuous slow operation.
(D) continuous fast operation
(E) temporary fast operation (unstable
position).
Temporary fast operation in position
(E) is limited to the time that the lever is
manually held in this position.
The lever returns to position (A) when it
is released, automatically stopping the
windscreen wipers.
4)
The right-hand lever fig. 70 turns
on the windscreen wiper/washer
and, where provided, the headlight
washers and the rain sensor.
This operates only with the ignition
key turned to MAR.
WINDSCREEN WIPER /
WASHER
The right hand stalk fig. 70 can take up
five different positions:
(A) windscreen wiper off.
(B) flick operation.
70
F1A0071
WARNING We recommend replacing
the blades once a year.
“Smart washing” function
Pulling the stalk towards the steering
wheel (unstable position) operates the
windscreen washer fig. 71.
Keeping the stalk pulled for more than
half a second, with just one movement
it is possible to operate the washer jet
and the wiper at the same time.
33
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
The windscreen wiper stops working
three strokes after the stalk is released.
A further stroke after approx. 6
seconds completes the wiping cycle.
71
F1A0072
RAIN SENSOR
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The rain sensor is located behind
the driving mirror in contact with the
windscreen and has the purpose
of automatically adjust, during the
intermittent operation, the frequency of
the windscreen wiper strokes as to the
rain intensity.
WARNING Keep the glass in the sensor
area clean.
Activation fig. 70
Move the right lever down by one click
(position (B)).
34
The activation of the sensor is signalled
by a "stroke" to show that the
command has been acquired.
Turn the control (F) to increase the rain
sensor sensitivity.
The increasing of the rain sensor
sensitivity is signalled by a "stroke" to
show that the command has been
acquired.
If the windscreen washer is used with
the rain sensor activated, the normal
washing cycle is performed, after which
the rain sensor resumes its normal
automatic operation.
Deactivation fig. 70
Move the lever from position (B) or
turn the ignition key to OFF. At the
next start-up (key at ON), the sensor
will not be reactivated even if the
stalk is at (B). To activate the sensor,
move the stalk to position (A) or (C)
and then to position (B) or turn the
sensitivity adjustment knurled ring. Rain
sensor activation will be indicated by
at least one wiper "stroke" even if the
windscreen is dry.
The rain sensor is capable of
recognising the difference between day
and night and making the necessary
adjustments automatically.
34)
HEADLIGHT WASHERS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The headlight washers are
“retractable", i.e.: they are located
inside the front bumper and they are
activated when (with dipped beams on)
the windscreen washer is operated.
WARNING Check the correct condition
and cleanliness of nozzles at regular
intervals.
WARNING
34) Streaks of water may cause
unnecessary blade movements.
IMPORTANT
4) Never use the screen wiper to remove
layers of snow or ice from the windscreen
glass. In such conditions, the wiper
may be subjected to excessive stress
and the motor cut-out switch, which
prevents operation for a few seconds, may
intervene. If operation is not restored,
contact a Fiat Dealership.
HEATING AND VENTILATION
MODE
72
F1A0302
1. Upper fixed vent 2. Adjustable central vents 3. Fixed side vents 4. Adjustable side vents 5. Lower vents for front seats
35
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
HEATING AND
VENTILATION
CONTROLS
for heating when the outside
temperature is very low: to direct as
much air as possible to the feet;
to warm the feet and demist the
windscreen at the same time;
for quick windscreen demisting.
Air recirculation on/off knob D
Turn the knob (D) to
to activate
internal air recirculation.
to deactivate
Turn the knob (D) to
internal air recirculation.
MANUAL CLIMATE
CONTROL SYSTEM
73
F1A0048
CONTROLS
Air temperature adjustment ring A
(mixing hot and cold air)
Red section = hot air
Blue section = cold air
(for versions/markets, where provided)
2)
CONTROLS
36
Knob B activates/adjusts the fan
0 = fan off
1-2-3 = fan speed
4
= maximum fan speed
Air distribution ring C
to convey air to the central and side
vents;
to warm the feet and convey slightly
cooler air to the dashboard vents, in
intermediate temperature conditions;
for heating when the outside
temperature is very low: to direct as
much air as possible to the feet;
to warm the feet and demist the
windscreen at the same time;
for quick windscreen demisting.
Air recirculation on/off knob D
Press the button (button LED on) to
turn the internal air recirculation on.
Press the button again (button LED off)
to turn the internal air recirculation off.
Knob B activates/adjusts the fan
0 = fan off
1-2-3 = fan speed
= maximum fan speed
4
Air distribution ring C
to convey air to the central and side
vents;
to warm the feet and convey slightly
cooler air to the dashboard vents, in
intermediate temperature conditions;
Air temperature adjustment ring A
(mixing hot and cold air)
Red section = hot air
Blue section = cold air
74
F1A0051
Climate control system on/off
button E
Press the button (button LED on) to
turn the climate control system on.
Press the button again (button LED off)
to turn the climate control system off.
IMPORTANT
2) The air conditioning system uses R134a
or R1234yf refrigerant compatible with the
regulations in force in the countries where
the vehicle is sold. When charging, only
use the gas indicated on the dedicated
plate in the engine compartment . The
use of other coolants affects the efficiency
and condition of the system. The lubricant
used for the compressor is also strictly
linked to the type of cooling gas, please
refer to a Fiat Dealership.
AUTOMATIC
CLIMATE CONTROL
SYSTEM
(for versions/markets, where provided)
2)
CONTROLS
A AUTO button for automatic control of
all functions.
B Air distribution selection button.
C Display.
D MAX DEF function control button.
E System deactivation button.
F Compressor on/off control button.
G Air recirculation control button.
H Fan speed increase/decrease control
buttons.
I Temperature increase/decrease
control knob.
75
F1A0054
USING THE CLIMATE
CONTROL SYSTEM
The system can be started in different
ways, but it is advisable to start by
pressing the AUTO button and then
turning the knob to set the temperature
required on the display.
The system will adjust the temperature,
the quantity and the distribution
of the air sent into the passenger
compartment and, by managing the
recirculation function, the activation of
the climate control system compressor.
During fully automatic operation, the
only manual intervention required is the
possible activation of the following
functions:
air recirculation (to keep the
recirculation constantly on or constantly
off);
to speed up demisting/defrosting
of windscreen, rear window and
external rear view mirrors.
During fully automatic system
operation, you can change the set
temperature, air distribution and fan
speed at any time by using the relevant
buttons or knobs: the system will
automatically change its settings to
adjust to the new requirements. During
fully automatic operation (FULL AUTO),
the word FULL will disappear if the air
distribution and/or flow rate and/or
engagement of the compressor and/or
recirculation settings are changed. In
this way, the functions will switch from
automatic to manual control until the
AUTO button is pressed again.
IMPORTANT
3) The air conditioning system uses R134a
or R1234yf refrigerant compatible with the
regulations in force in the countries where
the vehicle is sold. When charging, only
use the gas indicated on the dedicated
plate in the engine compartment . The
use of other coolants affects the efficiency
and condition of the system. The lubricant
used for the compressor is also strictly
linked to the type of cooling gas, please
refer to a Fiat Dealership.
37
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
ADDITIONAL
HEATER
(for versions/markets, where provided)
On some versions, an additional heater
is also present beneath the driver's
seat. The fan for this heater is operated
by means of the button (F) located on
the control panel fig. 76.
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The vehicle is available, on request,
with two different independent heaters:
one fully automatic, the other which
can be programmed.
AUTOMATIC VERSION
The additional heater is turned on in
automatic mode when the engine
is started and the required outside
temperature and coolant conditions
are present. Deactivation is always
automatic.
F
MODE
76
INDEPENDENT
ADDITIONAL
HEATER
35)
F1A0305
WARNING During periods with low
outdoor temperatures when the device
cuts in, check that the fuel level is
always higher than the reserve level.
Otherwise the device could lock
and require the assistance of a Fiat
Dealership.
PROGRAMMABLE
VERSION
The additional heater operates
completely independently of engine
operation and allows the following:
heat the passenger compartment
38
with the engine off;
defrosting the windows;
heat the engine coolant and then the
engine itself prior to starting.
The system consists of:
a diesel burner for heating the
water with an exhaust silencer for the
combustion gases;
a metering pump connected to the
reservoir pipes for supplying the burner;
a heat exchanger connected to the
engine cooling system pipes;
a control unit connected to
the passenger compartment
heating/ventilation system to allow
automatic operation;
an electronic control unit for
controlling and adjusting the built-in
burner;
a digital timer fig. 77 for turning the
heater on manually or for programming
the time it comes on.
WARNING The heater is equipped
with a thermal limiter that cuts off
combustion in the case of overheating
due to insufficient coolant/coolant
leaks. In this case, after repairing the
fault in the cooling system and/or
topping up the fluid, press the program
selection button before turning the
heater back on.
Programmed activation of heating
Before programming system activation,
it is essential to set the time.
Digital timer fig. 77
77
F1A0057
(1) Time/timer display
(2) Ventilation warning light
(3) Hour forward adjustment button
(4) Program selection button
(5) Clock pre-selection recall number
(6) Activation button for immediate
heating
(7) Time adjustment/reading warning
light
(8) Hour back adjustment button
(9) Heating cycle warning light
Heating turned on immediately
To switch the system on manually,
press the button (6) of the timer: the
display and warning light (9) will light
up and remain on the entire time the
system is working.
Switching on time will disappear after
10 seconds.
Setting the current time
Keep button (4) pressed: the display
and warning light (7) will switch on;
At the same time, within 10 seconds,
press buttons (3) or (8) to select the
exact time;
Release the button (4).
When the display goes off, the current
time is stored.
Continuing to press the buttons (3) or
(8) will move the digits on the clock
forwards or backwards faster.
Time setting is not possible when the
heating or ventilation functions are
active.
WARNING Pay attention to the daylight
saving time/standard time setting.
Programming the switching on time
To program the activation time:
press the button (4): the symbol
(10) or the time set previously and the
number (5) corresponding to the preselection recalled will light up in the
display for 10 seconds.
WARNING If you wish to recall other
preselected times, press button
(4) from time to time within 10
seconds.Within 10 seconds, press
buttons (3) or (8) to select the desired
switching on time.
WARNING The confirmation that
the time has been memorised is
given by:the disappearance of the
switching on time;the presence of the
pre-selection number (5);the lighting of
the display.
WARNING When the boiler comes
on:the flame warning light (9)switches
on in the display;the pre-selection
number (5) goes out.
Standard settings:
Preselected time 1: 6:00
Preselected time 2: 16:00
Preselected time 3: 22:00
WARNING Factory pre-settings
are cancelled with a new setting.
Preselected times are stored until
the following change. If the clock is
detached from the on-board network
(e.g. if the battery is disconnected), the
factory pre-settings are restored.
Deactivation of the programmed
switching on time
To delete the programmed activation
time, press button (4) briefly: the
39
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
display lighting will go off and the
number (5) relating to the preselected
time will disappear.
Recalling one of the preselected
switching on times
Operate button (4) within 10 seconds
until the program number with the
desired preselected time is displayed.
The preselected time you have chosen
to set is automatically activated after
about 10 seconds without the need for
any further confirmation with another
button.
Activate the preselected time taking
into account the safety instructions
for the operation of the independent
heating (for this purpose consult
the Owner Handbook for use of
independent heating).
WARNING Independent heating
switches on at the preselected time,
both with vehicle parked and while
driving.
WARNING The programmed switching
on time can be altered or cancelled
by following the instructions given
previously.
Operation duration setting
Hold the button pressed.
40
Hold button (3) or (8) pressed at the
same time.
The time and warning light (7) are
displayed.
Press the button 4 again and hold it
down. Hold button (3) or (8) pressed at
the same time.
The preset activation duration is
displayed and warning light (9) or (2)
flashes.
Set the activation duration with button
(3) or (8).
The set activation duration is stored
as soon as the text in the display
disappears, or pressing button (4).
Switching the heating system off
Deactivation of the system, depending
on the type of activation (automatic or
manual), may be:
automatic when the programmed
duration is over; when the set time is
over, the display switches off.
manual pressing the “immediate
heating” button on the timer again
(flame button 6).
The heating warning light and the
display light are switched off.
The fluid circulation pump keeps
working for approximately two minutes:
the heater can be switched back on
again during this time.
WARNING The parking heater goes off
when battery voltage is low to allow the
vehicle to be started.
WARNING Before turning on the
device, ensure that the fuel level is
above the reserve. Otherwise the
device could lock and require the
assistance of a Fiat Dealership.
Always turn off the heater when
refuelling and near service stations
to avoid the risk of explosion or fire
hazards.
Do not park the vehicle on
inflammable material such as paper,
grass or dry leaves: fire hazard!
The temperature near the heater
should not exceed 120°C (e.g. during
oven painting in a body shop). The
electronic control unit components may
be damaged at higher temperatures.
Whilst the heater is operating with
the engine switched off, it absorbs
energy from the battery; the engine
should therefore be left running for a
while to make sure that the battery is
properly recharged.
To check the coolant level, follow the
instructions in the "Engine coolant"
paragraph. The water in the heating
circuit must contain a minimum
percentage of 10% antifreeze.
For maintenance and repairs, consult
only a Fiat Dealership and use only
original parts.
MAINTENANCE
Have the additional heater checked
regularly at a Fiat Dealership (and
always at the start of every winter).
This will guarantee safe and economic
operation of the heater as well as a
long duration.
ADDITIONAL REAR
HEATING (Panorama and
Combi)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Panorama and Combi versions are
equipped with a main heating system
plus an additional system (as an option)
with a control on the roof lining above
the second row of seats fig. 78.
For it to operate, it must be enabled
using the button (F) fig. 79 on the
control panel.
78
F1A0062
F
MODE
79
F1A0305
Turn the knob (D) to the maximum
cold position (knob at blue sector);
air at ambient temperature will come
out of the rear footwell vents (located
under the seats in the 2nd -3rd row
for Panorama versions and the grille
on the left wheel arch side for Combi
versions);
Turn the knob (D) to the maximum
heating position (knob at red sector);
warm air will emerge (with the engine
warmed up), from the rear footwell
outlets (located under the seat in
the 2nd and 3rd row for Panorama
versions and the grille on the left wheel
arch side for Combi versions).
ADDITIONAL REAR
CLIMATE CONTROL
(Panorama and Combi)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Panorama and Combi versions are
equipped with a main heating/air
conditioning system plus an additional
system (as an option) with a control on
the roof lining above the second row
of seats fig. 78. Button (F) fig. 79 on
the control panel must be enabled
for operation; the air conditioning
only works if the main climate control
system is on.
When the knob (D) is placed in the
fully cold position (control in blue
sector) cold air comes out the vents in
the ceiling.
Turn the knob (D) to the maximum
heating position (knob at red
sector);warm air will emerge (with
the engine warmed up), from the
rear footwell outlets (located under
the seats in the 2nd and 3rd row for
Panorama versions and the grille on
the left wheel arch side for Combi
versions).
If the selector knob (D) is placed in
the intermediate positions, the air will
be distributed between the vents in
the ceiling and the rear footwell vents,
varying the temperature.
WARNING If the compressor on the
main climate control system control is
turned on (operation of button E), even
if the additional climate control system
fan is in position 0, the 1st speed will
automatically be activated to prevent
41
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
ice formation, with possible damage to
the component.
WARNING
35) The heater burns fuel in the same way
as the engine, though to a lesser extent.
To prevent poisoning and asphyxiation,
the supplementary heater must never be
turned on, not even for short periods, in
closed environments such as a garage or
workshops without extraction fans for the
exhaust gases.
ELECTRIC WINDOWS
ELECTRIC
Switches fig. 80 on the inner armrest of
the driver's door control the following
with the ignition key in the MAR
position:
(A): left front window opening/closing;
(B): right front window opening/closing.
Continuous automatic operation
Keep one of the buttons pressed for
longer than half a second to operate
the automatic continuous window
operation function. The window stops
when it reaches the end of travel
position, or when the button is pressed
again.
WARNING With the ignition key in
the STOP position or extracted, the
electric windows remain activated for
about 3 minutes and are deactivated
immediately when one of the doors is
opened.
Front passenger side door
A dedicated switch for operating the
window is located on the inner armrest
of the passenger side front door.
36)
due to accidental operation of the electric
windows.
BONNET
OPENING
Proceed as follows:
open the driver's door to gain access
to the bonnet release;
pull the lever fig. 81 in the direction
indicated by the arrow;
lift lever (A) fig. 82 as shown in the
figure;
lift the bonnet and, at the same time,
release the supporting rod fig. 83 from
its locking device (D), then insert the
end of the rod (C) fig. 84 into housing
(E) in the bonnet.
WARNING Before opening the bonnet,
check that windscreen wiper arms are
not lifted from the windscreen.
WARNING
80
42
F1A0125
36) Improper use of the electric windows
can be dangerous. Before and during
operation, always check that nobody is
exposed to the risk of being injured either
directly by the moving window or through
objects getting caught or hit by it. When
leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
from the ignition switch to avoid the risk of
injury to anyone remaining in the vehicle
81
F1A0126
38) The bonnet may drop suddenly if the
supporting rod is not positioned correctly.
39) Perform these operations only when
the vehicle is stationary.
HEAD RESTRAINTS
FRONT
82
F1A0339
CLOSING
Proceed as follows:
hold the bonnet up with one hand
and with the other remove rod (C)
fig. 84 from recess (E) and fit it back
into its catch (D) fig. 83;
lower the bonnet to approximately
20 centimetres from the engine
compartment and let it drop. Make
sure that the bonnet is completely
closed and not only fastened by the
locking device by trying to open it. If it
is not perfectly closed, do not try to
press the bonnet down but open it and
repeat the procedure.
WARNING Always check that the
bonnet is closed correctly to prevent
it from opening while the vehicle is
travelling.
83
F1A0349
85
84
F1A0129
F1A0039
On certain versions the head restraints
are adjustable in height and they lock
automatically in the required position.
40)
WARNING
37) For safety reasons, the bonnet must
always be properly closed while driving.
Therefore, make sure that the bonnet
is properly closed and that the lock is
engaged. If you discover that the bonnet
is not perfectly closed while driving, stop
immediately and close the bonnet in the
correct manner.
Adjustment
Upward adjustment: lift the head
restraint until it clicks into place.
Downward adjustment: press button
(A) fig. 85 and lower the head restraint.
To extract the rear head restraints
press buttons (A) and (B) fig. 85 at the
side of the two supports simultaneously
and lift them out upwards.
37) 38) 39)
43
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
40) All adjustments must be carried out
only with the vehicle stationary and the
engine off. Head restraints must be
adjusted so that the head, rather than the
neck, rests on them. Only in this case
they can protect your head correctly. To
maximise the protective action provided by
the head restraint, adjust the seat backrest
so that your trunk is upright and keep your
head as close to the head restraint as
possible.
INTERIOR FITTINGS
COMPARTMENT
BENEATH PASSENGER
SIDE FRONT SEAT
Proceed as follows to use the
compartment:
Open the flap (A) fig. 86 and remove
it as shown;
turn the lock knob (B) anticlockwise
and remove it to allow the
compartment to be removed.
44
86
F1A0095
USB PORTS
(for versions/markets where provided)
They can be located:
in the centre of the dashboard in
place of the cigar lighter and can be
used only as a charging source for
external devices;
on the central tunnel, above the
smartphone pocket fig. 87, for the
connection of USB remote devices
(see explanation in the "USB Support"
section of the "MULTIMEDIA" chapter
for Uconnect 3" or Uconnect 5").
87
F1A0487
POWER SOCKET
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The power socket is located in the
centre console near the cigar lighter.
To use it, open the cover (A) fig. 88.
88
F1A0308
TABLET HOLDER
(for versions/markets, where provided)
It is located in the centre of the
dashboard and is designed to anchor a
tablet.
Proceed as follows to use fig. 89:
lower the lever (A) to open the
locking devices (B);
fit the tablet between the locking
devices (B);
lift the lever (A) to ensure that the
device is locked.
TACHOGRAPH
For tachograph operation and use,
consult the owner handbook supplied
by the device manufacturer. The
tachograph must be installed on the
vehicle when the vehicle weight (with or
without trailer) exceeds 3.5 tons.
90
F1A0999
44)
41) 42) 43)
WARNING
89
F1A0342
OPEN STORAGE
COMPARTMENT
(for versions/markets where provided)
On some versions, there is a storage
compartment in the middle of the
dashboard fig. 90.
41) The cigar lighter becomes very hot.
Handle it carefully and make sure children
do not touch it: risk of fire and/or burning.
42) Do not use the desk in vertical position
with the vehicle in motion.
43) To prevent dangerous situations,
moving the tablet holder and using the
device are prohibited while driving.
44) Never place potentially dangerous
items in the open compartment on the
dashboard; in the event of a collision,
they may be flung into the passenger
compartment and injure the occupants.
WARNING Anyone making changes
to the monitoring device or signal
transmission system that affects
recording by the monitoring instrument,
particularly if this is done for purposes
of fraud, may be in breach of criminal
or administrative state regulations.
WARNING If a tachograph is fitted, if
the vehicle is parked for more than 5
days, it is advisable to disconnect the
negative battery terminal to maintain its
charge.
IMPORTANT NOTES
Do not use abrasive detergents or
solvents to clean the device.
To clean the device externally, use a
damp cloth or special products for the
care of synthetic materials.
The tachograph is installed and sealed
by authorised personnel: do not try
and access the device or the supply
and recording leads in any way. It is
the responsibility of the owner of the
45
KNOWING YOUR VEHICLE
vehicle on which the tachograph is
installed to check the device regularly.
The check must be carried out at least
every two years and a test must be
carried out to ensure it is operating
properly. Ensure that the data label is
renewed after every check that that the
label contains the specified data.
SELF-LEVELLING
AIR SUSPENSION
F1A0170
Manual adjustment
GENERAL INFORMATION
The system only acts on the rear
wheels.
The system maintains the rear ride
setting for the vehicle constant in any
loading condition, while ensuring a
greater driving comfort.
HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT
There are 7 pre-defined levels for the
free height from the ground: from “ride
-3" to “ride 0" till “ride +3".
The trim is shown on the multifunction
display
Automatic adjustment
Whilst driving, the system automatically
restores the vehicle to "position 0" and
keeps it constant.
While adjusting, the LED located on the
button ((A) or (B) fig. 91) corresponding
to the direction of travel, flashes.
46
91
Possible causes may be as follows:
insufficient air reserve: the function is
restored by starting the engine;
the system has reached a threshold
working temperature: wait a few
minutes to let it cool down before
operating the buttons again.
The level selected with the vehicle
stationary is maintained up to a speed
of about 20 km/h; when this speed is
exceeded, the system will automatically
restore the normal level: "position 0".
5)
With the vehicle stationary and the
engine on or off, the desired height
level can be set.
Pressing button (A), for less than 1
second, selects the next level up.
Keeping button (A) pressed for more
than 1 second directly selects the
maximum level: "position +3".
Pressing button (B), for less than 1
second, selects the next level down.
Keeping button (B) pressed for more
than 1 second directly selects the
minimum level: "position -3".
While adjusting, the LED located on the
button ((A) or (B) ) corresponding to the
direction of travel, flashes.
If, after selecting a button, the LED
remains lit up (for about 5 seconds)
rather than flashing, this means that the
adjustment is temporarily unavailable.
WARNING
5) Before manually adjusting with doors
open, make sure there is enough space
around the vehicle for this kind of
operation.
ACCESSORIES
PURCHASED BY THE
OWNER
PROVISION FOR
FITTING TELEPASS
ON REFLECTIVE
WINDSCREEN
(for versions/markets, where provided)
If the vehicle is equipped with a
reflective windscreen, install the
Telepass in the appropriate area shown
in fig. 92 - fig. 93.
92
93
F1A0311
F1A0310
47
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
48
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
This section of the handbook gives
you all the information you need to
understand, interpret and use the
instrument panel correctly.
DASHBOARD AND INSTRUMENT
PANEL........................................
DISPLAY .....................................
TRIP COMPUTER ........................
WARNING LIGHTS AND
MESSAGES ................................
49
53
55
56
DASHBOARD AND INSTRUMENT PANEL
Versions with multifunction display
94
F1A0356
A. Speedometer B. Display C. Rev counter D. Engine coolant temperature indicator with overheating warning light E. Fuel level
gauge with reserve warning light
49
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
Right-hand drive versions with multifunction display
95
F1A0357
A. Speedometer B. Display C. Rev counter D. Engine coolant temperature indicator with overheating warning light E. Fuel level
gauge with reserve warning light
50
Versions with reconfigurable multifunction display
96
F1A0994
A. Speedometer B. Display C. Rev counter D. Engine coolant temperature indicator with overheating warning light E. Fuel level
gauge with reserve warning light
51
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
Right-hand drive versions with reconfigurable multifunction display
97
F1A0977
A. Speedometer B. Display C. Rev counter D. Engine coolant temperature indicator with overheating warning light E. Fuel level
gauge with reserve warning light
6)
IMPORTANT
6) If the needle for the engine coolant temperature reaches the red area, stop the engine immediately and contact a Fiat Dealership.
52
DISPLAY
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The vehicle may be equipped with
a multifunction display or with a
reconfigurable multifunction display,
able to display information that is useful
and necessary when driving.
MULTIFUNCTION
DISPLAY “STANDARD”
SCREEN
The standard screen fig. 98 shows the
following information:
N.B. When one of the front doors
is opened, the display is activated,
showing the time and mileage for a few
seconds.
RECONFIGURABLE
MULTIFUNCTION
DISPLAY "STANDARD"
SCREEN
The standard screen fig. 99 shows the
following information:
99
98
F1A1040
A Date
B Milometer (display of kilometres, or
miles, travelled)
C Time
D Outside temperature
E Headlamp alignment position (only
with dipped headlamps on).
F1A1041
A Time
B Date or trip distance display in
kilometres (or miles)
C Milometer (display of distance
travelled in kilometres/miles)
D Headlight alignment position (only
with dipped beam headlights on)
E: Outside temperature (for
versions/markets, where provided)
GEAR SHIFT INDICATOR
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The GSI system (Gear Shift Indicator)
advises the drives when to shift gear
via a dedicated indication on the
instrument panel. Through the GSI, the
driver is notified that changing gear will
allow a reduction in fuel consumption.
When the SHIFT UP icon (
SHIFT)
is shown on the display, the GSI
is advising the driver to engage a
higher gear, while the SHIFT DOWN
(
SHIFT) icon advises the driver to
engage a lower gear.
WARNING The indication in the display
remains on until the driver shifts gear
or the driving conditions go back to
a situation where shifting gear is not
required to improve consumption.
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
GAUGE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The gauge shows the level of oil in the
engine in a graphic form.
To see the oil level: turn the key to
MAR and wait for approximately 3
seconds; the oil level will appear on the
display fig. 100 - fig. 101 by turning five
symbols on/off.
53
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
Versions with multifunction display
CONTROL BUTTONS
WARNING To find out the correct
oil quantity, always check using
the dipstick (see “Checking levels"
paragraph in "Technical Data" chapter).
100
F1A0354
Versions with reconfigurable
multifunction display
Liv.olio
MIN
101
MAX
F1A0355
The gradual switching off of the
symbols indicates a decreasing oil
level. Four or five symbols light up
to indicate a sufficient level of oil in
the sump. If the fifth symbol is not lit,
this does not indicate a fault or that
insufficient oil is present in the sump.
If the oil level is lower than the minimum
required value, the display shows a
dedicated message indicating minimum
54
engine oil level and the need for a topup.
After a few seconds, the symbol
display indicating the amount of engine
oil disappears and:
if the next scheduled servicing
intervention is approaching, the time to
the next service is displayed and the
O symbol lights up on the display.
When the service interval has expired a
dedicated alert will be shown on the
display.
later on, if the time for changing the
engine oil is getting close, the distance
until the next oil change will appear on
the display. When the service interval
has expired a dedicated alert will be
shown on the display.
WARNING The oil level indication will
not appear on the display if the engine
was stopped for less than 6 minutes.
MODE
102
F1A0304
To scroll up through the screen
and the related options or to increase
the displayed value.
MODE Press briefly to access the
menu and/or go to next screen or to
confirm the desired selection. Hold
down to go back to the standard
screen.
To scroll down through the
screen and the related options or to
decrease the displayed value.
N.B. Buttons
and
activate different functions according to
the following situations:
Adjusting the vehicle interior
lighting
with the side lights on and standard
screen active, it is possible to adjust
the brightness inside the vehicle.
Setup menu
within the menu, they allow you to
scroll up and down;
to increase or decrease values during
settings.
SETUP MENU
Setup menu functions
The Setup menu can be activated by
pressing the MODE button briefly.
The menu comprises the following
functions:
Menu
Dimmer
Headlight alignment corrector
Speed buzzer
Headlight sensor
Cornering lights
Rain sensor
Trip B activation
Traffic sign
Set time
Set date
Autoclose
Units
Language
Warning volume
Service
Passenger's airbag
Daytime running lights
Automatic main beam headlights
Brake Control (where present)
versions with reconfigurable
multifunction display
Blind Spot (where present) versions
with reconfigurable multifunction
display
Quit menu
or
to scroll
Press buttons
the Setup menu options.
Operating modes are different
according to the characteristics of the
option selected.
With the Uconnect™ system, some
Menu items are shown and managed
on the display of the latter and not on
the instrument panel display (see the
paragraphs on theUconnect™ system
in the "Multimedia" chapter).
TRIP COMPUTER
Trip A allows the display of the
following parameters:
Outside Temperature
Range
Distance travelled A
Average consumption A
Instant consumption
Average speed A
Travel time A (driving time)
Reset Trip A
"Trip B", available on multifunction
display only, is used to display the
values relating to:
Distance travelled B
Average consumption B
Average speed B
Trip time B (driving time).
7)
IN BRIEF
The Trip computer is used to display
information on vehicle operation when
the ignition key is turned to MAR.
This function allows you to define two
separate trips, called "Trip A" and
"Trip B", for monitoring the "complete
mission" (journey) of the vehicle in
a reciprocally independent manner.
Both functions can be reset (reset
means start of a new journey).
Exit Trip
You can automatically exit the TRIP
function once all the values have been
displayed or by holding the MODE
button down for more than 1 second.
IMPORTANT
7) The "Trip B" function may be disabled
(see the "Activating Trip B" paragraph).
"Range" and "Instantaneous fuel
consumption" information can not be
reset.
55
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WARNING LIGHTS AND MESSAGES
The warning light switches on together with (where the instrument panel permits) a specific message and/or acoustic warning.
These indications are indicative and precautionary and as such must not be considered as exhaustive and/or alternative to the
information contained in the Owner Handbook, which you are advised to read carefully in all cases. In the event of a failure
indication, always refer to the contents of this chapter.
WARNING The failure indicators appearing on the display are divided into two categories: very serious and less serious faults.
Serious faults are indicated by a repeated and prolonged warning "cycle". Less serious faults are indicated by a warning "cycle"
with a shorter duration. The display cycle of both categories can be interrupted. The instrument panel warning light will stay on
until the cause of the malfunction is eliminated.
Warning lights on panel
What it means
LOW BRAKE FLUID/HANDBRAKE ENGAGED
The warning light switches on when the key is turned
to MAR-ON, but it should switch off after a few
seconds.
red
56
What to do
Low brake fluid level
The warning light turns on when the level of the brake
fluid in the reservoir falls below the minimum level,
possibly due to a leak in the circuit.
Restore the brake fluid level, then check that the
warning light has switched off.
If the warning light turns on when travelling (on certain
versions together with the message on the display) stop
the vehicle immediately and contact a Fiat Dealership.
Handbrake engaged
The warning light switches on when the handbrake is
engaged.
Release the handbrake, then check that the warning
light has switched off.
If the warning light stays on, contact a Fiat Dealership.
What it means
red
amber
EBD FAILURE
The simultaneous switching on of the
(red),
(amber) and
(amber) warning lights (for
versions/markets, where provided), with the engine on,
indicates either a failure of the EBD system or that the
system is not available. In this case, the rear wheels
may suddenly lock and the vehicle may swerve when
braking sharply.
The display shows the dedicated message.
What to do
Drive very carefully to the nearest Fiat Dealership to
have the system inspected immediately.
amber
red
red
AIR BAG FAILURE
The warning light switches on when the ignition key
is turned to MAR, but it should switch off after a few
seconds.
The warning light stays on constantly if there is a
failure in the airbag system.
On some versions the display shows the dedicated
message.
SEAT BELTS REMINDER
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The warning light switches on constantly with the
vehicle stationary and the driver’s seat belt not
fastened.
The warning light flashes and a buzzer will sound if
the vehicle is in motion and the driver’s seat belt is not
correctly fastened.
45) 46)
For permanent deactivation of the acoustic signal
(buzzer) of the SBR. (Seat Belt Reminder) system
contact a Fiat Dealership. With the multifunction display,
you can also reactivate the system through the Setup
menu.
57
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
red
red
58
What to do
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE TOO HIGH
The warning light switches on when the ignition key
is turned to MAR, but it should switch off after a few
seconds. The warning light turns on when the engine
is overheated.
N.B. The screen-printed icon indicating excessive
engine coolant temperature is only provided on
versions with reconfigurable multifunction display.
The display shows the dedicated message.
In normal driving conditions: stop the vehicle, switch
off the engine and check that the water level in the
reservoir is not below the MIN mark. In this case, wait
for the engine to cool down, then slowly and carefully
open the cap, top up with coolant and check that
the level is between the MIN and MAX marks on the
reservoir itself. Also check visually for any fluid leaks. If,
when restarting, the warning light switches on again,
contact a Fiat Dealership.
If the vehicle is used under demanding conditions (e.g.
in high-performance driving): slow down and, if the
warning light stays on, stop the vehicle. Stop for two
or three minutes with the engine running and slightly
accelerated to facilitate better coolant circulation, then
turn the engine off. Check that the coolant level is
correct as described above.
IMPORTANT Over demanding routes, it is advisable to
keep the engine running and slightly accelerated for a
few minutes before turning it off.
LOW BATTERY CHARGE
The warning light switches on when the ignition key is
turned to MAR, but it should switch off as soon as the
engine has started (with the engine idling a brief delay
before switching off is acceptable).
If the warning light stays on, contact a Fiat Dealership
immediately.
LOW ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
When the ignition key is turned to MAR the warning
light (versions with multifunction display) or the symbol
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
switches on, but it should switch off as soon as the
engine is started.
The warning light (or symbol) witches on constantly
together with the alert in the display when the system
detects that the engine oil pressure is insufficient.
8)
What it means
red
red
DECAYED ENGINE OIL
(MultiJet versions with DPF only)
The warning light starts to flash together with an alert
on the display (for versions/markets, where provided)
when the system detects that the engine oil has
deteriorated.
If the warning light flashes, this does not mean that the
vehicle is faulty, but simply informs the driver that it is
now necessary to change the engine oil as a result of
regular vehicle use. If the oil is not changed, warning
will also come on and engine operation is
light
limited to 3000 rpm when a second threshold is
reached.
If the oil is still not changed, when a third deterioration
threshold is reached, the engine is limited to 1500 rpm
to prevent damage.
What to do
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
47) 48)
Remember that the deterioration of the engine oil is
accelerated by:
mainly town use of the vehicle which makes the DPF
regeneration process more frequent
use of the vehicle for short trips, preventing the
engine from reaching operating temperature
repeated interruptions to the regeneration process
signalled by the DPF warning light coming on.
INCOMPLETE DOOR/LOAD COMPARTMENT
CLOSURE
The warning light (versions with multifunction display)
or the symbol (versions with multifunction display)
switches on, on some versions, when one or more
doors or the load compartment are not perfectly
closed.
On some versions, the display shows a specific alert
that indicates that the left/right front door or rear/load
compartment door is open.
A buzzer will sound when doors/tailgate are open and
the vehicle is moving.
59
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
red
red
amber
60
POWER STEERING FAILURE
(for versions with SERVOTRONIC)
The warning light switches on when the ignition key
is turned to MAR, but it should switch off after a few
seconds.
If the warning light stays on together with the message
shown on the display and a buzzer, the power
steering is ineffective and the effort on the steering
wheel increases significantly even though the vehicle
can be steered.
What to do
Contact a Fiat Dealership.
SELF-LEVELLING SUSPENSION FAILURE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
When the ignition key is turned to MAR the warning
light (versions with multifunction display) or the symbol
(versions with multifunction display) switches on, but it
should switch off after a few seconds.
The warning light (or symbol) switches in the event of
a failure in the self-levelling suspension system.
EOBD/INJECTION SYSTEM FAILURE
In normal conditions, when the ignition key is turned
to MAR the warning light switches on, but it should
switch off as soon as the engine is started.
The operation of the
warning light may be checked
by the traffic police using specific devices. Comply
with the laws and regulations of the country where you
are driving.
9)
What it means
amber
amber
amber
What to do
If the warning light stays on or switches on when
driving, it means that the injection system is not
working properly; in particular, if the warning light
comes on constantly, this indicates a malfunction in
the supply/ignition system that could cause excessive
exhaust emissions, a possible loss of performance,
poor driveability and high fuel consumption. On some
versions the display shows the dedicated message.
The warning light switches off if the malfunction
disappears, but is still stored by the system.
Under these conditions, the vehicle can continue
travelling at moderate speed without demanding
excessive effort from the engine. Prolonged use of the
vehicle with the warning light on may cause damage.
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
AdBlue® (UREA) INJECTION SYSTEM FAILURE
The warning light switches on, together with
a dedicated message on the display (for
versions/markets, where provided) if a fluid not
conforming with the nominal characteristics is inserted
or if an average consumption of AdBlue® (UREA) over
50% is detected.
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
If the problem is not solved, a specific message will
appear on the instrument panel display whenever a
certain threshold is reached until it will no longer be
possible to start the engine.
When 200 km are left before you will no longer be able
to restart the engine, a continuous dedicated message
will appear on the dashboard (for versions/markets,
where provided) accompanied by an acoustic warning
sound.
ABS FAILURE
The warning light switches on when the ignition key
is turned to MAR, but it should switch off after a few
seconds.
The warning light switches on to indicate a system
fault. In this case the braking system maintains its
efficiency unaltered but without the advantage of
the ABS system. The display shows the dedicated
message.
Drive carefully and contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as
possible.
61
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
FUEL RESERVE
The warning light switches on when the ignition key
is turned to MAR, but it should switch off after a few
seconds. The warning light switches on when there
are about 10/12 litres of fuel (for versions with tank
capacity 75/90 litres) or 9 litres (for versions with tank
capacity 60 litres) remaining in the tank.
The warning light will blink to indicate a system fault.
If this is the case, go to a Fiat Dealership to have the
system checked.
GLOW PLUG PREHEATING / GLOW PLUG
PREHEATING FAILURE
Glow plugs
This warning light switches on when the key is turned
to MAR. It will switch off as soon as the glow plugs
have reached a preset temperature.
IMPORTANT When it is particularly warm outside, the
warning light stays on for an extremely short time.
Start the engine as soon as the warning light switches
off.
Glow plug preheating failure
The warning light flashes if there is a fault in the
preheating system.
On some versions the display shows the dedicated
message.
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
LOW AdBlue® (UREA) DIESEL EMISSIONS ADDITIVE
LEVEL WARNING
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The ® (UREA) Diesel Emissions Additive low level
warning light
lights up if the vehicle has a low level
of AdBlue® (UREA).
Fill the AdBlue® (UREA) tank
amber
amber
amber
62
What to do
amber
amber
What it means
What to do
VEHICLE PROTECTION SYSTEM FAILURE - FIAT
CODE
When the ignition key is turned to MAR the warning
light (versions with multifunction display) or the symbol
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
should flash once then switch off.
When the warning light (or symbol) comes on
constantly, with key at MAR, this indicates:
a potential failure (see explanations in the "The
Fiat Code system" paragraph of the "Knowing your
vehicle" chapter).
a possible break-in attempt with an alarm; in this
case the warning light switches off after approximately
10 seconds.
will blink with the engine running
The warning light
to indicate that the vehicle is not protected by the
engine immobiliser.
Contact a Fiat Dealership to have all the keys stored in
the memory.
REAR FOG LIGHTS
The warning light comes on when the rear fog lights
are turned on.
GENERAL FAILURE INDICATION
The warning light (versions with multifunction display)
or symbol (versions with reconfigurable multifunction
display) switches on during the following events:
If the fuel inertia cut-off switch is activated
amber
Light failure (rear fog lamps, direction indicators,
brake lights, number plate lights, side lights, daytime
running lights, main beam automatism, trailer direction
indicators, trailer side lights)
The failure relating to these lights could be: one or more
blown bulbs, a blown protection fuse or a break in the
electrical connection.
63
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
64
What it means
Airbag warning light failure (generic failure warning
light flashing)
amber
Rain sensor failure
Diesel filter sensor failure
Trailer connection failure
Audio system failure
Engine oil pressure sensor failure
Parking sensor failure
Water in diesel fuel filter
On versions with a multifunction display, the warning
light also turns on during the following events:
Engine oil level sensor failure
Insufficient engine oil level
Low engine oil pressure warning light failure
What to do
In this case, the warning light (or symbol) may not
indicate any faults with the restraint systems. Before
continuing, contact a Fiat Dealership immediately to
have the system checked.
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible to have
the fault fixed.
What it means
amber
amber
amber
DPF (PARTICULATE FILTER) CLEANING UNDERWAY
(for versions/markets, where provided)
When the ignition key is turned to MAR the warning
light (versions with multifunction display) or the symbol
(versions with multifunction display) switches on, but it
should switch off after a few seconds.
The warning light switches on constantly to alert
the driver that the DPF system needs to eliminate
the trapped pollutants (particulate) through the
regeneration process.
A specific message will appear on the display
when the warning light (or symbol) comes on (for
versions/markets, where provided).
IMPORTANT Failure to observe the appropriate
procedure for a long distance when the warning light
to come
comes on, can cause the warning light
on, resulting in the need to go to a Fiat Dealership to
restore correct DPF operation.
What to do
The warning light (or symbol) does not come on
during every DPF regeneration, but only when driving
conditions require that the driver is notified. The
warning light will go off if the vehicle stays in motion
until regeneration has been completed. The process
normally takes about 15 minutes.
Optimum conditions for completing the process are
achieved by travelling at 60 km/h with engine revs
above 2000 rpm.
If this warning light (or symbol) comes on, it does not
mean there is a vehicle defect, so there is no need to
take it to a garage.
49)
10)
ESC-ASR SYSTEM / TRACTION PLUS FAILURE
On certain versions a dedicated message is displayed.
Flashing of the warning light while driving indicates the
intervention of the ESC system.
If the warning light does not go out or remains on whilst
driving, go to a Fiat Dealership.
Hill Holder failure
The warning light will turn on when the Hill Holder
system is faulty.
On certain versions a dedicated message is displayed.
In this case, contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as
possible.
BRAKE PAD WEAR
The warning light (versions with multifunction display)
or symbol (versions with reconfigurable multifunction
display) switches on if the front or rear brake pads are
worn.
On certain versions a dedicated message is displayed.
Have them replaced as soon as possible.
65
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
amber
amber
amber
66
What to do
LANE DEPARTURE WARNING (DRIVING ADVISOR)
(Versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The two warning lights on indicate that the system has
started recognising the operating conditions.
When the system recognises the operating conditions,
it becomes active, i.e. it can assist the driver with
visual and acoustic warnings. Therefore, the warning
lights switch off.
If the operating conditions are no longer present, the
system is engaged but inactive, and therefore the two
warning lights on the panel switch on.
When the system is active, if the vehicle gets close
to one of the side limit lines or one of the two
demarcation lines of the lane, the driver is warned
with an acoustic signal along with illumination of the
direction indicator light (right or left) on the panel
lighting up.
The system failure is indicated by the two direction
indicator lights
and
lighting up on the panel,
along with an acoustic signal and a specific alert.
TPMS
TPMS failure
The warning light flashes for about 75 seconds and
then stays on constantly (along with a dedicated
message on the display) to indicate that the system is
temporarily deactivated or faulty.
In this case, contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as
possible.
Tyre pressure low
The warning light turns on to indicate that the pressure
of one or more tyres is lower than the recommended
value and/or that slow pressure loss is occurring. In
these circumstances, optimal tyre duration and fuel
consumption may not be guaranteed.
In this case it is advisable to restore the correct
pressure value.
IMPORTANT Do not continue driving with one or more
flat tyres as vehicle handling may be compromised.
Stop the vehicle, avoiding sharp braking and steering.
What it means
amber
amber
FULL BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM TRIGGERED OR
FAILURE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The warning light switches on (together with a
message on the display) if the system is triggered. The
warning light and symbol, with dedicated message,
switch on in case of obstruction, dirt or system
unavailability.
What to do
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
FULL BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM MANUAL
DEACTIVATION OR RESTARTING
(for versions/markets, where provided)
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The warning light switches on constantly (together with
a specific alert on the display) if the system is manually
deactivated, or temporarily until it is restarted.
DIPPED BEAM HEADLIGHTS
The warning light switches on when the dipped beam
headlights are turned on.
green
green
FOLLOW ME HOME
The warning light switches on (together with a
message shown on the display) when this device is
in use (see explanations in "Follow me home device"
paragraph in "Exterior lights" in the "Knowing your
vehicle" chapter).
LEFT DIRECTION INDICATOR
The warning light switches on when the direction
indicator control stalk is moved downwards or,
together with the right direction indicator, when the
hazard warning light button is pressed.
67
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
green
green
green
green
blue
68
RIGHT DIRECTION INDICATOR
The warning light switches on when the direction
indicator control stalk is moved upwards or, together
with the left direction indicator, when the hazard
warning light button is pressed.
FOG LIGHTS
The warning light comes on when the front fog lights
are turned on.
CRUISE CONTROL
(for versions/markets, where provided)
This warning light switches on when the ignition key
is turned to MAR, but it should switch off after a few
seconds, if the Cruise Control is deactivated.
The warning light on the instrument panel when the
Cruise Control selector wheel is turned to ON or
, depending on the version. On certain versions a
dedicated message is displayed.
AUTOMATIC HIGH BEAM (High Beam Control)
headlights
This warning light comes on when the automatic main
beam headlights are activated.
MAIN BEAM HEADLIGHTS
The warning light switches on when the main beam
headlights are turned on.
What to do
WARNING
45) If the
warning light does not switch on when the key is turned to MAR or if it stays on while driving (together with the message on
the display), there may be an anomaly in the restraint systems; in this case, the airbags or pretensioners may not deploy in the event of
an accident or, in a lower number of cases, they could deploy erroneously. Before continuing, contact a Fiat Dealership to have the system
checked immediately.
46) The failure of the
warning light is indicated by the
warning light flashing or, depending on the version, by the
icon constantly
on in the display. In this case, the
warning light may not indicate a possible problem with the airbag restraint system. Before continuing,
contact a Fiat Dealership to have the system checked immediately.
47) Degraded engine oil should be replaced as soon as possible after the warning light
comes on, and never more than 500 km after it
first comes on. Failure to observe the above may result in severe damage to the engine and invalidate the warranty. Remember that when this
warning light comes on, it does not mean that the level of engine oil is low, so if it flashes you do not need to top up the engine oil.
48) If the
warning light flashes while driving, contact a Fiat Dealership.
49) Always drive at a speed appropriate to the traffic conditions, the weather and traffic regulations. The engine may be stopped if the
DPF light is on; however, repeated interruption of the regeneration process may result in premature deterioration of the engine oil. For this
reason, always wait until the warning light switches off before stopping the engine as described above. It is not advisable to complete DPF
regeneration with the vehicle stationary.
IMPORTANT
8) If the
warning light switches on while driving, stop the engine immediately and contact a Fiat Dealership.
9) If, when the ignition key is turned to MAR, the
warning light does not switch on, switches on constantly or flashes while driving (on
certain versions together with the message on the display), contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
10) During regeneration, the fan could be operated.
69
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
70
Messages on display
What it means
What to do
EXTERIOR LIGHTS FAILURE
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The symbol switches on when a fault is detected on
one of the following lights:
direction indicators
rear fog lights
brake lights
side lights
daytime running lights
number plate lights
reversing lights
main beam automatism
trailer side lights
trailer direction indicators
The fault relating to these lights could be: one or more
blown bulbs, a blown protection fuse or a break in the
electrical connection.
ENGINE OIL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT SENSOR
FAILURE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The symbol lights up to indicate a failure of the engine
oil level sensor warning light.
On versions with multifunctional display, the "general
failure" warning light comes on (see explanations in the
"Warning lights on panel" section).
Contact a Fiat Dealership.
BRAKE LIGHT FAILURE
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The symbol switches on when a fault is detected in
the brake lights.
The fault could be: one or more blown bulbs, a blown
protection fuse or a break in the electrical connection.
What it means
What to do
AUTOMATIC HIGH BEAM (High Beam Control)
headlights failure
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The symbol switches on when a fault is detected in
the automatic switching-on system for the main beam
headlights.
POSSIBLE ICE ON ROAD
Versions with reconfigurable multifunction
display: when the outside temperature reaches or falls
below 3°C the outside temperature indication flashes
to warn the driver about the possible presence of ice
on the road.
Versions with multifunction display: when the
outside temperature reaches or falls below 3°C the
display shows a specific alert to warn the driver about
the possible presence of ice on the road.
SPEED LIMIT EXCEEDED
Versions with reconfigurable multifunction
display: the symbol lights up and a specific
alert appears on the display when the vehicle
exceeds the set speed limit (see explanations in the
"Reconfigurable multifunction display" section).
Versions with multifunction display: a specific alert
appears on the display when the vehicle exceeds the
set speed limit (see explanations in the "Multifunction
display" section).
71
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
SCHEDULED SERVICING
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The symbol (versions with reconfigurable multifunction
display) switches on together with display of a specific
alert next to the scheduled servicing warning and
stays on until the service deadline is reached. The
symbol switches off after the service has been carried
out at a Fiat Dealership or once 1000 km have been
covered from the service deadline. On versions with
multifunctional display, only a specific alert is shown.
SPEED LIMITER
(for versions/markets, where provided)
(versions with multifunction display)
The symbol on the display switches on when the
function is activated. On certain versions a dedicated
message is displayed.
FUEL CUT-OFF DEVICE INERTIA SWITCH TRIPPED
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
This symbol on the display switches on when the fuel
cut-off device inertia switch has tripped.
PARKING SENSOR FAILURE
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The symbol switches on together with a dedicated
message to indicate a failure of the park sensors.
LANE DEPARTURE WARNING (DRIVING ADVISOR)
SYSTEM FAILURE
Versions with reconfigurable multifunction
display: the symbol switches on in the display with
the two direction indicator lights
and , together
with a beep and a specific alert.
Versions with multifunction display: the display
shows a specific alert.
72
What to do
For the fuel cut-off inertia switch reactivation procedure,
refer to the "Fuel cut-off switch" paragraph. If it is still
not possible to restore the fuel supply, contact a Fiat
Dealership.
What it means
What to do
TRAFFIC SIGN RECOGNITION FAILURE
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The symbol switches on in the display together with
a specific alert to indicate a failure of the Traffic Sign
Recognition.
LIMITED RANGE
The display shows a dedicated message to warn the
driver that the range of the vehicle is less than 50 km.
ECO
TURNING ON THE ECO FUNCTION
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
ECO is shown on the display with the "ECO" function
is turned on by pressing the corresponding button on
the dashboard.
If the button is pressed again, the word ECO turns
off. On some versions, a specific screen is displayed
instead of the word "ECO".
START&STOP SYSTEM ACTIVATION/DEACTIVATION
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Start&Stop system activation
A message will appear on the display when the
Start&Stop system is activated. In this case the LED
button is off (see the “Start&Stop"
located on the
paragraph).
Start&Stop system deactivation
A dedicated message will appear on the display when
the Start&Stop system is deactivated.
The LED over the
button is on when the system is
deactivated.
START&STOP FAILURE
The symbol appears on the display together with
a specific alert in the event of a Start&Stop system
failure.
73
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
LOW AdBlue® (UREA) DIESEL EMISSIONS ADDITIVE
LEVEL WARNING
When a low AdBlue® (UREA) level is detected, a text
message will appear on the instrument panel display
alerting the driver that the AdBlue® (UREA) must be
topped up, together with the symbol.
The symbol stays on until the tank is topped up with
at least 5 litres of AdBlue® (UREA).
If you do not top up, a specific message will appear
on the instrument panel display whenever a certain
threshold is reached until it will no longer be possible
to start the engine.
A message will appear permanently on the display and
a beep will be heard when there is about 200 km of
range left.
When the residual range is 0 km, a specific alert will
appear on the display (for versions/markets, where
provided). It will no longer be possible to restart the
engine after it has been stopped.
It will be possible to restart the engine after pouring at
least 5 litres of AdBlue® (UREA) in to the tank.
50)
WATER IN DIESEL FUEL FILTER
(for versions/markets, where provided)
(Diesel versions)
(versions with reconfigurable multifunction display)
The symbol switches on constantly when driving
(along with a message in the display), to indicate the
presence of water in the diesel filter.
11)
74
What to do
Top up the AdBlue® (UREA) tank as soon as possible
with at least 5 litres of AdBlue® (UREA). If the top-up
was done with a range of 0 km left in the AdBlue®
(UREA) tank, you may need to wait 2 minutes before
starting the engine.
What it means
What to do
NATURAL POWER SYSTEM FAILURE
(for Natural Power versions only)
The symbol on the display turns on together with a
dedicated message and the four methane levels turn
off.
In this case, contact a Fiat Dealership as quickly as
possible.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID OVERHEATING
The symbol appears to indicate an automatic
transmission overheating.
With engine off or at idle speed, wait until the symbol
switches off.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FAILURE
The two symbols switch on, together with a message
on the display, when an automatic transmission fault
is detected. The symbols and message remain on the
display until the problem is solved.
Go to a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
75
KNOWING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL
What it means
BLIND SPOT ASSIST
WITH TRAILER
DETECTION
"DRIVE MODE" function
What to do
BLIND SPOT ASSIST WITH TRAILER DETECTION
(yellow) Sensor block: the symbol appears on
the display when the Blind Spot Assist with Trailer
Detection system sensor is blocked. In this case,
the LEDs on the door mirrors are switched on
continuously. Free the bumper of any obstacles or
clean it.
(yellow) System not available : the symbol
appears on the display when the Blind Spot Assist
with Trailer Detection system is not faulty. In this
case, the LEDs on the door mirrors are switched on
continuously. The failed operation of the system might
be due to the insufficient voltage from the battery or
other failures on the electrical system. Contact a Fiat
Dealership as soon as possible to have the electrical
system checked.
(red) Blind Spot Assist with Trailer Detection
system fault: the symbol appears on the display
when the Blind Spot Assist with Trailer Detection
system is faulty. In this case, the LEDs on the door
mirrors are switched off. An acoustic signal is also
emitted.
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible.
The required driving mode ("Normal", "Power" or
"Eco") is indicated on the instrument panel display.
WARNING
50) When the AdBlue® (UREA) tank is empty and the engine stops it is no longer possible to restart it until the AdBlue® (UREA) tank is topped
up with at least 5 litres of AdBlue® (UREA).
76
IMPORTANT
11) The presence of water in the fuel supply circuit may cause severe damage to the injection system and irregular engine operation. If the
symbol appears (on some versions together with the dedicated message on the display), contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as possible
to have the system bled. If the above indication occurs immediately after refuelling, water may have entered the tank: turn the engine off
immediately and contact a Fiat Dealership.
77
SAFETY
78
SAFETY
The chapter that you are about to
read is very important: it describes the
safety systems with which the vehicle is
equipped and provides instructions on
how to use them correctly.
ABS ........................................... 79
ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
SYSTEM ..................................... 80
TRACTION PLUS SYSTEM ............ 83
DRIVING ASSISTANCE
SYSTEMS ................................... 84
OCCUPANT PROTECTION
SYSTEMS ................................... 94
SEAT BELTS ............................... 94
SBR SYSTEM .............................. 95
PRE-TENSIONERS....................... 95
CARRYING CHILDREN SAFELY ..... 97
SETUP FOR “UNIVERSAL
ISOFIX" CHILD RESTRAINT
SYSTEM ................................... 101
SUPPLEMENTARY RESTRAINT
SYSTEM (SRS) - AIRBAG ............ 110
ABS
This is an integral part of the braking
system, which prevents one or more
wheels from locking and slipping
regardless of the road surface
conditions and braking intensity,
ensuring control of the vehicle even
during emergency braking.
The system intervenes during braking
when the wheels are about to lock,
typically in emergency braking or lowgrip conditions, when locking may be
more frequent.
The ABS ensures the direction of the
vehicle while braking and optimises the
braking distances at the same time.
The system also improves control and
stability of the vehicle when braking
on a surface on which the grip of the
left and right wheels differs, or when
braking while cornering.
The system is completed by EBD
(Electronic Braking Force Distribution),
which distributes the braking action
between the front and rear wheels.
WARNING To obtain the maximum
efficiency of the braking system, a
bedding-in period of about 500 km is
needed: during this period it is better to
avoid sharp, repeated and prolonged
braking.
SYSTEM INTERVENTION
The driver can feel that the ABS has
come into action because the brake
pedal pulsates slightly and the system
gets noisier: it means that the vehicle
speed should be altered to suit the type
of road surface.
52) 53) 54) 55) 56) 57) 58)
MSR (Motor
Schleppmoment
Regelung) SYSTEM
This is an integral part of the ABS
system and prevents the drive wheels
from locking, which could happen,
for example, if the accelerator pedal
is released suddenly or in the case of
shifting down suddenly in conditions
of poor grip. In these conditions, the
engine braking effect could cause the
drive wheels to slip, resulting in a loss
of vehicle stability.
In these situations, the system
intervenes, restoring torque to the
engine in order to conserve vehicle
stability and increase safety.
WARNING
driving on slippery surfaces and not take
unnecessary risks.
52) When the ABS cuts in and you feel
the brake pedal pulsating, do not remove
your foot, but keep the pedal pushed
down; in doing so you, will stop in the
shortest distance possible under the road
conditions at the time.
53) If the ABS intervenes, this indicates
that the grip of the tyres on the road is
nearing its limit: you must slow down to a
speed compatible with the available grip.
54) The ABS cannot overrule the natural
laws of physics, and cannot increase the
grip available according to the condition of
the road.
55) The ABS system cannot prevent
accidents, including those due to
excessive speed on corners, driving on
low-grip surfaces or aquaplaning.
56) The capability of the ABS must never
be tested irresponsibly and dangerously,
in such a way as to compromise personal
safety and the safety of others.
57) For the correct operation of the ABS,
the tyres must of necessity be the same
make and type on all wheels, in perfect
condition and, above all, of the prescribed
type and dimensions.
58) If the spare wheel (for
versions/markets, where provided) is
used, the ABS keeps operating. Always
remember that the spare wheel, being
smaller than the original wheel, provides
less grip.
51) The ABS gets the most from the
available grip, but it cannot improve it; you
should therefore take every care when
51)
79
SAFETY
80
ESC (Electronic
Stability Control)
SYSTEM
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The ESC system improves the
directional control and stability of the
vehicle in various driving conditions.
The ESC system corrects understeer
and oversteer, distributing the brake
force on the appropriate wheels. The
torque supplied by the engine can also
be reduced in order to maintain control
of the vehicle.
The ESC system uses the sensors in
the vehicle to determine the trajectory
required by the driver through steering
and compares it with the real trajectory
of the vehicle.
When the real trajectory deviates from
the desired trajectory, the ESC system
intervenes to counter understeer or
oversteer.
Oversteer: occurs when the vehicle is
turning more than it should according
to the angle of the steering wheel.
Understeer: occurs when the vehicle
is turning less than it should according
to the angle of the steering wheel.
The ESC system also includes the
following subsystems:
Hill Holder
ASR
HBA
ERM
HDC
59) 60) 61)
SYSTEM INTERVENTION
This is signalled by the flashing of the
warning light
in the instrument
panel, to inform the driver that the
vehicle is in critical stability and grip
conditions.
SYSTEM ACTIVATION
The ESC system switches on
automatically when the engine is
started and cannot be switched off.
HILL HOLDER SYSTEM
This system is an integral part of the
ESC system and facilitates starting on
slopes.
It is automatically activated in the
following conditions:
uphill: vehicle stationary on a road
with a gradient higher than 5%, engine
running, brake pressed and gearbox
in neutral or gear (other than reverse)
engaged;
downhill: vehicle stationary on a road
with a gradient higher than 5%, engine
running, brake pressed and reverse
gear engaged.
When setting off, the ESC system
control unit maintains the braking
pressure on the wheels until the torque
necessary for starting is reached, or in
any case for a maximum of 2 seconds,
allowing your right foot to be moved
easily from the brake pedal to the
accelerator.
When the 2 seconds have elapsed,
without starting, the system is
automatically deactivated, gradually
releasing the braking pressure.
During this release stage, the typical
brake disengagement noise indicating
that the vehicle is going to move
imminently will be heard.
WARNING The Hill Holder system
is not a parking brake; therefore,
never leave the vehicle without having
engaged the handbrake, turned the
engine off and engaged first gear, so
that it is parked in safe conditions (for
further information read the "Parking"
paragraph in the "Starting and driving"
chapter).
ASR (AntiSlip
Regulation) SYSTEM
It is an integral part of the ESC system.
It automatically operates in the event of
one or both drive wheels slipping, loss
of grip on wet roads (aquaplaning) and
acceleration on slippery, snowy or icy
roads, etc.
Depending on the slipping conditions,
two different control systems are
activated:
if the slipping involves both drive
wheels, the ASR intervenes reducing
the power transmitted by the engine;
if the slipping only involves one of the
drive wheels, it intervenes automatically
braking the wheel that is slipping.
62)
Engagement/ disengagement of
the ASR system
The ASR is switched on automatically
each time the engine is started.
While driving, the ASR can be switched
off and subsequently switched on again
by pressing the ASR OFF button ((A)
fig. 103).
63)
On some versions, the intervention of
the system is indicated by a message
shown on the display.
103
F1A0324
When the system is not active, the LED
on the button ASR OFF turns on and,
on some versions, a message appears
on the display.
If the ASR is disengaged during driving,
it is automatically reactivated when the
vehicle is next started.
When travelling on snowy roads with
snow chains, it may be helpful to turn
the ASR off: in fact, in these conditions,
the driving wheels skidding when
moving off gives you better traction.
HBA (Hydraulic Brake
Assist) SYSTEM
The HBA system is designed to
improve the braking capacity of the
vehicle during emergency braking. The
system detects an emergency braking
by monitoring the speed and strength
with which the brake pedal is pressed,
thereby applying the optimal brake
pressure.
This can reduce the braking distance:
the HBA system therefore completes
the ABS.
Maximum assistance from the HBA
system is obtained pressing the
brake pedal very quickly. In addition,
the brake pedal must be pressed
continuously during braking, avoiding
intermittent presses, to benefit from the
system.
Do not reduce pressure on the
brake pedal until braking is no longer
necessary.
The HBA system is deactivated when
the brake pedal is released.
64) 65) 66)
ERM (ELECTRONIC ROLLOVER
MITIGATION) SYSTEM
The system monitors the tendency of
the wheels to rise from the ground
if the driver performs extreme
manoeuvres like quick steering to avoid
an obstacle, especially in poor road
conditions.
If these conditions occur, the system
intervenes on the brakes and engine
power to reduce the possibility that the
wheels are raised from the ground.
It is not possible to avoid the tendency
to roll over if this is due to reasons
such as driving on high side gradients,
collision with objects or other vehicles.
67)
HILL DESCENT CONTROL
(HDC) SYSTEM
It is an integral part of the ESC and
is aimed at keeping the vehicle at a
constant speed during a descent,
operating autonomously on the brakes
in various ways at the same time.
In this way the vehicle stability and
completely safe driving are guaranteed,
81
SAFETY
above all in poor grip conditions and/or
steep descents.
To activate the system, reach a speed
slower than 25 km/h and press the
corresponding button (A)fig. 104; the
LED on the button turns on and the
display shows a dedicated message.
When this function is active the brake
lights turn on automatically.
While the HDC system is operating it
is also possible to take control of the
vehicle again by pressing the brake and
accelerator pedals.
If the function is not made available
when the button is pressed, this could
be due to brake overheating. In this
case, wait a few minutes before using
the function again.
WARNING The system is available for
speeds below 25 km/h.
104
F1A0300
After reaching the desired speed,
release the accelerator and brake
pedals completely (the LED on
the button flashes). If you want to
increase/decrease the speed, press the
accelerator/brake pedals again.
WARNING Do not use the device with
the gearbox in neutral position.
WARNING It is important to engage
a gear suitable for the set speed, to
prevent the engine from stalling.
82
WARNING On exceeding 25 km/h, the
HDC system is disabled and remains
ready to operate again (the LED on
the button remains on) when the
vehicle returns below 25 km/h. If the
vehicle speed exceeds 50 km/h, the
HDC system turns off completely (the
LED on the button turns off) and any
autonomous action on the brakes is
disabled.To reactivate it, press the
dedicated button again when the
speed is again below 25 km/h.
12)
WARNING
59) The ESC system cannot overrule
the natural laws of physics, and can’t
increase the grip available according to the
condition of the road.
60) The ESC system cannot prevent
accidents, including those due to
excessive speed on corners, driving on
low-grip surfaces or aquaplaning.
61) The capability of the ESC system
must never be tested irresponsibly
and dangerously, in such a way as to
compromise personal safety and the
safety of others.
62) For the correct operation of the ESC
and ASR systems it is vital that the tyres
are the same make and the same type on
all the wheels, in perfect condition and,
above all, the recommended type and size.
63) The performance of the ESC and ASR
systems must not encourage the driver to
take unnecessary risks. Driving style must
always be suitable for road conditions,
visibility and traffic. The driver is, in any
case, responsible for safe driving.
64) The HBA system cannot increase tyre
grip on the road over the limits imposed
by laws of physics: always drive carefully
according to the conditions of the road
surface.
65) The HBA system cannot prevent
accidents, including those due to
excessive speed on bends, travelling on
low-grip surfaces or aquaplaning.
66) The HBA system is an aid for the
driver, who must always pay full attention
while driving. The responsibility always
rests with the driver. The features of the
HBA system must never be tested in
imprudent or dangerous ways, with the
possibility of putting the safety of the
driver, occupants or other road users at
risk.
67) The performance of a vehicle with
ERM must never be tested in imprudent
or dangerous ways, with the possibility
of putting the safety of the driver or other
people at risk.
IMPORTANT
12) Prolonged use of the system may
overheat the braking system. If the brakes
overheat, the HDC system, when active,
will be gradually deactivated after suitably
informing the driver (the LED on the button
turns off): it can be reactivated only when
the brakes have cooled sufficiently. The
distance you can travel depends on the
brake temperature and thus on the slope,
the load and the vehicle speed.
TRACTION PLUS
SYSTEM
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Traction Plus is a driving aid,
useful for setting off in poor grip
conditions on non-homogeneous road
surfaces (snow/asphalt, ice/asphalt,
mud/asphalt, etc.), which allows the
drive force to be distributed adequately
on the engine axle when one of the two
drive wheels slips.
Traction Plus acts by braking the
wheel with poor grip (or the one which
slips more than the others), thereby
transferring the drive force to those
which have greater grip on the ground.
This function can be turned on
manually by pressing the (A) button
fig. 105 on the dashboard and works
below a level of 50 km/h. Over this
speed, it is automatically deactivated
(the LED on the button is still on) and it
is reactivated again when the speed is
below 50 km/h.
68) 69)
105
F1A0325
Traction Plus operation
When the engine is started the system
is disabled.
To activate the "Traction Plus" system,
press the button (A) fig. 105: the LED
on the button switches on.
The activation of the Traction Plus
system involves the following functions
being switched on:
inhibition of the ASR function, in
order to fully exploit the engine torque;
the differential locking effect on
the front axle, through the braking
system, to improve traction on irregular
grounds.
If the "Traction Plus" system is faulty,
the "general failure" instrument panel
warning light
comes on steady.
When travelling on snowy roads with
snow chains, it may be helpful to turn
the Traction Plus on and thus inhibiting
the ASR function: in fact, in these
conditions, slipping of the drive wheels
83
SAFETY
when moving off makes it possible to
obtain better traction.
WARNING
68) The Traction Plus system acts
effectively only on road surfaces that are
not homogeneous and/or differentiated
between the two drive wheels.
69) Until the setting off manoeuvre is
terminated, fully depress the accelerator
pedal in order to transfer all the drive
torque to the wheel with the best grip.
DRIVING
ASSISTANCE
SYSTEMS
The vehicle may be fitted with the
following driving assistance systems:
BSA (Blind Spot Assist with Trailer
Detection)
TPMS (Tyre Pressure Monitoring
System)
LDW (Lane Departure Warning)
For the operation of the systems, refer
to the following pages.
BSA (Blind Spot Assist
with Trailer Detection)
SYSTEM
The vehicle can be equipped with the
BSA (Blind Spot Assist with Trailer
Detection) system for blind spot
84
monitoring. The BSA system uses two
radar sensors, located in the rear side
bumper (one on each side) fig. 106, to
detect the presence of vehicles (cars,
trucks, etc.) in blind spots in the rear
side zone of the vehicle, while driving
on the road and while reversing (RCP
functionality).
106
F1A0480
The system warns the driver about the
presence of vehicles in the detection
area by lighting up, on the relevant
side, the warning light located on the
door mirror, along with an acoustic
warning. When the vehicle is started
the warning light turns on to signal the
driver that the system is active.
Sensors
The sensors are activated when any
forward gear is engaged at a speed
higher than about 10 km/h, or when
reverse is engaged.
The sensors are temporarily
deactivated with vehicle at a standstill
and the gear lever in position P (Park)
(versions with automatic transmission),
or with vehicle at a standstill and
parking brake engaged (versions with
manual transmission).
In no trailers are connected, the
detection area of the system covers
about a lane on both sides of the
vehicle (approx. 3 metres).
Such zone begins near the centre pillar
of the vehicle and extends up to 6
metres from the rear of the vehicle.
When the sensors are active the
system monitors the detection areas on
both sides of the vehicle and warns the
driver about the possible presence of
cars in these areas.
While driving the system monitors the
detection area from three different input
points (side, rear and front) to check
whether a signal needs to be sent to
the driver.
IMPORTANT NOTES
The system does not signal the
presence of fixed object (e.g. safety
barriers, poles, walls, etc.). However,
in some circumstances, the system
may activate in the presence of these
objects. This is normal and does not
indicate a system malfunction.
The system does not warn the driver
about the presence of vehicles coming
from the opposite direction, in the
adjacent lanes.
For the system to operate correctly,
the side rear bumper area fig. 106
where the radar sensors are located
must stay free from snow, ice and dirt
gathered from the road surface.
Do not cover the side rear bumper
area fig. 106 where the radar sensors
are located with any object (e.g.
adhesives, bike rack, etc.).
Rear view
The system detects vehicles coming
from the rear part of the vehicle on both
sides and entering the rear detection
area fig. 107 with a difference in speed
of less than 50 km/h with respect to
your vehicle.
107
F1A0482
Overtaking vehicles
If another vehicle is overtaken slowly
fig. 108 (with a difference in speed
of less than about 25 km/h), the
warning light on the door mirror of the
corresponding side lights up.
If the difference in speed between the
two vehicles is greater than about
25 km/h, the warning light does not
light up.
109
108
F1A0481
RCP (Rear Cross Path detection)
function
This system helps the driver during
reverse manoeuvres.
The RCP system detects objects
moving towards both rear sides of the
vehicle at a speed of between 1 km/h
and 35 km/h, as is generally the case in
parking lots fig. 109.
F1A0484
The system activation is signalled to
the driver by means of a visual and
acoustic warning.
WARNING If the detection field of
sensors are covered by objects or
vehicles, the system will not warn the
driver.
BSA operation method
The system can be
activated/deactivated by operating
on the display Menu, or via the
Uconnect™ system (for further
information see the dedicated
supplement).
To turn the system on/off using the
display menu, access the Setup Menu
by pressing the MODE button on the
dashboard and scroll through the list
of settings using the
or
85
SAFETY
86
buttons. Select "Blind Spot". The
available methods are:
OFF;
DISPLAY;
SOUND & DISPLAY;
Blind Spot Assist "Display" mode
When this mode is active, the BSA
system sends a visual warning to the
respective door mirror on the side of
the detected obstacle.
However, when the RCP function is
on, the system produces acoustic
and visual warnings when an object is
detected.
When an acoustic warning is sent, the
volume of the radio is lowered.
Blind Spot Assist "Sound &
Display" mode
When this mode is active, the BSA
system sends a visual warning to the
respective door mirror on the side of
the detected object.
If the direction indicator on the side
where an obstacle has been detected
is activated, an acoustic warning is
emitted as well.
The volume of the radio is not turned
down.
During "RCP" operating mode, the
system emits acoustic and visual
indications if the presence of an object
is detected. When an acoustic warning
is sent the volume of the radio is also
turned down.
"Blind Spot Assist" system
deactivation
When the system is deactivated ("Blind
Spot" function set to "OFF" on the
instrument panel), the BSA or RCP
systems will not emit either acoustic
nor visual warnings.
The BSA system will store the
operating mode running when the
engine was stopped. Each time the
engine is started, the operating mode
stored previously will be recalled and
used.
70)
Trailer Detection
The system can detect the presence
and length of a trailer and extend the
blind spot warning zone to the length of
the trailer.
After the system detects the presence
of a trailer and the speed exceeds
10 km/h, a notification is sent to the
driver.
If a trailer is detected, the Rear Cross
Path function is deactivated.
The "Blind Spot" function on the
display Setup Menu can be used to
set the mode for detecting the trailer
length.
According to the set trailer length
detection mode, the corresponding
icon will be displayed:
with the "Max" setting selected.
The warning zone is set to the
maximum expected length (greater
than 9 metres);
,
or
with the "Auto"
setting selected. The system will
show an icon corresponding to the
automatically detected length (3 m,
6 m, 9 m). In this case, it may be
necessary to travel at least a curve
with a 90-degree rotation to let the
system detect the length of the trailer.
Once the length has been determined,
the icon corresponding to the length
measured in metres or feet will be
displayed depending on the selected
unit of measurement.
If the trailer is longer than 9 m, the
system will display the maximum length
icon and respective message.
If the vehicle is stationary for more than
120 seconds, the system detects the
trailer again:
if the trailer is no longer detected, the
icon indicating the presence and length
of the trailer disappears;
when set to "Auto", if a new trailer
is detected as present, with the same
length as the previous one (with an
error of 1 m), the length icon remains
unchanged;
When set to "Auto", if a new trailer is
detected as present, with a different
length from the previous one, the
length icon is updated.
WARNING
70) The system is an aid for driving the
vehicle, it DOES NOT warn the driver
about incoming vehicles outside of the
detection areas. The driver must always
maintain a sufficient level of attention to
the traffic and road conditions and for
controlling the trajectory of the vehicle.
TPMS (Tyre Pressure
Monitoring System)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
71) 72) 73) 74) 75) 76) 77) 78) 79)
DESCRIPTION
The tyre pressure monitoring system
(TPMS) warns the driver of low tyre
pressure on the basis of the cold
inflation pressure prescribed for the
vehicle.
Changes in outside temperature
may cause tyre pressure to vary.
This means that a decrease in the
outside temperature corresponds to a
decrease in the tyre pressure.
Tyre pressure must always be adjusted
according to the cold inflation pressure.
Cold tyre inflation pressure is the tyre
pressure after letting the vehicle stand
for at least three hours or a travel
shorter than 1.6 km after an interval of
three hours.
The cold tyre inflation pressure must
not exceed the maximum inflation
pressure value printed on the side of
the tyre.
The tyre pressure also increases while
driving the vehicle: this is a normal
condition and does not require any
adjustment of the pressure.
The TPMS continues to advise
the driver of the low tyre pressure
condition until this is corrected; the
warning continues until the pressure
corresponds or exceeds the pressure
prescribed for the cold tyres. When
the low tyre pressure check warning
light turns on continuously, the
inflation pressure must be adjusted until
it reaches the pressure prescribed for
cold tyres. After the automatic update
of the system, the tyre pressure control
warning light switches off. You may
need to drive the vehicle for about 20
minutes at a speed higher than 20
km/h to allow the TPMS to receive this
information.
NOTE
The TPMS does not replace the
normal tyre maintenance service and
does not indicate any fault in a tyre.
Therefore, the TPMS should not be
used as pressure switch while adjusting
the tyre inflation pressure.
Driving with insufficient tyre pressure
causes their overheating and can result
in tyre failure. The low inflation pressure
reduces fuel efficiency and tyre tread
life and may also affect handling and
braking performance of the vehicle.
The TPMS does not replace the
correct tyre maintenance. It is up to
the driver to maintain the correct
tyre pressure level measuring it with
a suitable pressure switch. This is
necessary even if the decrease in the
inflation pressure value does not cause
the tyre pressure control warning light
to switch on.
The TPMS warns the driver of any
condition of insufficient tyre pressure.
If this drops below the insufficient
pressure limit for any reason including
low temperature and normal pressure
loss of the tyre.
The seasonal temperature changes
affect tyre pressure.
The TPMS uses wireless devices with
electronic sensors mounted on the
wheel rims to constantly monitor the
value of tyre pressure. The sensors
mounted on each wheel as part of the
valve stem transmit various information
of the tyres to the receiver module, in
order to calculate the pressure.
87
SAFETY
WARNING Monitoring and maintaining
the correct pressure in all four tyres are
particularly important.
Tyre pressure monitoring system
low pressure warnings
The system warns the driver if one or
more tyres are flat by turning on the
warning light on the instrument panel
(together with a warning message and
an acoustic signal).
In this case, stop the vehicle as
soon as possible, check the inflation
pressure of each tyre and inflate
to the cold tyre pressure value
prescribed for the vehicle. The system
will automatically update and after
receiving the tyre pressure update the
tyre pressure control warning light
switches off. You may need to drive
the vehicle for about 20 minutes at a
speed higher than 20 km/h to allow the
system to receive this information.
TPMS operation faults
The system fault is indicated by the
corresponding warning light , which
first flashes for 75 seconds and then
stays on continuously. This can occur
in any of the following situations:
interference caused by electronic
devices or radio frequency emissions
similar to those of the TPMS sensors.
88
Application of tinted films which
interfere with the signals of the radio
waves.
Presence of snow or ice on the
wheels or the wheel arches.
Use of snow chains.
Use of wheels/tyres not equipped
with TPMS sensors.
The spare wheel is not equipped
with the tyre pressure control sensor.
Therefore, the tyre pressure is not
controlled by the system.
If the spare wheel replaces a
tyre with a pressure lower than the
insufficient pressure limit, an acoustic
signal will be emitted and the
warning light will turn on at the next
start-up.
When the original tyres is repaired or
replaced and it is mounted back on the
vehicle to replace the spare wheel, the
TPMS will update automatically and the
warning light will switch off, provided
that the pressure of none of the four
tyres is below the insufficient pressure
limit. You may need to drive the vehicle
for about 20 minutes at a speed higher
than 20 km/h to allow the TPMS to
receive this information.
WARNING
71) The TPMS is optimised for the
original tyres and wheels provided. TPMS
pressures and alerts have been defined
according to the size of the tyres mounted
on the vehicle. Using equipment with
different size, type or kind may cause
irregular system operation or sensor
damage. Non-original spare wheels can
damage the sensor. Do not use tyre
sealant or balancing weights if the vehicle
is equipped with TPMS as these may
damage the sensors.
72) If the system signals a pressure drop
on a specific tyre, it is recommended to
check the pressure on all four tyres.
73) The TPMS does not relieve the driver
from the obligation to check the tyre
pressure every month; it is not even to
be considered a replacing system for
maintenance or a safety system.
74) Tyre pressure must be checked with
tyres cold. Should it become necessary for
whatever reason to check pressure with
warm tyres, do not reduce pressure even
though it is higher than the prescribed
value, but repeat the check when tyres are
cold.
75) The TPMS cannot indicate sudden
tyre pressure drops (for example when a
tyre bursts). In this case, stop the vehicle,
braking with caution and avoiding abrupt
steering.
76) The system only warns that the tyre
pressure is low: it is not able to inflate
them.
77) Insufficient tyre inflation increases fuel
consumption, reduces the tread duration
and may affect your ability to drive the
vehicle safely.
78) Always refit the valve stem cap after
inspecting or adjusting tyre pressure. This
prevents dampness or dirt from entering
the valve stem and thus the pressure
control sensor from being damaged.
79) The tyre repair kit (Fix&Go) provided
with the vehicle (for versions/markets,
where provided) is compatible with the
TPMS sensors; using sealants not
equivalent with that in the original kit may
adversely affect its operation. If sealants
not equivalent with the original one are
used, it is recommended to have the
TPMS sensor operation checked by a
qualified repair centre.
is advisable to contact a Fiat Dealership
should the windscreen need to be
replaced.If the repair is carried out
at a specialist window replacement
centre, it is still necessary to go to a
Fiat Dealership to have the camera
calibrated.
OPERATION
The system is always active when the
vehicle is started. It can be deactivated
or re-activated by pressing the button
(A) fig. 110 on the dashboard (see
following description).
LANE DEPARTURE
WARNING (DRIVING
ADVISOR)
(lane crossing warning)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
80) 81) 82)
The Lane Departure Warning (Driving
Advisor) is a warning system that
notifies the driver if he/she crosses the
lane if distracted.
A video sensor, fitted on the
windscreen near the interior rear view
mirror, detects the lane demarcation
lines and the position of the vehicle in
relation to them.
WARNING On cars with Lane
Departure Warning (Driving Advisor), it
110
F1A0322
The LED on the button switches on
to confirm that the system has been
activated and a dedicated message
appears on the display.
When the system is activated, the LED
on the dedicated button is off. If the
user deactivates the system, the LED
on the button switches on constantly
and a dedicated message appears on
the display to confirm that the system
has been switched off.
The system is enabled at every
key cycle of the vehicle and starts
recognition of the operating conditions
(condition signalled to the driver when
the 2 direction warning lights and
on the instrument panel light up).
When the system recognises the
operating conditions, it becomes
active, i.e. it can assist the driver with
visual and acoustic warnings. Therefore
the two direction warning lights and
on the instrument panel switch off to
prevent excessively frequent warnings
while driving in towns or on winding
roads at low speeds.
WARNING If the operating conditions
are no longer present, the system
remains activated but inactive.
Therefore the driver is warned by
constant illumination of the 2 direction
indicator lights and on the
instrument panel.
OPERATING
CONDITIONS FOR
ACTIVATION
Once switched on, the system
becomes active only if the following
89
SAFETY
conditions are met:
front driving direction (reverse not
engaged);
the system does not detect any
error;
calibration in progress;
vehicle speed between 60 km/h and
the max. vehicle speed;
presence of lane demarcation lines
not deteriorated and visible on both
sides;
suitable visibility conditions;
straight line or wide radius bends;
sufficient field of vision condition
(safety distance from vehicle in front);
direction indicators not activated
in the lane exiting direction (e.g. right
lane exiting direction, right direction
indicator activated);
vehicle direction getting constantly
closer to the lane demarcation lines
(the vehicle trajectory is within the lane
demarcation lines);
vehicle not constantly next to the
lane demarcation line.
radio navigation system) along with the
corresponding direction warning light
( or ) lighting up.
If the driver turns on the direction
indicator in order to change lanes or for
overtaking, then the system will switch
off the driver warning.
If the driver keeps deliberately with the
lane change manoeuvre, the system
interrupts the warning, remaining
enabled if the operating conditions are
not satisfied or active if the operating
conditions are exceeded (see the
dedicated paragraph).
ACTIVATING/
DEACTIVATING
THE SYSTEM
Automatic mode
If the Start&Stop is active the system
deactivates automatically. The system
will reactivate and check its operating
conditions again after the vehicle has
been started.
When the system is active, if the vehicle
gets close to one of the limit lines or
one of the two lane demarcation lines,
the driver is warned with an acoustic
signal (coming from the crossed line
side if the vehicle is equipped with the
90
SWITCHING OFF THE
SYSTEM
Manual mode
The system can be switched off by
pressing button (A) fig. 110 on the
dashboard.
The LED on the button switches on
and a message appears on the display
to confirm that the system has been
switched off.
SYSTEM FAILURE
In the event of malfunction, the system
signals the fault to the driver with a
message on the display, an acoustic
warning and by turning on the
icon
on the display (for versions/markets,
where provided).
WARNINGS
The Driving Advisor cannot operate
due to a not perfectly balanced and
excessive load.
The operation of the system can be
adversely affected in some cases by
the morphology of the territory/road
being driven on (e.g. driving over
humps), poor visibility conditions
(e.g. fog, rain, snow), extreme
light conditions (e.g. glare of the
sun, darkness), lack of cleanliness
or damage, even partial, to the
windscreen in the area in front of the
camera.
The Driving Advisor cannot operate
following a malfunction of the following
safety systems: ABS, ESC, ASR and
Traction Plus.
The operation of the system can be
adversely affected by poor visibility
conditions (e.g. fog, rain, snow),
extreme light conditions (glare of
the sun, darkness), lack of cleaning
or damage, even partial, to the
windscreen in the area in front the
camera.
The area of the windscreen by the
camera must not be partly or totally
obscured by objects (e.g. stickers,
protective film, etc.).
WARNING
80) If the camera loses its position due to
a load variation, the system may not work
temporarily to allow the camera to perform
an auto-calibration.
81) The Driving Advisor is not an automatic
driving system and does not replace
the driver in controlling the trajectory
of the vehicle. The driver is personally
responsible for maintaining sufficient
attention for the traffic and road conditions
and for controlling the vehicle trajectory
safely.
82) In the case of indistinct, overlapping or
missing lane demarcation lines, the system
may not assist the driver: in this case the
Lane Departure Warning (Driving Advisor)
will be inactive.
91
SAFETY
TABLE SUMMARISING SIGNALS DURING THE USE OF THE LANE DEPARTURE
WARNING (DRIVING ADVISOR)
Status of the LED on
the button
Off
Message in the display
Status of the symbol
on the display
Acoustic warning
Meaning
–
–
–
system active (automatic
for each key cycle)
–
system active without
operating conditions met
–
system active and
operating conditions met:
the system can provide
acoustic-visual warnings
Yes
the system is active and
recognises the operating
conditions: it warns about
deviation from the left line
Yes
the system is active and
recognises the operating
conditions: it warns about
deviation from the right line
no
The system has been
switched off manually
Yes
The system is faulty: go to
a Fiat Dealership
warning lights
Off
Driving Advisor active
and
on fixed
Off
Driving Advisor active
Off
–
–
warning light
Blinking
Off
–
warning light
Blinking
92
On
Driving Advisor off
–
On
Driving Advisor not
available - see handbook
failure warning
Status of the LED on
the button
Message in the display
On
Driving Advisor not
available - clean the front
camera
Status of the symbol
on the display
failure warning
Acoustic warning
Meaning
Yes
system failure: clean the
windscreen
93
SAFETY
OCCUPANT
PROTECTION
SYSTEMS
Some of the most important safety
equipment of the vehicle comprises the
following protection systems:
seat belts;
SBR (Seat Belt Reminder) system;
head restraints;
child restraint systems;
Front airbags and side bags.
Read the information given the
following pages with the utmost care.
It is of fundamental importance that
the protection systems are used in the
correct way to guarantee the maximum
possible safety level for the driver and
the passengers.
For the description of the head restraint
adjustment see the "Head restraints"
paragraph in the "Knowing your
vehicle" chapter.
SEAT BELTS
IN BRIEF
All the seats in the vehicle are
equipped with seat belts with three
anchoring points and a retractor. The
reel mechanism operates locking the
belt in the event of sharp braking or
strong deceleration due to an impact.
This allows the belt strap to slide
freely and to adapt to the body of the
occupant. In the event of an accident,
the belt will lock to reduce the risk
of impact inside the passenger
compartment or of being projected
outside the vehicle. The driver is
responsible for respecting, and
ensuring that all the other occupants
of the vehicle also respect, the local
laws in force in relation to the use of
the seat belts. Always fasten the seat
belts before setting off.
USING THE SEAT BELTS
The belt should be worn keeping the
torso straight and rested against the
backrest.
To fasten the seat belts, hold fastening
tongue (A) fig. 111 and insert it into
buckle (B), until it clicks into place.
94
111
F1A0145
On removal, if the belt jams, let it
rewind for a short stretch, then pull it
out again without jerking.
Press button (C) fig. 111 to release the
belt. Guide the belt while it is rewinding
to prevent it from twisting.
The retractor may lock up when the
vehicle is parked on a steep slope: this
is perfectly normal.
Furthermore, the reel mechanism locks
the belt if it is pulled sharply or in the
event of sudden braking, collisions and
high-speed bends.
83)
HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT
(For versions/markets, where provided)
To adjust, press button (A) fig. 112 and
raise or lower the handle (B).
84) 85)
Always adjust the seat belt height to
the passenger's body. This precaution
may considerably reduce the risk of
injury in the event of a collision.
Correct adjustment is obtained when
the belt passes approximately half way
between the shoulder and the neck.
WARNING
83) Never press button (C) when travelling.
84) The height of the seat belts must be
adjusted with the vehicle stationary.
85) After adjustment, always check that
the cursor to which the ring is fastened
is locked in one of the preset positions.
To do this, with button released, press
downward more to allow the anchoring
device to click if it has not been released in
one of the possible positions.
SBR SYSTEM
112
F1A0146
Seat belt with retractor for front
central place on bench seat
The two-seater front bench is equipped
with an on-board seat belt (reel on
seat) with three anchorage points for
the central position fig. 113.
IN BRIEF
The vehicle is provided with a system
called SBR (Seat Belt Reminder),
composed of a buzzer which, along
with the flashing warning light
on the instrument panel, warns
the driver that their seat belt or (for
versions/markets, where provided) the
passenger's seat belt is not correctly
fastened.
PRE-TENSIONERS
To increase the protective efficiency of
the front seat belts, the vehicle is fitted
with pretensioners. These devices, in
the event of a head-on crash or side
impact, rewind the seat belts a few
centimetres. In this way, they ensure
that the belts fit tightly to the wearer
before the restraining action begins.
It is evident that the pretensioners
have been activated when the belt
withdraws toward the retractor.
A slight discharge of smoke may be
produced during the activation of the
pretensioner which is not harmful and
does not involve any fire hazard.
The pretensioner does not require any
maintenance or lubrication.
Any changes to its original conditions
will invalidate its efficiency. If, due to
unusual natural events (floods, sea
storms, etc.), the device has been
affected by water or mud, contact a
Fiat Dealership to have it replaced.
86)
13)
For permanent deactivation, contact a
Fiat Dealership.
With multifunction display, the SBR
system can also be reactivated through
the Setup menu.
113
WARNING To obtain the highest
degree of protection from the action of
the pretensioner, wear the seat belt
tight to the chest and pelvis.
F1A0147
95
SAFETY
LOAD LIMITERS
To increase passenger safety, the front
seat belt retractors contain a load
limiter which controls the force acting
on the chest and shoulders during the
belt restraining action in the event of a
head-on collision.
This device is present on all versions
with the exception of the version with
bench seat if no air bag is present.
GENERAL
INSTRUCTIONS FOR
USING THE SEAT BELTS
Seat belts are also to be worn by
pregnant women: the risk of injury in
the case of accident is greatly reduced
for them and the unborn child if they
are wearing a seat belt. Pregnant
women must position the lower part of
the belt very low down so that it passes
over the pelvis and under the abdomen
(see fig. 114).
While pregnancy progresses, the driver
must adjust both the seat and the
steering wheel to ensure full control
of the vehicle (pedals and steering
wheel must be easily accessible). The
maximum clearance should be kept
between the abdomen and the steering
wheel. The seat belt strap must
not be twisted. The upper part must
pass over the shoulder and cross the
chest diagonally. The lower part must
adhere to the pelvis fig. 115, not to the
96
abdomen of the occupant. Do not use
devices (clips, etc.) to hold the seat belt
away from your body.
87) 88) 89)
116
114
115
F1A0148
F1A0149
F1A0150
Each seat belt must be used by only
one person. Never travel with a child
sitting on the passenger's lap and
a single belt to protect them both
fig. 116. In general, do not place any
objects between the person and the
belt.
SEAT BELTS
MAINTENANCE
For keeping the seat belts in efficient
conditions, carefully observe the
following warnings:
always use the seat belt well
stretched and never twisted; make
sure that it is free to run without
obstructions;
check seat belt operation as follows:
attach the seat belt and pull it hard;
replace the belt after an accident of
a certain severity even if it does not
appear to be damaged. Always replace
the belt if the pretensioners were
deployed;
prevent the retractors from getting
wet: their correct operation is only
guaranteed if water does not get inside;
replace the seat belt when it shows
wear or cuts.
WARNING
86) The pretensioner may be used only
once. After it is triggered, have it replaced
at a Fiat Dealership.
87) For maximum safety, keep the
backrest upright, lean back into it and
make sure the seat belt fits closely across
your chest and pelvis. Always fasten the
seat belts on both the front and the rear
seats! Travelling without wearing seat belts
will increase the risk of serious injury and
even death in the event of an accident.
88) Removing or tampering with seat
belt and pretensioner components is
strictly prohibited. Any intervention on
these components must be performed
by qualified and authorised technicians.
Always go to a Fiat Dealership.
89) If the belt has been sharply pulled, for
example as the result of an accident, the
seat belt, together with the anchoring
devices, the anchoring device fixing
screws and the pretensioner must be
completely replaced. Even if the belt does
not present any exterior signs of wear or
damage, it may have lost its restraining
properties.
IMPORTANT
13) Operations which lead to impacts,
vibrations or localised heating (over 100°C
for a maximum of six hours) in the area
around the pretensioners may damage or
deploy them. Contact a Fiat Dealership
should intervention be necessary on these
components.
CARRYING
CHILDREN SAFELY
For optimal protection in the event
of an impact, all occupants must
be seated and wearing adequate
restraint systems, including newborn
and other children! This prescription
is compulsory in all EC countries
according to EC Directive 2003/20/EC.
Children below the height of 1.50
metres and up to 12 years must be
protected with suitable restraint
systems and be seated on the rear
seats. Statistics on accidents indicate
that the rear seats offer greater safety
for children. Compared with adults, a
child's head is proportionally larger and
heavier than the rest of the body, while
muscles and bone structure are not
fully developed. Therefore, correct
restraint systems other than adult seat
belts are necessary, to reduce as
much as possible the risk of injuries in
the event of an accident, braking or
sudden manoeuvre. Children must be
seated safely and comfortably.
As far as the characteristics of the child
seats used allow, you are advised to
keep children in rear facing child seats
for as long as possible (at least until
3–4 years old), since this is the most
protected position in the event of an
impact. The choice of the most suitable
child restraint system depends on the
weight and size of the child.
There are various types of child
restraint systems that can be secured
to the vehicle by means of the seat
belts or with the ISOFIX anchorages. It
is recommended to always choose the
restraint system most suitable for the
child; for this reason always refer to the
Owner Handbook provided with the
child restraint system, to be sure that it
is of the right type for the children it is
intended for.
In Europe the characteristics of child
restraint systems are ruled by the
regulation ECE-R44, dividing them into
five weight groups:
Group
Weight groups
Group 0
up to 10 kg in weight
Group 0+
up to 13 kg in weight
97
SAFETY
Group
Weight groups
Group 1
9-18 kg
Group 2
15 - 25 kg
Group 3
22 - 36 kg
As you can see, the groups overlap
partly and, in fact, there are devices on
sale that cover more than one weight
group.
All restraint devices must bear the typeapproval data, together with the control
mark, on a label solidly fixed to the
child restraint system which must never
be removed.
Over 1.50 m in height, from the point of
view of restraint systems, children are
considered as adults and wear the seat
belts normally.
Lineaccessori MOPAR includes
child restraint systems for each
weight group. These devices are
recommended, having been specifically
designed for Fiat cars.
fig. 117 and it must restrain the child in
turn with its own belts.
91) 92) 93) 94) 95) 96) 97)
92) 93) 94) 95) 96)
117
F1A0151
GROUP 1
Children from 9 kg to 18 kg in weight
can be carried facing forwards if the
child seat is fitted with a front cushion,
through which the vehicle seat belt
restrains both child and seat fig. 118.
92) 93) 94) 95) 96) 97)
119
98
F1A0153
GROUP 3
For children from 22 kg to 36 kg in
weight the size of the child's chest no
longer requires a support to space the
child's back from the backrest.
The fig. 120 shows the correct child
positioning on the rear seat.
90)
GROUPS 0 and 0+
Babies up to 13 kg must be carried
facing backwards on a cradle seat,
which, supporting the head, does not
induce stress on the neck in the event
of sharp decelerations.
The cradle is restrained by the seat
belts of the vehicle, as shown in
GROUP 2
Children from 15 to 25 kg may use
the seat belts of the vehicle directly
fig. 119.
The child restraint system is now
needed only to position the child
correctly with respect to the belts so
that the diagonal section crosses the
child's chest and never the neck, and
the lower part is snug on the pelvis not
the abdomen.
118
92) 93) 94) 95) 96)
F1A0152
120
F1A0154
Children over 1.50 m in height can
wear seat belts like adults.
WARNING
90) Do not place a rear-facing cradle
seat on the front seat if the passenger
side airbag is enabled. Deployment of
the airbag in an accident could cause
fatal injuries to the child regardless of the
severity of the impact. It is advisable to
always carry children in a child restraint
system on the rear seat, which is the
most protected position in the event
of a collision. If you need to carry a
child on the front passenger seat in a
rear-facing cradle restraint system, the
passenger side airbags (front and side
bags for chest/pelvis protection, for
versions/markets, where provided) must
be deactivated using the setup menu. It
is important to check the dedicated LED
on the dashboard to make
on button
sure that they are actually deactivated.
Move the passenger's seat as far back
as possible to avoid contact between the
child seat and the dashboard.
91) On the sun visor there is a label with
suitable symbols reminding the user that
it is compulsory to deactivate the airbag if
a rearward facing child restraint system is
fitted. Always comply with the instructions
on the passenger side sun visor (see the
"Supplementary Restraint System (SRS) Airbag" paragraph).
92) Do not move the front or rear seat if
a child is seated on it or on the dedicated
child restraint system.
93) Incorrect fitting of the child restraint
system may result in an inefficient
protection system. In the event of an
accident the child restraint system may
become loose and the child may be
injured, even fatally. When fitting a restraint
system for newborns or children, strictly
comply with the instructions provided by
the Manufacturer.
94) When the child restraint system is not
used, secure it with the seat belt or with
the ISOFIX anchorages, or remove it from
the vehicle. Do not leave it unsecured
inside the passenger compartment. In this
way, in the event of sudden braking or an
accident, it will not cause injuries to the
occupants.
95) Always make sure that the diagonal
section of the seat belt does not pass
under the arms or behind the back of the
child. In the event of an accident the seat
belt will not be able to secure the child,
with the risk of injury, including fatal injury.
Therefore the child must always wear the
seat belt correctly.
96) The diagrams are indicative and
provided for assembly purposes only. Fit
the child restraint system according to the
instructions, which must be included.
97) Car seats for weight groups 0 and 1
feature an anchor in front of the vehicle
safety belts as well as its own belts to
restrain the child. Due to their weight, they
may be dangerous if incorrectly mounted
(e.g. if fastened to the vehicle seat belts
placing a cushion in between). Follow the
assembly instructions carefully.
99
SAFETY
PASSENGER SEAT COMPLIANCE FOR USING UNIVERSAL CHILD SEATS
The vehicle complies with the new European Directive 2000/3/EC which governs the arrangement possibilities for child restraint
systems on the seats of a vehicle as shown in the following table (the table refers to the Van, Combi and Panorama versions):
Group
Weight groups
CAB
1st and 2nd REAR SEATS ROW
Single or two-seater seat (1 or 2
passengers) (*)
Rear left side
passenger
Rear right side
passenger
Central
passenger
Airbag enabled
Airbag disabled
Up to 13 kg
X
U
U
U
U
Group 1
9 - 18 kg
X
U
U
U
U
Group 2
15 - 25 kg
U
U
U
U
U
Group 3
22–36 kg
U
U
U
U
U
Group 0, 0+
X restraint system not suitable for children in this weight category.
U suitable for child restraint systems of the "Universal" category, according to European Standard ECE-R44 for the specified "Groups".
* IMPORTANT: NEVER fit rearward-facing child restraint systems on the front seat with an active passenger airbag. If you wish to fit a
rearward-facing child seat in the front passenger seat, first deactivate the respective airbag (see instructions in the paragraph Supplementary
protection system (SRS) – Airbag").
100
SETUP FOR
“UNIVERSAL
ISOFIX" CHILD
RESTRAINT SYSTEM
The vehicle is set up for fitting an
ISOFIX child restraint system.
The ISOFIX system lets you install the
ISOFIX child restraining system quickly,
simply and safely, without using the
vehicle seat belts, but by connecting
the child restrain system directly to
the vehicle seat with three anchors in
the vehicle. Traditional child restraint
systems can be fitted alongside ISOFIX
child restraint systems on different
seats in the same vehicle.
To install an ISOFIX child restraint
system, attach it to the two metal
anchorings (A) fig. 121 located where
the rear seat cushion meets the
backrest, then fix the upper strap
(available together with the restraint
system) to the dedicated anchoring (B)
fig. 122 located at the bottom behind
the backrest.
fig. 124 shows an example of a
Universal ISOFIX child restraint system
for weight group 1.
121
F1A0156
123
F1B0117C
122
F1A0157
124
F1A0155
WARNING When a Universal ISOFIX
child restraint system is used, only ECE
R44 "ISOFIX Universal" (R44/03 or
further upgrades) type-approved child
restraint systems can be used fig. 123.
WARNING The fig. 124 is indicative
and for assembly purposes only. Fit the
child restraint system according to the
instructions, which must be included.
WARNING
98) Fit the child restraint system only when
the vehicle is stationary. The child restraint
system is correctly fixed to the brackets
when you hear the click. Follow the
instructions for assembly, disassembly and
positioning that the Manufacturer must
supply with the child restraint system.
98) 99) 100) 101)
101
SAFETY
102
99) Fiat Professional recommends fitting
the child restraint system according to the
instructions, which must be included.
100) Do not use the same lower anchoring
to install more than one child restraint
system.
101) If a Universal ISOFIX child restraint
system is not fixed to all three anchorages,
it will not be able to protect the child
correctly. In a crash, the child could be
seriously or fatally injured.
SUITABILITY OF PASSENGER SEATS FOR USE WITH ISOFIX CHILD SEATS
The table below shows the different installation possibilities for "Universal Isofix" child restraint systems on the seats fitted with
ISOFIX attachments, in accordance with European regulation ECE 16.
Weight group
Portable cradle
Group 0 (up to 10 kg)
Group 0+ (up to 13 kg)
Group 1 (from 9 up to 18
kg)
Child restraint system
position
Isofix size class
Rear side ISOFIX
position, 1st row
(PANORAMA)
Rear side ISOFIX
position, 1st row
(COMBI)
Rear facing
F
X
X
Rear facing
G
X
X
Rear facing
E
IL
IL
Rear facing
E
IL
IL
Rear facing
D
IL
IL
Rear facing
C
IL
IL
Rear facing
D
IL
IL
Rear facing
C
IL
IL
Forward facing
B
IUF
IUF
Forward facing
B1
IUF
IUF
Forward facing
A
IUF
IUF
X: ISOFIX position not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this group of weight and/or size class.
IL: suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems of the "Specific for the vehicle", "Restricted", or "Semiuniversal" categories, approved for this type
of vehicle.
IUF: suitable for forward facing ISOFIX child restraint systems of the universal category, approved for use in the weight group.
WARNING The bench seat and the Crew Cab Van version 4-seater seat are not suitable for positioning a child restraint system.
103
SAFETY
104
NOTE: The other weight groups are covered by specific ISOFIX child restraint systems, which can only be used if specifically
tested for this vehicle (see list of vehicles provided with the child restraint system).
i-Size CHILD RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS
These child restraint systems, built and
type-approved according to the i-Size
(ECE R129) standard, ensure better
safety conditions to carry children on
board a vehicle:
the child must be transported
rearward facing until 15 months;
child restraint system protection
is increased in the event of a side
collision;
the use of the ISOFIX system is
promoted to avoid faulty installation of
the child restraint system;
efficiency in the choice of the child
restraint system, which isn't made
according to weight any more but
according to the child's height, is
increased;
compatibility between the vehicle
seats and the child restraint systems is
better: the i-Size child restraint systems
can be considered as "Super ISOFIX";
this means that they can be perfectly
fitted in type-approved i-Size seats, but
can also be fitted in ISOFIX (ECE R44)
type-approved seats.
125
J0A0450
WARNING See the table shown on the
following page to check whether your
vehicle is approved for installing i-Size
child restraint systems.
WARNING If your vehicle seats are iSize approved, the fig. 125symbol will
appear on the seats near the ISOFIX
attachments.
105
SAFETY
The following table, according to European standard ECE 129, indicates the possibility of i-Size child restraint system
installation.
i-Size POSITIONS ON THE VEHICLE
i-Size child restraint systems
Device
Front passenger
Rear side
passengers
Rear central
passenger
ISO/R2
X
X
X
ISO/F2
X
X
X
X: seat not suitable for Universal i-Size child restraint systems.
WARNING This vehicle is not approved for use with i-Size child restraint systems. Despite this, it may be possible to install an
"i-Size" child restraint system. Check compatibility of this vehicle with the child restraint system on the manufacturer's Internet
website.
106
CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEMS RECOMMENDED BY FIAT PROFESSIONAL FOR YOUR
NEW DUCATO
In the markets in which they are available, Lineaccessori MOPAR offers a complete range of child restraint systems to be fixed
using the seat belt with three anchor points or the ISOFIX anchorages.
WARNING FCA recommends fitting the child restraint system according to the instructions, which must be included
102) 103) 104) 105)
Weight group
Child restraint system
Type of child restraint system
Child restraint system installation
BeSafe iZi Go Modular
Fiat order code: 71808564
Group 0+: from birth to 13
kg
from 40 cm to 80 cm
+
+
Universal/i-Size child restraint system.
It must be installed facing rearwards,
using the vehicle seat belts only, or the
dedicated i-Size base (which can be
purchased separately) and the vehicle
ISOFIX anchorages.
It must be fitted on the rear outer seats.
BeSafe iZi Modular i-Size Base
Fiat order code: 71808566
107
SAFETY
Weight group
Child restraint system
Type of child restraint system
Child restraint system installation
BeSafe iZi Modular i-Size
Fiat order code: 71808565
Group 0+/1: from 9 up to
18 kg
from 67 cm to 105 cm
+
+
The approved i-Size child restraint system
that must be installed in the vehicle
together with the underneath iZi Modular
i-Size Base, which can be purchased
separately. It can be installed facing
forwards or facing backwards (refer to the
child restraint system manual)
It must be fitted on the rear outer seats.
BeSafe iZi Modular i-Size Base
Fiat order code: 71808566
Group 2: from 15 kg to 25
kg
from 95 cm to 135 cm
108
Britax Römer KidFix XP
It can only be fitted facing forwards, using
the three-point seat belt and the ISOFIX
anchorages, if present. FCA recommends
installing it using the ISOFIX anchor
points of the vehicle.
It must be fitted on the rear outer seats.
Weight group
Group 3: from 22 kg to 36
kg
from 136 cm to 150 cm
Child restraint system
Type of child restraint system
Britax Römer KidFix XP
Child restraint system installation
It can only be fitted facing forwards, using
the three-point seat belt and the ISOFIX
anchorages, if present. FCA recommends
installing it using the ISOFIX anchor
points of the vehicle.
It must be fitted on the rear outer seats.
WARNING
102) Fit the child restraint system only when the vehicle is stationary. The child restraint system is correctly fixed to the brackets when you
hear the click. Follow the instructions for assembly, disassembly and positioning that the Manufacturer must supply with the child restraint
system.
103) Fiat Professional recommends fitting the child restraint system according to the instructions, which must be included.
104) Do not use the same lower anchoring to install more than one child restraint system.
105) If a Universal ISOFIX child restraint system is not fixed to all three anchorages, it will not be able to protect the child correctly. In a crash,
the child could be seriously or fatally injured.
109
SAFETY
110
Main recommendations to carry
children safely
The recommended position for
installing child restraint systems is
on the rear seat, as it is the most
protected area in the event of an
impact.
Keep children in rearward facing
child restraint systems for as long as
possible, until 3–4 years old if possible.
If the passenger front airbag is
deactivated, always check the
corresponding LED on the button
on the instrument panel to make sure
that it has actually been deactivated.
Carefully follow the instructions that
come with the child seat, which the
manufacturer must supply. Keep the
instructions in the vehicle along with
the other papers and this handbook.
Do not use second-hand child seats
without instructions.
Always check that the seat belt is
well fastened by pulling on it.
Only one child is to be strapped
into each restraint system; never carry
two children using one child restraint
system.
Always check that seat belts do not
rest on the child’s neck.
While travelling, do not let the child
sit incorrectly or unfasten the belts.
Never carry children on your lap,
even newborns. No-one can hold a
child in the case of a crash.
Never allow a child to put the belt's
diagonal section under an arm or
behind their back.
If the vehicle has been involved in
a road accident, replace the child
restraint system with a new one. In
addition, and depending on the type of
child restraint system installed, replace
the Isofix anchorages or the seat belt
with which the child restraint system
was connected.
The rear headrest can be removed
if needed to install a child restraint
system. The head restraint must always
be fitted in the vehicle if the seat is
used by an adult passenger or a child
sitting in a restraint system without
backrest.
SUPPLEMENTARY
RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(SRS) - AIRBAG
The vehicle may be equipped with:
driver front airbag;
front passenger airbag;
front side bags to protect the pelvis
and chest of the driver and passenger;
window bags to protect the heads of
the front seat occupants.
The airbag locations on the vehicle
are marked by the word "AIRBAG" in
the middle of the steering wheel, on
the dashboard, on the side lining or
on a label placed next to the airbag
deployment area.
FRONT AIRBAGS
The front airbags protect the front seat
occupants in the event of a mediumhigh severity frontal impact, by placing
the bag between the occupant and the
steering wheel or dashboard.
Therefore, non-activation in other
types of collisions (side collisions, rear
shunts, roll-overs, etc.) is not a system
malfunction.
An electronic control unit will make
the bag inflate in the event of a frontal
impact.
The bag will inflate instantaneously
placing itself between the front
occupants body and the structures
which could cause injury. It will deflate
immediately afterwards.
Front airbags are not a replacement of
but complementary to the seat belts,
which you are recommended to always
wear, as specified by law in Europe and
most non-European countries.
In the event of an impact, someone not
wearing a seat belt could move forward
and come into contact with a bag
which is still opening. The protection
offered by the bag is compromised in
these circumstances.
Front airbags may not activate in the
following situations:
frontal impacts against highly
deformable objects not involving the
front surface of the vehicle (e.g. wing
collision against guard rail, etc.);
when the vehicle is wedged under
other vehicles or protective barriers
(e.g. under a lorry or a guardrail);
Failure to deploy in the conditions
described above is due to the fact
that the airbags may not provide any
additional protection compared with
seat belts, so their activation would
be inappropriate. In these cases,
non-deployment does not indicate a
system malfunction.
occupants wearing seat belts. At
their maximum inflation, their volume
fills most of the space between the
steering wheel and the driver and
between the dashboard and the
passenger.
The airbags are not deployed in the
event of minor frontal impacts (for
which the restraining action of the seat
belts is sufficient).
Seat belts must always be worn. In the
event of a frontal collision, they ensure
the correct positioning of the occupant.
DRIVER'S FRONT
AIRBAG
This consists of an instant-inflating bag
contained in a special compartment
in the centre of the steering wheel
fig. 126.
PASSENGER SIDE
FRONT AIRBAG
(for versions/markets, where provided)
This consists of an instantly inflating
bag contained in a special recess in
the dashboard fig. 127: this bag has
a larger volume than that on the driver
side.
127
F1A0159
PASSENGER'S FRONT
AIRBAG AND CHILD
RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
107)
126
F1A0312
Rearward facing child restraint systems
must NEVER be fitted on the front seat
with an active passenger airbag since
in the event of an impact the airbag
activation may cause fatal injuries to the
transported child.
106)
The driver's and passenger's front
airbags have been designed and
calibrated to protect front seat
111
SAFETY
protection status. If the LED is off, the
passenger side protection is activated.
When the front passenger airbag and
side bag (for versions/markets, where
provided) are activated again, the
warning light turns off.
128
F0T0950
ALWAYS comply with the instructions
on the label stuck on the passenger
side sun visor fig. 128.
Manual deactivation of front
passenger side airbag and side bag
(for versions/markets, where provided)
If a child must necessarily be carried
on the front seat in a rear-facing
child restraint system, the front
passenger airbag and side bag (for
versions/markets, where provided) can
be deactivated.
WARNING To manually deactivate the
front passenger airbag and side bag
(for versions/markets, where provided),
refer to the explanations provided in the
"Display" paragraph in the "Knowing
the instrument panel" chapter. The LED
on the button switches on in case of
deactivation.The LED that corresponds
fig. 129 on the
to the symbol
dashboard indicates the passenger's
112
The LED is tested also for markets
where the passenger protection
deactivation is not provided, and the
LED switches on for less than one
second when the key is turned to MAR,
and then switches off again. The
warning light may light up with various
intensity levels depending on the
vehicle conditions. The intensity may
also vary during the same key cycle.
WARNING
129
F1A0374
When the vehicle is started (key in
MAR position), the LED turns on for
approx. 8 seconds, provided that at
least 5 seconds have elapsed from the
previous switching off. If not, contact a
Fiat Dealership.
If the vehicle is switched off/on again
in less than 5 seconds the LED may
remain off. In this case, to check
correct LED operation, switch the
vehicle off, wait at least 5 seconds and
switch on again.
During the first 8 seconds, the
activation of the LED does not actually
show the passenger protection status,
but only checks its correct operation.
106) Do not apply stickers or other objects
to the steering wheel, the dashboard in the
passenger side airbag area and the seats.
Never put objects (e.g. mobile phones) on
the passenger side of the dashboard since
they could interfere with correct inflation
of the passenger airbag and also cause
serious injury to the passengers.
107) When there is an active passenger
airbag, DO NOT install rearward facing
child restraint systems on the front seat.
Deployment of the airbag in a crash could
cause fatal injuries to the child regardless
of the severity of the collision. Therefore,
always deactivate the passenger side
airbag when a rearward facing child
restraint system is installed on the front
passenger seat. The front passenger seat
must also be positioned back as far as
possible in order to prevent the child
restraint system from coming into contact
with the dashboard. Immediately reactivate
the passenger airbag as soon as the child
restraint system has been removed.
PASSENGER'S FRONT AIRBAG AND CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEMS: IMPORTANT
130
F1A0387
113
SAFETY
SIDE BAGS
108) 109) 110) 111) 112) 113) 114) 115) 116) 117) 118)
119) 120) 121)
To help increase occupant protection
in the event of a side impact, for
versions/markets where provided, the
vehicle is equipped with front side bags
and window bags.
Side bags (for versions/markets where
provided) protect occupants from side
impacts of medium-high severity, by
placing the bag between the occupant
and the internal parts of the side
structure of the vehicle. Non-activation
of side bags in other types of collisions
(front collisions, rear shunts, roll-overs,
etc.) is not a system malfunction.
An electronic control unit causes
the bags to inflate in the event of a
side-on collision. The bags inflate
instantaneously, placing themselves
between the occupant's body and the
structures which could cause injury.
They deflate immediately afterwards.
Side bags (for versions/markets where
provided) are not a replacement of but
complementary to the belts, which you
are recommended to always wear, as
specified by law in Europe and most
non-European countries.
FRONT SIDE BAGS FOR
CHEST PROTECTION
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Housed in the seat backrests fig. 131,
they are composed of an instantly
inflating bag, which serves to protect
the occupants' chest and pelvis in the
event of a medium-high severity side
impact.
132
F1A0333
Window bags have been designed for
protecting the head of front occupants
in the event of side impact, thanks to
the wide bag inflation surface.
131
F1A0160
WINDOW BAGS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
They consist of two curtain bags, one
on the right and the other on the left
side of the vehicle, located behind the
side coverings of the roof and covered
by special finishing fig. 132.
WARNING In the event of a side-on
crash, the system offers best
protection if you keep a correct position
on the seat because this allows the
side bags to inflate correctly.
WARNING The front airbags and/or
side bags may be deployed if the
vehicle is subject to heavy knocks or
accidents involving the underbody
area, such as for example violent
shocks, against steps, kerbs or low
obstacles, vehicle falling into big
potholes or depressions in the road.
WARNING A small amount of dust
will be released when the airbags are
114
deployed. The dust is not harmful and
does not indicate the beginning of a
fire. Furthermore, the surface of the
deployed bag and the interior of the
vehicle may be covered in a dusty
residue: this may irritate your skin and
eyes. Wash with mild soap and water in
the event of exposure.
WARNING Should an accident occur
in which any of the safety devices
are activated, take the vehicle to a
Fiat Dealership to have the activated
devices replaced and to have the whole
system checked. Every control, repair
and replacement operation concerning
the airbags must be carried out only
at Fiat Dealerships. If you are having
the vehicle scrapped, have the system
deactivated at a Fiat Dealership first.
If the vehicle changes ownership, the
new owner must be informed of how
to use the airbags and the above
warnings and also be given this "Owner
Handbook".
WARNING Pretensioners, front airbags
and front side bags are deployed
differently according to the type of
collision. Failure to activate one or more
of the devices does not indicate a
system malfunction.
WARNING
108) Never rest head, arms and elbows
on the doors, on the windows and in the
window bag head protection area to
prevent possible injuries during inflation
phase.
109) Never lean your head, arms or
elbows out of the window.
110) If when turning the key to MAR
does not turn on
the warning light
or if it stays on while driving (together
with the message on the multifunction
display, for versions/markets, where
provided), there could be an anomaly in
the safety systems; in this event, airbags
or pretensioners may not trigger in
the case of an accident or, in a lower
number of cases, they could be triggered
accidentally. Contact a Fiat Dealership
immediately to have the system checked.
111) Do not cover the backrest of the front
or rear seats with covers which are not
suitable for use with side bags.
112) Do not travel with objects in your lap,
in front of your chest or held in your mouth
(e.g., pipe, pencil etc.). They could cause
severe injury if the airbag is deployed in a
crash.
113) The airbag must be able to inflate
without obstruction in the event of
deployment. It is therefore recommended
not to drive with the body bent forward,
but to sit up resting your back and
shoulders on the backrest of the seat.
Adjusting the position of the seat so that
you can reach and manoeuvre the steering
wheel comfortably with your arms slightly
bent being as far away as possible from
the steering wheel. Being too close to
the steering wheel when the airbag is
deployed may cause serious injury.
114) The airbags may also be deployed
when the vehicle is not moving, if the
ignition key is inserted and turned to MAR
even when the engine is off, if the vehicle is
hit by another moving vehicle. Therefore,
even if the vehicle is stationary, when an
active front passenger airbag is fitted,
DO NOT install rear facing child restraint
systems on the front passenger seat.
Deployment of the airbag following an
impact could cause fatal injuries to the
child. Therefore, always deactivate the
passenger side airbag when a rearward
facing child restraint system is installed
on the front passenger seat. The front
passenger seat must also be positioned
back as far as possible in order to prevent
the child restraint system from coming into
contact with the dashboard. Immediately
reactivate the passenger airbag as soon
as the child restraint system has been
removed. Also remember that, if the key
is turned to STOP, none of the safety
devices (airbags or pretensioners) will
be deployed in the event of collision.
Non-deployment in such cases does not
indicate a system malfunction.
115) Have the airbag system checked by
a Fiat Dealership if the vehicle was stolen,
if theft was attempted, or if the vehicle was
subjected to vandalism or flooding.
116) By turning the ignition key to MAR
position, the LED on the
button located
on the dashboard lights up (the time it
stays lit up can vary depending on the
market), to check that the button LED is
working correctly.
115
SAFETY
116
117) Do not wash the seats with water or
pressurised steam (wash by hand or at
automatic seat washing stations).
118) The front airbag deployment
threshold is higher than that of the
pretensioners. For impacts whose intensity
falls between the two levels, normally, only
the pretensioners will be activated.
119) Do not affix rigid objects to the coat
hooks or support handles.
120) The airbag does not replace seat
belts but increases their efficiency.
Furthermore, since front airbags are not
deployed in low-speed frontal impacts,
side impacts, rear shunts or roll-overs, the
passengers are protected only by the seat
belts which must therefore be fastened at
all times.
121) In some versions, in case of LED
failure
OFF (located on the plate of
the instrument panel), the light on the
console turns on
and the passenger
side airbags are deactivated. On some
ON
versions, in case of failure of the
LED (located on the dashboard), warning
light
appears on the instrument panel.
STARTING AND DRIVING
Let’s get to the core of the vehicle:
seeing how you can exploit all of its
potential to the full.
We’ll look at how to drive it safely in any
situation, so that it can be a welcome
companion, with our comfort and our
wallets in mind.
STARTING THE ENGINE .............
WHEN PARKED .........................
MANUAL TRANSMISSION ..........
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION .....
"DRIVE MODE" FUNCTION..........
START&STOP SYSTEM ..............
CRUISE CONTROL (constant
speed regulator) .........................
ENGINE IDLE PRESET ................
SPEED BLOCK ..........................
PARKING SENSORS ..................
REAR CAMERA (PARKVIEW®
REAR BACK UP CAMERA) ..........
TRAFFIC SIGN RECOGNITION.....
FULL BRAKE CONTROL
SYSTEM ...................................
SAVING FUEL............................
REFUELLING THE VEHICLE ........
AdBlue® (UREA) ADDITIVE FOR
DIESEL EMISSIONS ...................
VERSION WITH METHANE
SYSTEM (Natural Power) .............
LOADING ADVICE ......................
TOWING TRAILERS....................
VEHICLE INACTIVITY..................
118
119
121
122
125
125
126
128
129
130
131
132
133
137
137
141
142
143
144
150
117
STARTING AND DRIVING
STARTING THE
ENGINE
The vehicle is fitted with an electronic
engine lock device: if the engine fails
to start, see the paragraph “The Fiat
CODE system” in section “Know your
vehicle”.
Before starting the vehicle, adjust the
seat, the interior rear view mirrors, the
door mirrors and fasten the seat belts
correctly. Never press the accelerator
pedal for starting the engine.
WARNING If the accelerator pedal
and the brake pedal are accidentally
pressed at the same time, the system
will consider the braking request
has having a higher priority. In this
condition, the engine will switch to
recovery mode and performance
(engine torque and vehicle speed) will
be limited. To restore normal operation,
simply release the accelerator pedal. It
is not necessary to stop and start the
engine.
122)
14) 15)
PROCEDURE FOR
VERSIONS WITH MANUAL
TRANSMISSION
Proceed as follows:
engage the handbrake;
put the gear lever into neutral;
turn the ignition key to MAR: the
warning lights
and
on the
instrument panel will turn on;
wait for the warning lights
and
to switch off. The hotter the engine is,
the quicker this will happen;
fully depress the clutch pedal without
touching the accelerator;
turn the ignition key to AVV as soon
switches off.
as warning light
Waiting too long will waste the heating
work carried out by the plugs.
Release the key as soon as the engine
starts.
16)
PROCEDURE
FOR VERSIONS
WITH AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
Starting the engine is allowed only
when the gear lever is in position P or
N, so when the engine is started, the
system is at position N or P (the latter
means neutral, but the vehicle wheels
are locked mechanically).
16)
118
DRIVING OFF IN THE VEHICLE
To move the vehicle, from position
P press the brake pedal and move
the lever to the desired position (D or
"Sequential mode") to move forward
or R to engage reverse). The display
will show the gear engaged. When the
brake pedal is released, the vehicle
starts moving forwards or backwards,
as soon as the manoeuvre is activated
("creeping" effect). The accelerator
should not be pressed in this case.
WARNING The inconsistency between
the speed actually engaged (shown
on the display) and the position of
the gear lever is indicated by the
letter corresponding to the position of
the gear lever flashing on the panel
(also accompanied by an acoustic
warning). This condition should not be
interpreted as an operational fault, but
simply as a request by the system to
repeat the manoeuvre.
WARNING With the parking brake
released and brake pedal released,
engine at idling speed and gear lever
in position D, R or sequential, pay
the utmost care because the car can
move even without the operation of
the accelerator pedal. This condition
can be used with the vehicle on a
level surface during tight parking
manoeuvres using the brake pedal
only.
carbon dioxide, carbon monoxide and
other toxic gasses.
IMPORTANT
17)
PROCEDURE FOR
NATURAL POWER
VERSIONS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The various engine cranking methods
are described below:
METHANE tank not in reserve –
petrol tank not empty: the engine starts
with methane supply;
METHANE tank empty – petrol tank
not empty: the engine is forced to
start on petrol and it will not switch
to methane until the methane tank
has been filled. At the same time,
the reserve warning light will turn on
and the "REFUELLING REQUIRED"
message will be shown on the
instrument panel display;
METHANE tank not in reserve –
petrol tank empty: the engine starts
with methane supply.
18) 19) 20) 21) 16)
WARNING
122) It is dangerous to run the engine in
enclosed areas. The engine consumes
oxygen and engine exhaust contains
14) It is advisable not to demand
maximum performance from your
vehicle (e.g. excessive acceleration, long
distances at high speeds, excessive
intense braking, etc.) during the initial
period of use.
15) When the engine is switched off
never leave the ignition device in the
MAR position to prevent useless current
absorption from draining the battery.
16) In some cases, when the engine
switches off, the fan could activate for
max. 120 seconds.
17) If the engine fails to start with a gear
engaged, the potentially dangerous
situation due to the fact that the
transmission is automatically placed in
neutral will be signalled by a buzzer.
18) If the
warning light flashes for
60 seconds after starting or during an
extended towing period, this indicates an
anomaly in the glow plug preheating
system. Use the vehicle normally if the
engine starts, but contact a Fiat Dealership
as soon as possible.
19) Remember that the brake servo and
power steering are not operational until the
engine has been started, so you need to
apply much more force than usual to the
brake pedal and steering wheel.
20) Never bump start the engine by
pushing, towing or coasting downhill. This
could cause fuel to flow into the catalytic
converter and damage it beyond repair.
21) A quick burst on the accelerator before
stopping the engine serves no practical
purpose; it wastes fuel and is especially
damaging to turbocharged engines.
WHEN PARKED
123)
22)
Proceed as follows when parking and
leaving the vehicle:
engage a gear (1st gear if facing
uphill or reverse if facing downhill) and
leave the wheels turned;
stop the engine and engage the
handbrake;
always remove the ignition key.
If the vehicle is parked on a steep
slope, it is advisable to block the
wheels with a wedge or stone.
WARNING NEVER leave the vehicle
with the gearbox in neutral or, on
versions equipped with automatic
transmission, before placing the gear
lever at P).
VERSIONS WITH MANUAL
GEARBOX
Proceed as follows:
engage a gear (1stgear if parked
uphill or reverse if facing downhill) and
119
STARTING AND DRIVING
leave the wheels turned.
stop the engine and engage the
handbrake;
If the vehicle is parked on a steep
slope, it is advisable to block the
wheels with a wedge or stone.
Do not leave the key in the ignition as
this drains the battery. Always remove
the key when you leave the vehicle.
VERSIONS WITH
AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
On versions with automatic
transmission, keep the brake pedal
pressed, apply the parking brake and
engage the gear lever in position (P),
wait for the letter P to appear on the
display, after which the brake pedal
can be released.
IMPORTANT NOTES
With the vehicle stationary and a gear
engaged, always keep the brake pedal
pressed until you decide to set off,
then release the brake and accelerate
gently;
during prolonged stops with the
engine running, it is advisable to keep
the gearbox in neutral (N);
to keep the clutch in good condition,
do not use the accelerator to keep the
vehicle stationary (e.g. when stopped
facing uphill); the clutch could be
120
damaged by overheating. Use the
brake pedal instead and operate the
accelerator only when you are ready to
set off;
only use second gear when you need
greater control for starting manoeuvres
on surfaces with poor grip;
if, with reverse gear (R) engaged,
you have to engage first gear or vice
versa, only do this when the vehicle
is completely stationary and with the
brake pedal pressed;
although it is strongly inadvisable,
if you are driving downhill and, for
unexpected reasons, you let the vehicle
move forward with the transmission in
neutral (N), when you engage a gear,
the system will automatically engage
the best gear to transmit the correct
drive torque to the wheels depending
on the vehicle speed;
When necessary, you can engage
1st, (R) or (N) with the engine off, the
key in the MAR position and the brake
pressed. In this case, gear shifts must
be made allowing at least 5 minutes
to elapse between one gear shift and
the next to safeguard the operation of
the hydraulic system and the pump in
particular;
for hill starts, accelerating gradually
but fully straight after having released
the handbrake or the brake pedal
allows the engine to greatly increase
the number of revs and tackle steeper
slopes with more torque at the wheels.
on gradients > 5% it is prohibited
to engage the 2nd gear with vehicle
stationary.
HANDBRAKE
To apply the handbrake: the
handbrake lever is located on the left
side of the driver's seat. Pull the lever
upwards to engage the handbrake and
ensure that the vehicle does not move.
To release the handbrake: slightly
raise the lever, hold the button A
pressed and check that the
warning
light switches off on the instrument
panel.
Press the brake pedal when carrying
out this operation to prevent the vehicle
from moving accidentally.
WARNING Make sure that the
handbrake is engaged in such a way as
to ensure the stationing of the vehicle,
especially in the case of steep slopes
and full load.
WARNING Apply the handbrake only
when the vehicle is at a standstill
or with the vehicle in motion only in
the event of a failure in the hydraulic
system. If exceptional use is made
of the handbrake with the vehicle in
motion, moderate traction is advisable
in order not to cause locking of the rear
end with consequent swerving of the
vehicle.
WARNING
MANUAL
TRANSMISSION
To engage the gears, press the clutch
pedal fully and put the gear lever into
the required position (the diagram for
gear engagement is shown on the lever
knob (A) fig. 133).
123) Never leave children unattended in
the vehicle. Always remove the key from
the ignition device when leaving the vehicle
and take it out with you.
124)
23)
WARNING
124) Press the clutch pedal fully to shift
gears correctly. It is therefore essential that
there is nothing under the pedals: make
sure the mats are lying flat and do not get
in the way of the pedals.
IMPORTANT
22) If the vehicle is equipped with
self-levelling air suspension, always check
that there is sufficient space above the
roof and around the vehicle when parking.
Indeed, the vehicle could raise (or lower)
automatically depending on load or
temperature changes.
To engage reverse (R) from neutral,
proceed as follows: raise sliding ring (A)
under the knob and at the same time
move the gear lever to the left and then
forwards.
133
F1A0492
To engage 6th gear, operate the lever
by pressing it towards the right in order
to avoid engaging 4th gear by mistake.
The same applies to the shift from 6th
to 5th gear.
WARNING Reverse may only be
engaged when the vehicle is at a
standstill. With the engine running, wait
for at least 2 seconds with the clutch
pedal fully depressed before engaging
reverse to prevent damage to the gears
and grating.
IMPORTANT
23) Do not drive with your hand resting
on the gear lever as the force exerted,
even if slight, could lead over time to
premature wear of the gearbox internal
components. The clutch pedal should be
used only for gear changes. Do not drive
with your foot resting on the clutch pedal,
however lightly. For versions/markets
where provided, the electronic clutch
control could cut in, interpreting the
incorrect driving style as a fault.
121
STARTING AND DRIVING
AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The vehicle can be equipped with
a 9-speed automatic transmission.
The transmission can operate in two
different modes: “Automatic mode” or
“Sequential mode”.
GEAR LEVER
125) 126) 127) 128) 129) 130)
24)
The gear engaged is shown on the
display. If the transmission is used in
"sequential" mode, which is activated
moving the lever from D (Drive) to
the left, the various positions can
be reached towards + or –. These
positions are unstable. The lever
returns to intermediate position.
To exit position P (Park), or to pass
from position N (Neutral) to position D
(Drive) or R (Reverse) when the vehicle
is stopped or is moving at a low speed,
the brake pedal must be pressed either
(see "Gear engagement disabling
system with brake engaged" in this
chapter).
WARNING DO NOT accelerate while
shifting from position P (or N) to
another position.
134
F1A0466
The (1) lever has the following
positions:
P = Park
R = Reverse
N = Neutral
D = Drive, (automatic forward speed)
AutoStick: + shifting to higher gear
in sequential driving mode; – shifting to
lower gear in sequential driving mode.
122
WARNING After selecting a gear, wait a
few seconds before accelerating. This
precaution is particularly important with
a cold engine.
AUTOMATIC DRIVING
MODE
To select the automatic driving mode,
you need to shift the gear lever to
D. The best ratio is selected by the
control unit depending speed, engine
load (accelerator pedal position) and
gradient of the road.
D can be selected from sequential
operation in any driving conditions.
“Kick-Down” function
To resume speed quickly, when the
accelerator pedal is pressed fully, the
transmission control system downshifts
(kick-down function).
WARNING When driving on roads with
poor grip conditions (snow, ice, etc.)
avoid activating the kick-down function.
SEQUENTIAL DRIVING
MODE - AUTOSTICK
In the case of frequent gearshifting (e.g.
when the vehicle is driven with a heavy
load, on slopes, with strong headwind
or when towing heavy trailers), it is
recommended to use the Autostick
(sequential shifting) mode to select and
keep a lower fixed ratio.
It is possible to shift from position
D (Drive) to the sequential mode
regardless of vehicle speed.
Activation
With gear lever in position D (Drive),
to activate the sequential drive mode,
move the lever to the left (– and +
indication of the panel). The gear
engaged will be shown on the display.
Gearshifting is made by moving the
gear lever forwards, towards symbol –
or backwards, towards symbol +.
Deactivation
Bring the gear lever back in position D
(Drive) ("automatic" driving mode).
TRANSMISSION
EMERGENCY FUNCTION
(where provided)
Transmission operation is constantly
monitored to detect any fault. If
a condition that might damage
the transmission is detected, the
"transmission emergency" function is
activated.
In this condition, the transmission stays
in 4th gear, regardless of the selected
gear.
Positions P (Parking), R (Reverse) and
N (Neutral) still work. Icon
might
light up on the display.
In the event of a "transmission
emergency" immediately contact the
nearest Fiat Dealership.
Temporary failure
In the event of a temporary failure,
correct transmission operation can be
restored for all the forwards gears by
proceeding as follows:
stop the vehicle;
bring the transmission lever to P
(Park);
bring the ignition device to STOP;
wait for about 10 seconds, then
restart the engine;
select the desired gear: if the
problem is not detected any more
the transmission correct operation is
restored.
WARNING In the event of a temporary
failure it is in any case recommended
to contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as
possible.
IGNITION LOCK AND
PARK POSITION
This function requires the gear lever
to be positioned at P (Park) before
extracting the key from the ignition
device.
If the vehicle battery is flat and the
ignition key is engaged, the latter is
locked in position.
To remove the key manually see
paragraph "Automatic transmission
lever unlock" in chapter "In an
emergency".
LEVER MOVEMENT
INHIBITION
This system prevents you from moving
the gear lever from position P if the
brake pedal has not been previously
pressed.
To bring the gear lever to a position
other than P or from N to R, the ignition
device must be in position MAR (engine
on or off) and the brake pedal must be
pressed.
The lever will remain locked in the P
position in case of faults or flat battery.
See the “Automatic transmission”
paragraph in the “In an emergency”
chapter for how to release the lever
manually.
With the ignition device in MAR (engine
started), if the lever remains in position
N for more than about 10 seconds, it
will be necessary to press the brake
to be able to engage the gear (R and
D). A message on the instrument panel
will remind you that the brake must be
pressed to shift gear.
In this case the lever will not lock from
position N, the gear is not shifted
without pressing the brake and an error
message will appear with the request
to repeat the manoeuvre.
IMPORTANT NOTES
Failure to comply with what is reported
below may damage the transmission:
select position P (Park) only with the
vehicle at a standstill;
select position R (Reverse), or pass
from R to another position only with the
vehicle at a standstill and engine idling;
123
STARTING AND DRIVING
124
do not shift gears between positions
P (Park), R (Reverse), N (Neutral) or D
(Drive) with engine running at a speed
above idling. Before engaging any gear
position, fully depress the brake pedal;
keep the brake pedal pressed while
moving the gear lever in a position
different from P (Park);
unexpected movement of the vehicle
can injure the occupants or people
nearby. Do not leave the vehicle with
engine running: before getting out of
the passenger compartment always
engage the parking brake, bring the
gear lever to P (Park), switch off the
engine and extract the key from the
ignition device (for versions with
mechanical key). With ignition device
at STOP (key extraction allowed), the
transmission is locked in position
P (Park), to prevent any accidental
movement of the vehicle;
when getting out of the vehicle,
always remove the mechanical key
from the ignition device and close
all the doors. Do not leave children
unattended inside the vehicle;
bringing the transmission to a
position different from P (Park) or N
(Neutral) at an engine speed higher
than idling is dangerous; if the brake
pedal is not fully pressed, the vehicle
could rapidly accelerate. Only engage
the gear with engine at idling, fully
depressing the brake pedal;
if the transmission temperature
exceeds the normal operating limits,
the transmission control unit may
change the gear engagement order
and reduce the drive torque;
if the transmission overheats the
fluid overheating icon appears on the
display. In this case the transmission
could operate incorrectly until it cools
down;
when using the vehicle with
extremely low external temperatures,
the transmission operation may change
according to engine temperature and
vehicle speed: activation of the higher
gears could be inhibited until the
transmission oil is correctly warmed up;
this function accelerates engine and
transmission warming up. Complete
operation of the transmission will be
enabled as soon as the oil temperature
reaches the predefined value.
WARNING
125) Never use position P instead of
the parking brake. Always engage the
parking brake when parking the vehicle to
prevent injury or damage caused by the
unexpected movement of the vehicle.
126) If the P position is not engaged, the
vehicle could move and injure people.
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that
the gear lever is in position P and that the
parking brake is engaged.
127) Do not shift the gear lever to N and
do not stop the engine when driving on
a downhill road. This type of driving is
dangerous and reduces the possibility
of intervening in the case of variation
of the road traffic or surface. You risk
losing control of the vehicle and causing
accidents.
128) Before moving the gear lever from
position P, bring the ignition device
to position MAR and press the brake
pedal. Otherwise, the gear lever may get
damaged.
129) Engage reverse only with the vehicle
stationary, engine at idling speed and
accelerator fully released.
130) Never leave children unattended in
the vehicle. In addition, always remove the
ignition key when leaving the vehicle and
take it out with you.
IMPORTANT
24) If the vehicle is on a slope, always
engage the parking brake BEFORE moving
the shift lever to the P position.
START&STOP
SYSTEM
"DRIVE MODE"
FUNCTION
(for versions/markets, where provided)
IN BRIEF
136
135
F1A0467
This device, in combination with the
automatic transmission, can be used
to set three different driving modes
("vehicle response") according to the
driver's needs and road conditions:
"Normal", "Power" or "Eco".
The mode is selected by pressing
button (A) fig. 135 on the dashboard.
The selected mode is displayed on the
instrument panel display (A) fig. 136.
F1A0491
The device, using the on-board
electronics, acts on the transmission
and interfaces with the instrument
panel. Engagement of the required
driving mode is indicated on the
instrument panel display.
The system automatically turns on
"Normal" mode when the engine is
started.
FAULT INDICATIONS
In the event of a fault in the system or
selector, mode change is automatically
disabled. The system will automatically
switch to "Normal" mode.
The Start&Stop device automatically
stops the engine each time the
vehicle is stationary and all the
conditions for automatic switch-off
have been met, and starts it again
when the driver wants to move off.
This improves the efficiency of the
vehicle by reducing fuel consumption,
the emission of harmful gases and
noise pollution.
OPERATING MODE
Stopping the engine
Versions with manual gearbox
With the vehicle stationary, the engine
stops with the gearbox in neutral and
the clutch pedal released.
Versions with automatic
transmission
With vehicle at a standstill and brake
pedal pressed, the engine switches off
if the gear lever is in a position other
than (R).
NOTE On versions with automatic
transmission In the event of stops
125
STARTING AND DRIVING
126
uphill, the engine switching off is
disabled to activate the "Hill Start
Assist" function (works only with
running engine).
NOTE After automatic restarting, for the
Stop&Start system to intervene again
simply move the vehicle (at speed
higher than 0.5 km/h for versions with
automatic transmission or 7 km/h for
versions with manual transmission).
The warning light on the instrument
panel switches on to signal that the
engine has stopped.
Restarting the engine
Versions with manual gearbox
Depress the clutch pedal to restart the
engine.
Versions with automatic
transmission
To restart the engine, release the brake
pedal. The icon on the display
switches off. With brake pressed, if the
gear lever is in automatic mode - D
(Drive) - the engine can be restarted
by moving the lever to R (Reverse) or
N (Neutral). With brake pressed, if the
gear lever is in "AutoStick" mode, the
engine can be restarted by moving the
lever to "+" or "–", or R (Reverse) or N
(Neutral).
When the engine has been stopped
automatically, keeping the brake pedal
pressed, the brake can be released
keeping the engine off by quickly
shifting the gear lever to P (Park). To
restart the engine, just move the lever
out of position P.
MANUAL ACTIVATION
AND DEACTIVATION OF
THE SYSTEM
To activate/deactivate the system
manually, press the button on the
dashboard control panel.
25)
SAFETY FUNCTIONS
In engine cut-out conditions through
the Start&Stop system, if the driver
unfastens his/her seat belt and opens
the driver's door or the passenger
door, the engine can be restarted only
by using the key.
The driver is notified of this condition by
a buzzer, through the instrument panel
warning light flashing and, where
provided, by a message in the display.
131) 132)
WARNING
131) The vehicle should always be
evacuated after the key has been removed
or turned to the STOP position. When
refuelling, make sure that the vehicle is
switched off with the key in the STOP
position.
132) If the battery needs to be replaced,
always contact a Fiat Dealership. The
replacement battery should be of the same
type (L6 105Ah/850A) and should have the
same characteristics.
IMPORTANT
25) If the vehicle is equipped with manual
climate control, if you want to favour
climate comfort, the Start&Stop system
can be deactivated for continuous climate
control system operation.
CRUISE CONTROL
(constant speed
regulator)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
IN BRIEF
This is an electronic driving aid
that allows you to drive at a speed
of above 30 km/h on long and
straight dry roads with few driving
changes (e.g. motorways) at a preset
speed without having to press the
accelerator pedal. It is therefore not
recommended to use this device on
extra-urban roads with traffic. Do not
use the device in town.
Activating the device
Turn ring (A) fig. 137 - fig. 138 to ON or
(according to the version).
The device cannot be engaged in 1st
or reverse gear but it is advisable to
engage it in 4th gear or higher.
Versions without Speed Limiter
(fig. 137)
137
F1A0364
Versions with Speed Limiter (fig. 138)
138
F1A0363
When travelling downhill with the device
engaged, the vehicle speed may
slightly exceed the stored one.
When the device is activated the
warning light
comes on together
with the relevant message on the
instrument panel.
Storing vehicle speed
Proceed as follows:
turn ring (A) fig. 137 - fig. 138 to ON
(according to the version) and
or
press the accelerator pedal so that the
vehicle reaches the desired speed;
move the stalk upwards (+) for at
least one second, then release it. The
vehicle speed is now stored and you
can therefore release the accelerator
pedal.
Increasing/reducing the stored
speed
Once the Cruise Control is activated,
you can increase the speed by moving
the lever upwards (+) or decrease it by
moving the lever downwards (-).
Each movement of the stalk will
correspond to a slight reduction in
speed of about 1 km/h, while keeping
the stalk held downwards will decrease
the speed continuously.
Deactivating the device
The device can be switched off by the
driver in the following ways:
turning ring (A) to OFF or
(according to the version);
by switching off the engine;
Deactivating the function
The device can be switched off by the
driver in the following ways:
turning ring (A) to OFF or
(according to the version);
pressing the button (B), both with
symbol
and symbol CANC/RES, the
system pauses;
by switching off the engine;
by pressing the brake pedal or
operating the handbrake;
by pressing the clutch pedal;
requesting a gear shift with an
automatic transmission in sequential
mode;
with the vehicle speed below the set
limit;
by pressing the accelerator pedal;
in this case the system is not actually
turned off but the acceleration request
takes priority; the Cruise Control
remains activated, without the need
to press the CANC/RES button to
restore the previous conditions once
the acceleration is over.
The device is automatically switched off
in the following cases:
if the ABS or ESC systems intervene;
in the event of system failure.
133) 134)
127
STARTING AND DRIVING
SPEED LIMITER
This device allows the vehicle speed to
be limited to a value set by the driver.
The maximum speed can be set both
with vehicle stationary and in motion.
The minimum speed that can be set is
30 km/h.
When the device is active, the vehicle
speed depends on the pressure at the
accelerator pedal, until the set speed
limit is reached.
If necessary (in the event of overtaking
for example), the set speed limit can
be exceeded by fully depressing the
accelerator pedal.
By gradually reducing the pressure on
the accelerator pedal, the function will
be reactivated as soon as the vehicle
speed drops below the programmed
speed.
Activating the device
To activate the device, turn ring (A)
fig. 139 to position
.
When the device is turned on, the
warning light on the instrument panel
turns on and, on some versions, a
message and the last programmed
speed value appears on the display.
Automatic device deactivation
The device deactivates automatically in
the event of fault in the system.
WARNING
133) While driving with the device active,
never move the gear lever to neutral.
134) If the device is faulty, turn ring A to
, check the fuse and contact a Fiat
Dealership.
ENGINE IDLE
PRESET
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The engine idle speed setting is a
feature which can be used to manually
set the engine idle speed using the
Cruise Control and Speed Limiter
control ring fig. 140. The function is
usually used in case of:
"Power Take-Off" connection;
heating of the engine and/or the
passenger compartment.
The function is only available on
versions with Cruise Control and Speed
Limiter.
ACTIVATING THE DEVICE
140
139
128
F1A0363
F1A0363
Turn the ring fig. 140 to . By pressing
button (B), the system sets the engine
idle speed to the previously stored
value. If no values are stored, the
system sets the minimum speed to a
default value (900 rpm).
Activation of the device is indicated
by the respective message on the
instrument panel.
The device can be activated if the
following conditions are met:
handbrake applied;
clutch pedal released (for versions
with manual transmission);
brake pedal released;
vehicle speed equal to 0 km/h;
clutch pedal pressed and released at
least once during the key-on cycle (for
versions with manual transmission);
gear shift lever in position P (for
versions with automatic transmission).
A specific message will appear if you
attempt to activate the device (by
pressing button (B)) when not all the
conditions listed above are met.
INCREASING/DECREASING
AND STORING ENGINE
IDLE PRESET
Once the device is activated, you
can increase/decrease the engine
idle speed by moving the stalk up
(+) or decrease it by moving the
stalk down (-). Each time the stalk
is operated, the engine idle speed
is increased/decreased by about
50 rpm, while keeping the stalk
up/down, the engine idle speed varies
continuously by a fixed gradient up to
a minimum/maximum allowed value
(minimum: 900 rpm - maximum: 2200
rpm).
Under these conditions, holding button
(B) pressed will cause the system to
store the current engine idle speed
as a new preset value. The storage
of the new engine idle speed value
is indicated by a message on the
instrument panel.
DEACTIVATING THE
DEVICE
Once the engine idle speed setting
has been activated, the device can be
switched off by pressing and releasing
button (B).
The device will be switched off even if
one of the following conditions occurs:
ring moved from position ;
handbrake released;
clutch pedal pressed (for versions
with manual transmission);
the brake pedal is pressed;
vehicle speed higher than 0 km/h;
lever in position other than (P for
versions with automatic transmission).
Deactivation of the device is indicated
by the respective message button
instrument panel.
SPEED BLOCK
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The vehicle is equipped with a speed
limitation function that can be set on
the user's request to one of four default
values: 90, 100, 110, 130 km/h.
To activate/deactivate this function,
contact a Fiat Dealership.
Following the operation, a sticker will
be applied to the windscreen showing
the top speed setting.
WARNING The speedometer could
indicate a higher maximum speed than
the effective one, set by the Dealership,
in accordance with the regulations in
force.
129
STARTING AND DRIVING
PARKING SENSORS
These are located in the rear bumper of
the vehicle fig. 141 and their function
is to inform the driver, through an
intermittent buzzer, about the presence
of obstacles behind the vehicle.
141
F1A0134
ACTIVATION
The sensors are automatically activated
when reverse gear is engaged.
As the obstacle behind the vehicle gets
closer to the bumper, the frequency of
the acoustic signal increases.
ACOUSTIC WARNING
When reverse gear is engaged
an intermittent acoustic signal is
automatically activated.
The acoustic warning:
increases as the distance between
the vehicle and the obstacle decreases;
becomes continuous when the
distance between the vehicle and the
130
obstacle is less than 30 cm and stops
immediately if the distance increases;
it remains constant if the distance
remains unchanged; if this situation
concerns the side sensors, the buzzer
will stop after about 3 seconds to
avoid, for example, warning indications
in the event of manoeuvres along walls.
If several obstacles are detected by
the sensors, only the nearest one is
considered.
FAULT INDICATIONS
Any parking sensor faults will be
indicated when reverse is engaged
in the
by the warning light
instrument panel or by the icon
on the display and by the message
in the multifunction display (for
versions/markets, where provided)
OPERATION WITH A
TRAILER
Parking sensor operation is
automatically deactivated when the
electric cable plug of the trailer is
inserted into the vehicle tow hook
socket.
The sensors are automatically
reactivated when the trailer's cable plug
is removed.
135)
26)
WARNING If you wish to leave the
tow hook fitted without towing a
trailer, it is advisable to contact a Fiat
Dealership for the relevant system
update operations because the tow
hook could be detected as an obstacle
by the central sensors. When using
special washing equipment such as
high pressure jets or steam cleaning,
clean the sensors very quickly keeping
the jet more than 10 cm away.
WARNINGS
Do not apply stickers to the sensors.
When parking, take the utmost care
over obstacles that may be above or
under the sensor.
Objects close to the vehicle, in
certain circumstances are not detected
and could therefore cause damage to
the vehicle or be damaged.
The following conditions may influence
the performance of the parking
assistance system:
Reduced sensor sensitivity and a
reduction in the parking assistance
system performance could be due
to the presence on the surface of the
sensor of: ice, snow, mud, thick paint.
The sensor may detect a nonexistent obstacle (echo noise) due to
mechanical noises, for example when
washing the vehicle, in case of rain,
strong wind, hail.
The warnings sent by the sensor
can also be altered by the presence
of ultrasonic systems (e.g. pneumatic
brakes of trucks or pneumatic drills)
near the vehicle.
The performance of the parking
assistance system may also be
affected by the position of the sensors.
For example by a change in the
ride setting (caused by the wear of
the shock absorbers, suspension),
changing the tyres, overloading the
vehicle and carrying out specific tuning
operations that require the vehicle to be
lowered.
Detection of obstacles in the upper
part of the vehicle (particularly in the
case of vans or chassis cabs) may not
be guaranteed because the system
detects obstacles that could strike the
lower part of the vehicle.
WARNING
135) The driver is always responsible for
parking and other dangerous manoeuvres.
While carrying out these manoeuvres,
always make sure that no people
(especially children) or animals are in the
area concerned. The parking sensors
are used to assist the driver, who must
never allow his attention to lapse during
potentially dangerous manoeuvres, even
those executed at low speeds.
IMPORTANT
The table below shows the
approximate distances for each area:
26) The sensor must be free of mud,
dirt, snow or ice in order for the system
to work. Be careful not to scratch or
damage the sensors while cleaning them.
Avoid using dry, rough or hard cloths.
The sensors must be washed using
clean water, with the addition of vehicle
shampoo if necessary.
REAR CAMERA
(PARKVIEW® REAR
BACK UP CAMERA)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
136)
27)
The vehicle may be equipped with a
ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera,
which allows the driver to see the
surrounding area behind the vehicle on
the display when reverse is engaged or
the tailgate is opened fig. 142.
SYMBOLS AND
MESSAGES ON THE
DISPLAY
When displayed, the static line grid
shows the width of the vehicle.
The grid shows separate areas,
allowing you to see the distance from
the rear of the vehicle.
142
F1A0479
Approximate distances for zone
Zone (see figure)
Distance from the
rear of the vehicle
Red (A)
0–30 cm
Yellow (B)
30–100 cm
Green (C)
1 m or more
131
STARTING AND DRIVING
IMPORTANT NOTES
WARNING In some circumstances,
such as with ice, snow or mud on the
surface of the camera, its sensitivity
may be reduced.
WARNING If the rear doors need to be
re-painted after the repairs, make sure
the paint does not get in contact with
the plastic support of the camera.
WARNING When parking, take the
utmost care over obstacles that may
be above or under the camera range.
WARNING
136) The responsibility for parking and
other manoeuvres is always and in any
case charged to the driver. While carrying
out these manoeuvres, always make sure
that no people (especially children) or
animals are in the area concerned. The
camera is an aid for the driver, but the
driver must never allow his/her attention
to lapse during potentially dangerous
manoeuvres, even those executed at low
speeds. Always keep a slow speed, so as
to promptly brake in the case of obstacles.
132
IMPORTANT
27) It is vital, for correct operation, that the
camera is always kept clean and free from
any mud, dirt, snow or ice. Be careful not
to scratch or damage the camera while
cleaning it. Avoid using dry, rough or hard
cloths. The camera must be washed using
clean water, with the addition of vehicle
shampoo if necessary. In washing stations
which use steam or high-pressure jets,
clean the camera quickly, keeping the
nozzle more than 10 cm away from the
sensors. Also, do not apply stickers to the
camera.
TRAFFIC SIGN
RECOGNITION
WARNING The system is designed
to read signs complying with the
specifications of the Vienna convention.
USE OF THE TRAFFIC
SIGN RECOGNITION
System switching on and off
The system can be
activated/deactivated using the display
menu. Refer to the "Display" paragraph
in the "Knowing the instrument panel"
chapter.
N.B.: the system condition and settings
do not change throughout the different
on-off cycles.
(for versions/markets, where provided)
100
137) 138) 139) 140)
28) 29) 30) 31) 32) 33) 34)
The system automatically detects
the recognisable traffic signs: speed
limits, no overtaking signs and signs
indicating the end of such prohibitions.
The camera is fitted behind the internal
rear view mirror. The sensor always
checks the traffic signs indicating the
current speed limit and possible no
overtaking signs.
143
F1A0373
WARNING
137) If the camera loses its position due to
a load variation, the system may not work
temporarily to allow the camera to perform
an auto-calibration.
138) The system only detects the preset
traffic signs. If the minimum visibility
conditions and distance from the sign are
met it can detect all traffic signs.
139) The system is a driving assistance
system but it does not relieve the driver
of the responsibility of driving with due
attention and diligence in compliance with
the laws in force.
140) When the system is active, the driver
is responsible for controlling the vehicle
and monitoring the system, and must
intervene as appropriate if necessary.
FULL BRAKE
CONTROL SYSTEM
141) 142) 143) 144)
35) 36) 37) 38) 39) 40)
(for versions/markets, where provided)
This is a driving assist system
consisting of a camera mounted in the
middle of the windscreen fig. 144.
IMPORTANT
28) If the sensor is obstructed the system
may not work.
29) At low temperatures and in particularly
adverse weather conditions, the system
may not work.
30) Rain, snow, splashes and strong light
contrast may influence the sensor.
31) Do not repair the area of the
windscreen directly surrounding the
sensor.
32) If the vehicle is equipped with a nongenuine suspension kit, the system may
not work correctly.
33) Always use genuine spare parts when
replacing the bulbs of the headlights.
Other bulbs may reduce the system
performance.
34) Clean the windscreen from foreign
matters such as bird droppings, insects,
snow or ice.
144
F1A0998
In the event of an imminent collision
the system intervenes by automatically
braking the vehicle to prevent the
impact or reduce its effects.
The system provides the driver with
acoustic and visual signals through
specific messages on the instrument
panel display.
The system may lightly brake to warn
the driver if a possible frontal accident
is detected (limited braking). Signals
and limited braking are intended to
allow the driver to react promptly, in
order to prevent or reduce the effects
of a potential accident.
In situations with the risk of collision, if
the system detects no intervention by
the driver, it provides automatic braking
to help slow the vehicle and mitigate
the potential frontal accident (automatic
braking).
If intervention by the driver on the brake
pedal is detected but not deemed
sufficient, the system may intervene in
order to improve the reaction of the
braking system, therefore reducing
vehicle speed further (additional
assistance in braking stage).
Versions equipped with manual
gearbox: at the end of the automatic
braking the engine may stall and turn
off, unless the driver presses the clutch
pedal.
Versions equipped with automatic
transmission: at the end of the
braking, the latest stored gear is
engaged: the vehicle may therefore
restart after a few seconds.
WARNING Both on versions equipped
with manual transmission and on those
with automatic transmission, after the
vehicle is stopped the brake callipers
may be locked for about 2 seconds for
safety reasons. Make sure you press
the brake pedal if the vehicle moves
slightly forwards.
133
STARTING AND DRIVING
Engagement /
disengagement
Full Brake Control can be turned
off (and then on again) using the
Uconnect™ system (where provided)
(see relevant section), or from the
instrument panel (see relevant section).
The system can be turned off even with
the starter switch at MAR.
The system can be set to two
activation levels:
System active: the system (if active),
in addition to the visual and acoustic
warnings, provides limited braking,
automatic braking and additional
assistance in braking stage, where the
driver does not brake sufficiently in the
event of a potential frontal accident;
System deactivated: the system
does not provide visual and acoustic
warnings, limited braking, automatic
braking or additional assistance in
braking stage. The system will therefore
provide no indication of a possible
accident.
Activation / deactivation
If the Full Brake Control system has
been correctly activated, it will be active
each time the engine is started.
The system is deactivated if this is
selected on the instrument panel or
Uconnect™ system menu.
134
Following a deactivation, the system
will not warn the driver about the
possible accident with the preceding
vehicle, regardless of the setting
selected.
The system activation status will not
be kept in the memory when the
engine is switched off: if the system
is deactivated when the engine is
switched off, it will be active when it its
next started.
After a deactivation, the system can
be reactivated from the Uconnect™
system or instrument panel menu.
The function is not active at speed
above 5 km/h.
The system is only active if:
it has been activated correctly;
it has not been deactivated using
the instrument panel or Uconnect™
system menu;
the ignition device is at MAR;
the vehicle speed is greater than 5
km/h.
Changing the system
sensitivity
The sensitivity of the system can be
changed through the Uconnect™
system or instrument cluster menu,
choosing from one of the following
three options: "Near", "Med" or "Far".
See the description in the Uconnect™
supplement for how to change the
settings.
The pre-set option is "Med". With this
setting, the system warns the driver of
a possible collision with the vehicle in
front when that vehicle is at a standard
distance, between that of the other two
settings.
This setting offers the driver reaction
time longer than that of the "Near"
setting but shorter than that of the
"Far" setting in the event of a potential
accident.
By setting system sensitivity to "Near",
the system warns the driver of a
possible accident with the vehicle
in front when that vehicle is a short
distance away.
With the system sensitivity set to "Far",
the system will warn the driver of a
possible collision with the vehicle in
front when that vehicle is at a greater
distance, thus providing the possibility
of acting on the brakes more lightly
and gradually. This setting provides
the drivers with the maximum possible
reaction time to prevent a potential
accident.
The system sensitivity setting is kept
in the memory when the engine is
switched off.
Function temporarily not
available warning
If the fault light comes on and the
dedicated message is displayed,
a condition temporarily disabling
operation of the system may have
occurred. The main possible causes of
this temporary blinding are weatherrelated (heavy rain, fog, sun low down
on the horizon, etc.).
Although the vehicle can still be driven
in normal conditions, the system may
be temporarily not available.
When the conditions limiting the
system functions end, this will go back
to normal and complete operation.
Should the fault persist, contact a Fiat
Dealership.
Warning of system
disabling due to an
obstruction
If the dedicated message is displayed,
a condition disabling operation of
the system may have occurred. The
possible cause of this disabling is a
camera obstruction. If an obstruction
is signalled, clean the area of the
windscreen indicated in fig. 144
and check that the message has
disappeared.
Although the vehicle can still be driven
in normal conditions, the system is not
available.
When the conditions disabling the
system functions end, it will return
to normal and complete operation.
Should the fault persist, contact a Fiat
Dealership.
System failure warning
If the system switches off and a
dedicated message is shown on the
display, it means that there is a failure
on the system.
In this case, it is still possible to drive
the vehicle, but you are advised to
contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as
possible.
Driving in special
conditions
In certain driving conditions, such as,
for example:
driving close to a bend;
vehicles with small dimensions
and/or not aligned in the driving lane;
lane change by other vehicles;
vehicles travelling at right angles to
the vehicle.
system intervention might be
unexpected or delayed. The driver
must therefore be very careful, keeping
control of the vehicle to drive in
complete safety.
the Uconnect™ system or the
instrument panel.
Driving close to a bend
When entering or leaving a wide bend,
the system may detect a vehicle that is
in front of you, but that is not driving in
the same lane fig. 145. In cases such
as these, the system may intervene.
145
F1A0997
Vehicles with small
dimensions and/or not
aligned in the driving
lane
The system cannot detect vehicles in
front of you but outside the camera's
field of vision and may therefore not
react in the presence of small vehicles,
such as motorbikes.
WARNING In particularly complex
traffic conditions, the driver can
deactivate the system manually through
135
STARTING AND DRIVING
accident in advance. Failure to take
into account this warning may lead to
serious or fatal injuries.
In case of complex scenarios,
unexpected or unnecessary warnings
or braking may occur.
WARNING
146
F1A0996
Lane change by other
vehicles
Vehicles suddenly changing lane,
entering the same lane as your vehicle
and this moving into the camera's field
of vision, may cause the system to
intervene fig. 147.
147
F1A0995
Important notes
The system has not been designed to
prevent impacts and cannot detect
possible conditions leading to an
136
141) The system is an aid for the driver,
who must always pay full attention while
driving. The responsibility always rests with
the driver, who must take into account
the traffic conditions in order to drive in
complete safety. The driver must always
maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in
front.
142) If the driver depresses the brake
pedal fully or carries out a fast steering
during system operation, the automatic
braking function may stop (e.g. to allow a
possible manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle).
143) The system intervenes on vehicles
travelling in the same lane. People, animals
and things (e.g. pushchairs) are not taken
into consideration.
144) If the vehicle must be placed on a
roller bench for maintenance or if it is
washed in an automatic car wash with
an obstacle in the front part (e.g. another
vehicle, a wall or another obstacle), the
system may detect its presence and
activate. Therefore, in this case the system
must be deactivated.
IMPORTANT
35) The system may have limited or absent
operation due to weather conditions such
as: heavy rain, hail, thick fog, heavy snow.
36) System intervention might be
unexpected or delayed when other cars
transport loads projecting from the side,
above or from the rear, with respect to the
normal size of the vehicle.
37) Operation can be adversely affected
by any structural change made to the
vehicle, such as a modification to the front
geometry, tyre change, or a heavier than
standard load of the vehicle.
38) Incorrect repairs in the zone where the
camera is mounted may interfere with its
field of vision and reduce its performance
(e.g. application of fillers or glues to
remove scratches). Go to a Fiat Dealership
for any operation of this type.
39) Do not tamper with nor operate on the
camera on the windscreen. In the event of
a sensor failure, contact a Fiat Dealership.
40) When towing a trailer (with modules
installed after purchasing the vehicle) or a
vehicle or during loading manoeuvres on a
car carrier (or in vehicle for transport), the
system must be deactivated.
SAVING FUEL
Top speed
Fuel consumption increases
considerably with speed.
GENERAL INFORMATION
The general factors that affect fuel
consumption are listed below.
Vehicle maintenance
Tyres
Unnecessary loads
Roof rack/ski rack
Electric devices
Climate control module
Devices for aerodynamic control
Acceleration
Accelerating violently will greatly
affect consumption and emissions:
acceleration should be gradual.
DRIVING STYLE
The main driving styles that affect fuel
consumption are listed below.
Starting
Do not warm up the engine at low or
high revs when the vehicle is stationary;
this causes the engine to warm up
more slowly, thereby increasing fuel
consumption and emissions.
Unnecessary actions
Avoid accelerating when stopped at
traffic lights or before switching off the
engine.
Gear selection
In the same way improper use of a high
gear increases consumption, emissions
and engine wear.
CONDITIONS OF USE
The main usage conditions that
negatively affect fuel consumption are
listed below.
Cold starting
Short journeys and frequent cold
starts do not allow the engine to reach
optimum operating temperature.
Traffic and road conditions
Heavy traffic causes high fuel
consumption. Winding mountain roads
and rough road surfaces also adversely
affect consumption.
Stops in traffic
During prolonged hold-ups (e.g. level
crossings) the engine should be
switched off.
REFUELLING THE
VEHICLE
IN BRIEF
Stop the engine before refuelling.
PETROL ENGINES
Only use petrol with an octane number
(RON) no lower than 95 (EN228
specification).
DIESEL ENGINES
Only refuel with automotive diesel
conforming to the European
specification EN590.
OPERATION AT LOW
TEMPERATURES
When using or parking the vehicle for
a long time in the mountains or cold
areas, it is advisable to refuel using
locally available diesel fuel. In this case,
it is also advisable to keep the tank
over 50% full.
41)
REFUELLING CAPACITY
To ensure that you fill the tank
completely, top up twice after the first
click of the fuel supply gun. Further
137
STARTING AND DRIVING
top-ups could cause faults in the fuel
feeding system.
FUEL TANK CAP
When refuelling, open flap (A) fig. 148
located on the left side of the vehicle
therefore unscrew the cap (B) fig. 148
turning it counter-clockwise.
For versions / markets where provided,
insert the ignition key in the lock of the
cap. Turn the key counter-clockwise
and remove the cap by gripping the
key. Do not remove the key from
the cap during refuelling. During the
operation of refuelling, the cap can be
hung to its appropriate place located
on the door A (A) fig. 148.
The sealing may cause a slight
pressure increase in the tank. A little
breathing off, while slackening the cap
is absolutely normal.
replacement cap is for the appropriate
vehicle.
Tighten the cap of the fuel tank filler
until you hear a "click". This sound
shows that the cap of the fuel tank filler
is properly tightened.
For versions / markets where provided,
turn the key clockwise until it stops. It is
not necessary to apply an additional
load on the key to complete the
tightening of the cap. Only in the case
where the cap has been tightened
properly, it will be possible to remove
the ignition key from the cap.
After each refuelling, make sure the fuel
filler cap is securely tightened.
WARNING When the gun distributor
fuel "snaps" or interrupts the supply,
the tank is nearly full and you can run
two additional top-ups after shooting
automatic.
145) 146) 147)
148
In case of loss or damage to the
fuel tank cap, make sure that the
138
F1A5004
TOPPING UP AdBlue®
DIESEL EMISSIONS
ADDITIVE (UREA)
Preliminary conditions
AdBlue® (UREA) freezes at
temperatures lower than -11°C. If the
vehicle stands for a long time at this
temperature refilling could be difficult.
For this reason, it is advised to park
the vehicle in a garage and/or heated
environment and wait for the AdBlue®
(UREA) to return to liquid state before
topping up.
Proceed as follows:
park the vehicle on ground level;
stop the engine by turning the
ignition device to MAR;
open the fuel flap A (A)fig. 148 and
then unscrew and remove the cap (C)
(blue colour) fig. 148 from the AdBlue®
filler.
Refilling with nozzles
You can fill up at any AdBlue® (UREA)
distributor.
Proceed as follows:
insert the AdBlue® (UREA) nozzle
in the filler, start refilling and stop
refilling at the first shut-off (the shut-off
indicates that the AdBlue® (UREA) tank
is full).
Do not proceed with the refilling and
remove the nozzle to prevent spillage.
Refilling with containers
Proceed as follows:
check the expiration date;
read the advice for use on the label
before pouring the content of the bottle
into the AdBlue® (UREA) tank;
if systems which cannot be screwed
in (e.g. tanks) are used for refilling,
after the indication appears on the
instrument panel display (refer to
the “Warning lights and messages"
paragraph), fill the AdBlue® (UREA)
tank with no more than 10 litres;
if containers which can be screwed
to the filler are used, the reservoir is full
when the AdBlue® (UREA) level in the
container stops pouring out. Do not
proceed further.
Operations after refilling
Proceed as follows:
fit the cap (C)fig. 148 back on the
AdBlue® (UREA) filler by turning it
clockwise and screwing it completely;
set the starter switch to MAR (it is
not necessary to start the engine);
wait for the indication on the
instrument panel to switch off before
moving the vehicle. The indication
may stay on for a few seconds to
approximately half a minute.
If the engine is started and the vehicle
is moved, the indication will remain on
for longer. This will not compromise
engine operation;
if the AdBlue® was topped up
when the tank was empty, refer to the
“Refuelling ” paragraph, and wait for 2
minutes before starting the engine.
WARNING If AdBlue® (UREA) is spilled
out of the filler neck, clean up well the
area and proceed to filling up again. If
the liquid crystallises, eliminate it with a
sponge and warm water.
IMPORTANT
DO NOT EXCEED THE MAXIMUM
LEVEL: this could cause damage to the
reservoir. AdBlue® (UREA) freezes at
under -11 °C. Although the system is
designed to operate below the freezing
point of the UREA, it is advisable not
to fill the tank beyond the maximum
level because if the AdBlue® (UREA)
freezes the system can be damaged.
Follow the instructions in the “Topping
up AdBlue® diesel emissions additive
(UREA)” paragraph in this chapter.
If the AdBlue® (UREA) is spilled
on painted surfaces or aluminium,
immediately clean the area with water
and use absorbent material to collect
the fluid that has been spilled on the
ground.
Do not try to start the engine if the
AdBlue® (UREA) was accidentally
added to the Diesel fuel tank, this can
result in serious engine damage,
contact a Fiat Dealership.
Do not add additives or other fluids
to AdBlue® (UREA); doing so could
damage the system.
The use of non-conforming or
degraded AdBlue® (UREA) may lead to
indications appearing on the instrument
panel display (see "Warning lights and
messages" paragraph).
Never pour AdBlue® (UREA)
into another container: it could be
contaminated.
In case of damage to the sewage
system of exhaust gas resulting from
the use of additives / tap water, the
introduction of diesel fuel, or at least
by not fulfilling the requirements, the
warranty expires.
If the AdBlue® (UREA) runs out, refer
to the “Warning lights and messages"
paragraph to continue using the vehicle
normally.
AdBlue ® (UREA) storage
AdBlue® (UREA) is considered a very
stable product with a long shelf life.
Stored at temperatures LOWER than
32°C, it has a shelf life of at least one
year. Follow the instructions on the
label of the container.
AdBlue ® (UREA) tank topping in
cold environments
Since AdBlue® (UREA) starts to
freeze around -11°C, the vehicle is
equipped with an automatic system of
heating UREA that allows the system
to function properly at temperatures
below -11°C.
If the vehicle remains idle for a long
period at temperatures below the 139
STARTING AND DRIVING
11°C, the AdBlue® (UREA) in the tank
might freeze.
If the AdBlue® (UREA) tank was filled
beyond the maximum level and freezes,
it can be damaged; for this reason it is
advisable not to exceed the maximum
level of the tank.
Pay extra attention to avoid exceeding
the maximum level when you use
portable containers for topping up.
Fuel storage - Diesel Fuel
148)
In case of the storage of massive
amounts of fuel, good maintenance
is essential. The fuel contaminated
with water favours the proliferation of
"microbes".
These microbes create a "slime" that
can clog the filter system and fuel
pipes. Remove water from the supply
tank and regularly replace the filter
pipe.
METHANE ENGINES
(NATURAL POWER)
METHANE GAS FILLER
The methane filler is located near
the petrol filler. To access the filler,
unscrew the cap (A) fig. 149.
The profile of the filler is of the universal
type, compatible with Italian and
"NGV1" standards.
In some European countries adapters
are considered ILLEGAL (e.g. in
Germany).
For service stations with cubic metre
(m3) nozzles (pressure differential), to
measure the residual pressure in the
cylinder, the non-return valves must be
released by delivering a small amount
of methane.
WARNING When a Diesel engine runs
out of fuel, air is blown through the fuel
system.
149
F0N0436
The other plates (provided with the
vehicle documentation) contain the
140
date for the first inspection of the
cylinders.
42) 43)
Fuel - Vehicle compatibility
identification - Graphic symbol
for informing consumers in
accordance with EN16942
The symbols shown below aid
recognising the correct fuel type to
be used on your vehicle. Before
proceeding with refuelling, check the
symbols inside the fuel filler flap (where
provided) and compare them with
the symbols shown on the fuel pump
(where provided).
Symbols for petrol/methane bi-fuel
cars
E5: Unleaded petrol containing up to
2.7% (m/m) oxygen and with maximum
5.0% (V/V) ethanol compliant with
EN228
E10: Unleaded petrol containing up to
3.7% (m/m) oxygen and with maximum
10.0% (V/V) ethanol compliant with
EN228
CNG: Automotive methane and biomethane compliant with EN16723
Symbols for diesel powered cars
B7: Diesel containing up to 7% (V/V)
of FAME (Fatty Acid Methyl Esters)
compliant with EN590
WARNING
145) Do not approach naked flames or
lit cigarettes to the fuel tank filler: fire risk.
Keep your face away from the fuel filler to
prevent breathing in harmful vapours.
146) To avoid fuel spillage and the
exceeding of the maximum level, avoid
topping up after filling the tank.
147) Any fuel pumping in portable
containers located on a floor can cause
a fire. Danger of burns. Always put the
fuel container on the ground during filling.
Avoid using contaminated fuel: a fuel
contaminated with water or earth can
cause serious damage to the engine fuel
feed system. Proper maintenance of the
fuel filter, of the engine and the fuel tank is
essential.
148) Do not open the fuel system at high
pressure with the engine running. The
operation of the engine creates a high fuel
pressure. A jet of high-pressure fuel can
cause serious injury or death.
IMPORTANT
41) Only refuel with automotive diesel
complying with the European specification
EN590. The use of other products or
mixtures may damage the engine beyond
repair and consequently invalidate the
warranty, due to the damage caused. If
you accidentally introduce other types of
fuel into the tank, do not start the engine.
Empty the tank. If the engine has been run
for even an extremely limited amount of
time, you must not only drain the fuel tank,
but the rest of the supply circuit as well.
42) Methane refuelling stations are not
authorised to refill the cylinders when the
inspection date has expired. The check
valve prevents the methane from flowing
back to the fuel filler.
43) If the vehicle has been registered in a
country other than Italy, the certification
data, identification and inspection
procedures for the methane cylinders
should conform to the legislation in
that country. In any case, it should be
remembered that the life of the cylinders is
20 years from the production date as set
out in ECE Regulation 110.
AdBlue® (UREA)
ADDITIVE FOR
DIESEL EMISSIONS
The vehicle is equipped with an
AdBlue® (UREA) injection system and
Selective Catalytic Reduction to meet
emission standards.
These two systems ensure compliance
with the diesel emissions requirements;
at the same time, they ensure fuelefficiency, handling, torque and power.
For messages and system warnings,
refer to the "Warning lights and
messages" paragraph in the "Knowing
the instrument panel" chapter.
AdBlue® (UREA) is considered a very
stable product with a long shelf life.
Stored at temperatures LOWER than
32 °C, it has a shelf life of at least one
year.
For more information on the AdBlue®
(UREA) liquid type, see the “Fluids and
lubricants” paragraph in the “Technical
specifications” chapter.
The vehicle is provided with an
automatic AdBlue® (UREA) heating
system when the engine starts allowing
the system to work correctly at
temperatures lower than -11 °C.
IMPORTANT! AdBlue® (UREA) freezes
at temperatures lower than -11 °C.
141
STARTING AND DRIVING
142
VERSION WITH
METHANE SYSTEM
(Natural Power)
WARNING If gas is smelled, switch
from methane operation to petrol
operation and immediately go to a Fiat
Dealership to have the vehicle checked
and possible system faults excluded.
44) 45)
INTRODUCTION
The "Natural Power" version of the Fiat
Ducato features two fuel system, one
primary natural gas (methane) system
and one emergency petrol system.
METHANE CYLINDERS
The vehicle is equipped with five
cylinders (total capacity of about 218
litres) located under the vehicle floor
and protected by two special shields.
The cylinders are the tank that contains
the methane in its compressed
gaseous state (nominal pressure of 200
bar at 15°C). The methane, stored in
the canisters at high pressure, flows
through a dedicated pipe to reach the
pressure regulator/reduction unit which
supplies the 4 methane injectors at low
pressure (about 6 bar).
The cylinders must be inspected, in
accordance with ECE Regulation
Procedure no. 110, every 4 years
from the vehicle registration date
or in accordance with specific
regulations in individual countries.
FUEL SWITCHING
LOGICS
Management of switching between
the two different fuel supplies is fully
automatic, and carried out by the
engine control unit.
When the residual amount of methane
drops below 1/5 of the cylinder
capacity, the lowest level and the
edges of the other levels flash to
indicate the reserve state and that
refuelling fig. 150 is required.
If the methane runs out, it is
automatically switched to petrol; on the
display, all the empty segments stop
near
flashing and then the indicator
the CNG icon fig. 151 turns on.
Having reached the reserve methane
pressure threshold, and completely
filled the methane tank, the system
forces the switch to petrol for 5
seconds, with the aim of keeping the
petrol fuel supply system fully efficient.
150
F1A0436
151
F0N0403i
The general recommendation is
to avoid emptying the petrol tank
completely, as this may lead to a
risk for the driver:
After the METHANE level has
dropped below the reserve threshold,
the vehicle will continue to run on petrol
until it runs out;
the vehicle has run out of petrol
during a previous mission and while
running on METHANE it has reached
the METHANE reserve pressure
threshold: in this case, the system
forces switching to petrol and the
vehicle turns off while it is in motion.
NOTE Make sure that the key is in
the OFF position when refuelling with
methane. If, in fact, the system has
already forced running on petrol and
you refuel with methane with the key
in the ON position, the engine will
continue running on petrol until the next
time it is started.
RESTRICTIONS ON USE
Passing from running on methane
to running on petrol causes the
maximum speed to be limited to 90
km/h; therefore, after the first methane
reserve indication, it is advisable to
refuel and after the second indication
of gaseous fuel running out (double
beep), avoid "risky" conditions such
as overtaking at high speed on the
motorway.
Petrol operation is for emergency
only. In order to guarantee good
independence, even where there is
limited tank capacity, performance is
limited such as speed or, as for takeoff, acceleration (particularly uphill).
As such, before embarking on
demanding journeys and/or routes, in
terms of load or road conditions, it is
advisable to ensure that the gaseous
fuel canister is full.
IMPORTANT
44) Fiat Ducato Natural Power is equipped
with a high pressure methane system
designed to run at 200 bar. It is dangerous
to strain the system with higher pressures.
If there is a problem with the methane
system, only contact a Fiat Dealership. Do
not alter the methane system configuration
or components; they are designed
exclusively for the Fiat Ducato Natural
Power. The use of other components or
materials could cause malfunctions and
prejudice safety.
45) When oven painting, the cylinders
must be removed from the vehicle and
refitted by a Fiat Dealership. Although the
methane system has numerous safety
features, it is advisable to close the
manual tap on the cylinders whenever the
vehicle is not in use for a long period,
transported on other vehicles or moved in
an emergency as a result of a breakdown
or accident.
LOADING ADVICE
The Fiat Ducato version used by you
has been designed and type approved
on the basis of certain maximum
weights (see "Weights" table in the
"Technical Data" chapter): kerb weight,
payload, total weight, maximum weight
on front axle, maximum weight on rear
axle, towable weight.
WARNING The maximum permitted
load on the floor fastenings is 500 kg;
the maximum permitted load on the
side panel is 150 kg.
WARNING For versions with right
and left side flaps, it is advisable to
reposition the release lever in the
closed position before lowering the
sides.
149) 150) 151)
46)
In addition to these general
precautions, some simple precautions
can improve driving safety, travelling
comfort and vehicle durability:
distribute the load evenly over
the platform: if it is necessary to
concentrate it in a single area, choose
an area mid-way between both axles;
143
STARTING AND DRIVING
lastly, remember that the dynamic
behaviour of the vehicle is affected by
the weight transported: in particular,
the stopping distances are longer,
especially at high speed.
WARNING
149) Irregular trajectories and abrupt
braking may cause sudden movements
of the load with consequent situations of
hazard for the driver and passengers.
Before beginning your journey, please
constrain the load appropriately, using the
hooks provided on the floor. To hold it in
place, use cables, ropes or belts that are
appropriately strong to hold the weight of
the material to be fixed.
150) Even when the vehicle is stopped
on a steep hill or side slope, opening the
rear or side doors could cause unsecured
goods to fall out.
151) If you wish to carry a reserve of petrol
in a can, observe the legal restrictions and
only use a can that is type-approved and
properly secured to the load anchoring
eyebolts. In the event of a collision the fire
risk is increased all the same.
IMPORTANT
46) Each of these must be strictly
observed and MUST NEVER BE
EXCEEDED in any case. In particular,
ensure that you never exceed the
maximum permitted weights on the front
and rear axles when arranging the load
144
on the vehicle (particularly if the vehicle is
equipped with a specific trim level).
TOWING TRAILERS
IMPORTANT NOTES
The vehicle must be provided with a
type-approved tow hook and adequate
electrical system to tow caravans or
trailers. Installation should be carried
out by specialised personnel who will
issue the required papers for travelling
on roads.
Install any specific and/or additional
door mirrors as specified by the
Highway Code.
Remember that when towing a trailer,
steep hills are harder to climb, the
braking spaces increase and overtaking
takes longer depending on the overall
weight.
Engage a low gear when driving
downhill, rather than constantly using
the brake.
The weight of the trailer on the vehicle
tow hook will reduce the loading
capacity of the vehicle by the same
amount. Consider the weight of the
trailer fully laden, including accessories
and luggage, to make sure you do not
exceed the maximum towable weight
(shown on the vehicle registration
document).
Do not exceed the speed limits specific
to each country you are driving in, in
the case of vehicles towing trailers.
In any case, the top speed must not
exceed 100 km/h.
You are advised to fit a suitable
stabiliser to the trailer drawbar.
In the vehicles equipped with parking
sensors, after fitting the tow hook
malfunctioning warnings may be
displayed, as some parts (tow bar, ball
tow hook) may be within the sensor
detection range. In this case the
detection range must be adjusted or
the parking assistance function must
be deactivated.
152) 153)
INSTALLING THE TOW
HOOK
The towing device should be fastened
to the body by specialised technicians
according to any additional and/or
integrative information supplied by the
Manufacturer of the device.
The towing device must meet
current regulations with reference to
Directive 94/20/EC and subsequent
amendments.
For any version the towing device used
must match the towable weight of the
vehicle on which it is to be installed.
For the electric connection a standard
connector should be used which is
generally placed on a special bracket
normally fastened to the towing device,
and a special ECU for external trailer
light control must be installed on the
vehicle. For the electrical connection,
7 or 13 pin 12 VDC connections are
to be used (CUNA/UNI and ISO/DIN
Standards). Follow the instructions
provided by the vehicle manufacturer
and/or the tow hitch manufacturer.
An electric brake should be supplied
directly by the battery through a cable
with a cross section of no less than 2,5
mm².
WARNING Electric brakes or other
devices must be used with engine
running. In addition to the electrical
branches, the electric system of the
vehicle can only be connected to the
supply cable for an electric brake and
to the cable for an internal light, though
not above 15W. For connections use
the preset control unit with battery
cable no less than 2.5 mm².
WARNING The trailer tow hook
contributes to the length of the vehicle.
When installing on long wheelbase
versions, it is only possible to install
removable tow hooks because the
total vehicle length limit of 6 metres is
exceeded. If no trailer is fitted, the hook
must be removed from the attachment
base and it must not exceed the
original length of the vehicle.
WARNING If you wish to leave the
tow hook fitted without towing a
trailer, it is advisable to contact a Fiat
Dealership for the relevant system
update operations because the tow
hook could be detected as an obstacle
by the central sensors.
Installation diagram for Van
versions fig. 152
The tow hook structure must be
fastened in the points shown by the
symbol Ø using a total of 6 M10x1.25
screws and 4 M12 screws.
The internal back plates must be
at least 5 mm thick. MAX LOAD ON
BALL: 100/120 kg according to the
payload (see “Weights” table in the
“Technical data” chapter).
The structure Ø must be fixed in the
points indicated using a total of 6
M10x1.25 screws and 4 M12 screws.
MAX LOAD ON BALL: 100/120
kg according to the payload (see
“Weights” table in the “Technical data”
chapter).
WARNING
152) The ABS with which the vehicle may
be equipped will not control the braking
system of the trailer. Particular caution is
required on slippery roads.
153) Never modify the braking system
of the vehicle to control the trailer brake.
The trailer braking system must be fully
independent from the hydraulic system of
the vehicle.
154) After fitting, screw holes must be
sealed to prevent exhaust gas infiltrations.
154)
To install a tow hook, the bumpers
must be trimmed as described in the
supplier's installation kit.
Installation diagram for Truck and
Chassis Cab versions fig. 153
Another tow hook specific to Truck
and Chassis Cab versions is shown in
fig. 153.
145
M12
152
146
F1A0164
STARTING AND DRIVING
153
F1A0165
147
STARTING AND DRIVING
148
INSTRUCTIONS FOR
USING THE REMOVABLE
BALL HEAD TOW BAR
47) 48) 49) 50) 51) 52)
Before setting off, check the correct
locking of the removable ball head tow
bar, as follows:
The green mark of the flywheel must
coincide with the green mark on the
tow bar.
The flywheel is in the stop position on
the tow bar (without slot).
Locked lock and key removed. The
flywheel cannot be removed.
Ball head bar firmly secured to the
housing pipe.
Check by shaking with a hand.
The fitting procedure must be repeated
if any of the 4 checked requirements is
not met.
If even only one of the requirements
is not met the tow hook must not be
used, as in this case there is risk of
accidents.
Contact the joint manufacturer.
The ball head tow bar can be fitted and
removed manually, without needing any
tool.
Never use working tools or means, as
the mechanism could be damaged.
Never unlock in the case of trailer
attached to the vehicle or fitted rack.
When driving without trailer or rack the
ball head tow bar must be removed
and the closing plug must always be
inserted in the housing pipe. This
applies particularly if the visibility of the
number plate characters or of the
lighting system is reduced.
156
154
F1A0380
Locked position, driving fig. 155
155
F1A0381
Released position, removed fig. 156
F1A0382
Removable ball head tow bar
fig. 154 - fig. 155 - fig. 156
(1) Mounting pipe - (2) Ball head tow
bar - (3) Locking balls - (42) Release
lever - (5) Handwheel - (6) Cap - (7)
Wrench - (82) Red mark (handwheel)
- (9) Green mark (handwheel) - (10)
Green mark (tow bar) - (11) Symbol
(release control) - (12) Closing plug
- (13) Coupling pin - (14) No gaps
between 2 and 5 - (15) Gap of about 5
mm
Installing the ball head tow bar
1. Remove the plug from the mounting
pipe.
The ball head tow bar is usually in the
released position when taken out from
the boot. This can be observed by
the flywheel spaced from the tow bar,
corresponding to a slot of approx. 5
mm (see fig. 155) and by the red mark
on the flywheel directed to the green
mark on the tow bar.
Please note that the tow bar can be
installed only when in these conditions.
If the locking mechanism of the tow bar
is disengaged before the installation, or
at any other time, and is in the locked
position, it must be pre-loaded. The
locked position can be identified by the
green mark of the flywheel coinciding
with the green mark of the tow bar and
by the flywheel in the stop position on
the tow bar, namely without slot (see
fig. 155).
The locking mechanism is pre-loaded
as follows: with the key inserted and
the lock open, extract the flywheel
following the direction of the arrow (a)
and, to pre-load, rotate according to
the direction of the arrow (b) until the
stop. The release lever is engaged
and the locking mechanism remains
in the pre-loading position even when
the flywheel is released. The tow bar
must be inserted in the housing pipe
with the coupling pin for the installation.
Insert from the bottom and push
upwards. The mechanism then locks
automatically. Keep your hands far
from the flywheel, as it rotates during
the locking procedure.
2. The tow bar must be inserted in the
housing pipe with the coupling pin for
the installation. Insert from the bottom
and push upwards. The mechanism
then locks automatically. Keep your
hands far from the flywheel, as it
rotates during the locking procedure.
3. Close the lock and always remove
the key. The key cannot be removed
when the lock is released. Apply the
protection cap on the lock.
Removing the tow bar
1. Remove the protection cap from the
lock and press it on the key grip. Open
the lock with the key.
2. Hold the tow bar firmly, remove the
flywheel following the direction of the
arrow and rotate according to the
direction of the arrow b until stopping,
so as to remove till the extracted
position. Then remove the tow bar from
the housing pipe. The flywheel can then
be released; it autonomously stops in
the released position.
3. Arrange the tow bar in the luggage
compartment so that it cannot
be dirtied or damaged by other
transported objects.
4. Insert the suitable plug in the
mounting pipe.
49) To ensure correct operation of the
system, periodically remove all dirt
deposits from the ball head bar and from
the mounting pipe. The mechanical
components must be serviced at the
specified intervals. The lock must only be
treated with graphite.
50) Periodically lubricate the joints, the
sliding surfaces and the balls with grease
without resin or oil. Lubrication is also a
further corrosion protection.
51) If the vehicle is washed with highpressure jets, the ball head bar must be
removed and the dedicated cap fitted. The
ball head bar must never be treated with
steam jets.
52) Two keys are supplied together with
the removable ball tow bar. Note down the
key number on the pawl for any following
order and keep it.
IMPORTANT
47) The removable ball head bar must
be repaired and taken apart by the
manufacturer only.
48) The accompanying plate must be in a
highly visible point of the vehicle, near the
mounting pipe or inside the boot.
149
STARTING AND DRIVING
150
VEHICLE INACTIVITY
If the vehicle needs to be off the
road for longer than one month, the
following precautions must be taken:
park the vehicle indoors in a dry and,
if possible, well-ventilated place;
engage a gear;
check that the handbrake is not
engaged;
disconnect the negative battery
terminal; if the vehicle is equipped
with a battery disconnection function
(disconnector), see the description
of the procedure in the "Controls"
paragraph in the "Knowing the vehicle"
section;
clean and protect the painted parts
using protective wax;
clean and protect the shiny metal
parts using special compounds
available commercially;
sprinkle talcum powder on the
windscreen and rear window wiper
rubber blades and lift them off the
glass;
slightly open the windows;
cover the vehicle with a piece of
fabric or perforated plastic sheet. Do
not use compact plastic tarpaulins,
which prevent humidity from
evaporating from the surface of the
vehicle;
inflate tyres to +0.5 bar above the
standard prescribed pressure and
check it periodically;
do not drain the engine cooling
system.
WARNING If the vehicle is equipped
with an alarm system, switch off the
vehicle alarm with the remote control.
WARNING After turning the ignition
key to STOP and having closed
the driver side door, wait at least
one minute before disconnecting the
electrical supply from the battery. When
reconnecting the electrical supply to
the battery, make sure that the ignition
key is in the STOP position and the
driver side door is closed.
IN AN EMERGENCY
A punctured tyre or a burnt-out bulb?
At times, a problem may interfere with
our journey.
The pages on emergencies can help
you to deal with critical situations
independently and with calm.
In an emergency we recommend that
you call the freephone number found in
the Warranty Booklet.
The www.fiatprofessional.com,
website, or www.fiatcamper.com,
for motorhome owners, provides
information about the nearest Fiat
Service Network together with a great
deal of other useful information.
REPLACING A BULB ..................
REPLACING AN EXTERIOR
BULB .......................................
REPLACING INTERIOR BULBS ....
REPLACING FUSES ...................
GATEWAY FMS MODULE ...........
CHANGING A WHEEL ................
FIX & GO AUTOMATIC QUICK
TYRE REPAIR KIT ......................
EMERGENCY STARTING ............
BATTERY RECHARGING ............
FUEL CUT-OFF SWITCH .............
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
GEAR LEVER RELEASE ..............
KEY RELEASE AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION ........................
TOWING THE VEHICLE ..............
152
155
160
161
172
177
181
183
184
185
186
187
188
151
IN AN EMERGENCY
REPLACING A BULB
GENERAL
INSTRUCTIONS
155) 156)
53)
When a light is not working, check
that the corresponding fuse is intact
before changing a bulb. For the
location of fuses, refer to the paragraph
"Replacing fuses" in this chapter.
before changing a bulb check the
contacts for oxidation;
burnt bulbs must be replaced by
others of the same type and power;
always check the headlight beam
direction after changing a bulb;
WARNING A slight misting may
appear on the internal surface of the
headlight: this does not indicate a fault
and is caused by low temperature
and the degree of humidity in the air.
Misting will rapidly disappear when
the headlights are switched on. The
presence of drops inside the headlights
indicates infiltration of water. Contact a
Fiat Dealership.
152
WARNING
155) Modifications or repairs to the electric
system that are not carried out properly
or do not take the system technical
specifications into account can cause
malfunctions leading to the risk of fire.
156) Halogen bulbs contain pressurised
gas, in the case of breakage they may
burst causing glass fragments to be
projected outwards.
IMPORTANT
53) Halogen bulbs must be handled
holding the metallic part only. Touching
the transparent part of the bulb with your
fingers may reduce the intensity of the
emitted light and even reduce the lifespan
of the bulb. In the event of accidental
contact, wipe the bulb with a cloth
moistened with alcohol and let the bulb
dry.
BULB TYPES
Various types of bulbs are fitted to your vehicle:
All-glass bulb: (type A) these are pressure fitted - pull to remove.
Bayonet bulb: (type B) to remove them press the bulb and turn it
anticlockwise.
Cylindrical bulbs: (type C) release them from their contacts to
remove.
Halogen bulbs: (type D) to remove the bulb, release it and extract it
from its seat.
Halogen bulbs: (type E) to remove the bulb, release it and extract it
from its seat.
153
IN AN EMERGENCY
Light bulbs
Light bulbs
Type
Power
Figure ref.
Main beams
H7
55W
D
Dipped headlights
H7
55W
D
W21/5W - LED (*)
–
–
H11
55W
–
WY21W
21W
B
W16WF (***) / WY5W (****)
16W (***) / 5W (****)
A
Rear direction indicators
PY2IW
21W
B
Side lights
W5W
5W
A
P21/5W
21/5W
B
Rear side lights/Brake lights
P21W
21W
B
Third brake light
W5W
5W
B
Reverse gear
W16W
16W
B
Rear fog light
W16W
16W
B
Number plate
C5W
5W
A
Front roof light (movable lens)
12V10W
10W
C
Rear roof light
12V10W
10W
C
Front side lights / daytime running lights
Front fog lights (**)
Front direction indicators
Side turn light
Rear side lights
(*) Where provided, instead of W21/5W bulb
(**) For versions/markets where provided
(***) XL and Tempo Libero versions
(****) All other versions
154
REPLACING AN
EXTERIOR BULB
FRONT LIGHT CLUSTERS
To remove the headlight, operate as
follows:
open the bonnet by following the
procedure in the "Bonnet/Luggage
Compartment" paragraph in the
"Knowing your vehicle" chapter;
disconnect the electrical connector
(A) fig. 157 from the headlight;
undo the screws (B) fig. 158 fixing
the headlight to the body, release the
headlight from its housing, in the lower
part, as shown in fig. 158 and remove
the headlight placing it on a work
surface;
follow the steps described below for
replacing the bulbs;
after the replacement, refit the
headlight and secure it with the fixing
screws (B) fig. 158;
disconnect the electrical connector
(A) fig. 157 from the headlight.
157
158
F1A0337
F1A0338
The bulbs are arranged inside the light
cluster as follows fig. 159:
(A) direction indicators
(B) dipped beam headlights
(C) main beam headlights
(D) daytime running lights
E side lights/DRLs with LEDs (as an
alternative to (D))
159
F1A0313
To replace a main beam headlight bulb,
remove the rubber cap (C) fig. 160.
To replace a dipped beam headlight
bulb, remove the rubber cap (B)
fig. 160.
To replace a direction indicator or side
light/DRL bulb (when not LED), remove
the rubber cap (A) fig. 160.
After replacement, refit the rubber caps
correctly, ensuring that they are locked
in place.
160
F1A0314
155
IN AN EMERGENCY
SIDE LIGHTS/DAYTIME
RUNNING LIGHTS (LEDs)
These are LEDs. For replacement,
contact a Fiat Dealership.
SIDE LIGHTS/DAYTIME
RUNNING LIGHTS
To replace the bulb, proceed as
follows:
remove the protective rubber cover
(A) fig. 160;
turn the bulb holder (B) fig. 161
anticlockwise;
extract the bulb by pulling and
replace it;
remove the bulb by pushing it slightly
and turning it anticlockwise (bayonet
mount);
refit the bulb holder (B) by turning it
clockwise and making sure that it locks
correctly;
refit the protective rubber cover (A)
fig. 160.
161
156
F1A0386
MAIN BEAM HEADLIGHTS
162
DIPPED BEAM
HEADLIGHTS
With incandescent bulbs
F1A0315
To replace the bulb, proceed as
follows:
remove the protective rubber cover
(C) fig. 160;
free the bulb holder (A) fig. 150 from
the side clips B and remove it;
disconnect the electrical connector;
fit the new bulb, ensuring that the
outline of the metal part coincides
with the grooves on the curve of the
headlight, pressing to engage it with
the side clips;
reconnect the electrical connector;
refit the protective rubber cover (C)
fig. 160.
163
F1A0316
To replace the bulb, proceed as
follows:
remove the protective rubber cover
(B) fig. 160;
free the bulb holder (A) fig. 163 from
the side clips (B) and remove it;
disconnect the electrical connector;
fit the new bulb, ensuring that the
outline of the metal part coincides
with the grooves on the curve of the
headlight, pressing to engage it with
the side clips;
reconnect the electrical connector;
refit the protective rubber cover (B)
fig. 160.
DIRECTION INDICATORS
To replace the bulb, proceed as
follows:
remove the protective rubber cover
(A) fig. 160;
turn the bulb holder (B) fig. 164
anticlockwise;
extract the bulb by pulling and
replace it;
remove the bulb by pushing it slightly
and turning it anticlockwise (bayonet
mount);
refit the bulb holder B by turning it
clockwise and making sure that it locks
correctly;
refit the protective rubber cover (A)
fig. 160.
164
F1A0317
Side
To change the bulb, proceed as follows
fig. 165:
move the mirror manually to permit
access to the two fixing screws (A);
using the Phillips screwdriver
provided, undo the screws and extract
the bulb holder assembly, releasing it
from the teeth;
undo the bulb and replace bulb (B),
turning it anticlockwise.
165
166
F1A0361
167
F1A0362
F1A0195
FOG LIGHTS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
To replace the front fog light bulbs,
proceed as follows:
steer the wheel completely inwards;
undo the screw (A) and remove the
flap (B) fig. 166;
adjust the clip (C) fig. 167 and
disconnect the electrical connector (D);
turn and remove the bulb holder (E);
release the bulb and replace it;
refit the new bulb and carry out the
procedure described previously in
reverse.
157
IN AN EMERGENCY
REAR LIGHT CLUSTERS
168
F1A0318
The bulbs are arranged inside the light
cluster as follows fig. 168:
(A) brake/side lights
(B) sidelights
(C) Direction indicators
(D) reversing lights
(E) rear fog lights
To change the bulb, proceed as follows
fig. 169, fig. 170:
open the rear swing door;
158
169
F1A0319
undo the 7 fixing screws (A) of the
plastic cover;
undo the two fixing screws (B);
extract the unit outwards and
disconnect the electrical connector;
unscrew the screws (C) using the
screwdriver provided and remove the
bulb holder;
170
F1A0320
remove the bulb to be replaced D,
(E), (F) pushing it slightly and turning
it anticlockwise (bayonet mount) and
replace it; extract the bulb (G), (H)
pulling it outwards;
refit the bulb holder and tighten the
screws (C);
reconnect the electrical connector,
correctly reposition the unit on the
body of the vehicle and then tighten the
fixing screws (B);
refit the plastic cover fastening it with
the 7 fixing screws (A).
THIRD BRAKE LIGHTS
NUMBER PLATE LIGHTS
172
174
For truck and chassis cab versions:
F1A0204
F1A0206
To replace the bulb proceed as follows:
operate in the point indicated by
the arrow and remove the lens unit (A)
fig. 174;
change the bulb releasing it from the
side contacts and making sure the new
bulb is correctly fastened between the
contacts;
refit the snap-fitted lens unit.
171
F1A0200
Undo the four screws (H) fig. 171 and
replace the bulbs:
(I) bulb for rear fog light
(L) bulb for reversing light
(M) bulb for side light
(N) bulb for brake light
(O) direction indicator bulb.
173
F1A0205
To replace the bulb proceed as follows:
undo the two fixing screws (A)
fig. 172;
extract the lens unit;
press the tabs (B) fig. 173 together
and remove the bulb holder;
remove the snap-fitted bulb and
replace.
SIDE LIGHTS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
To replace the bulb proceed as follows:
For extra-long van
undo the two fixing screws (C)
fig. 175 and remove the headlight;
remove the bulb-holder (D) on the
rear of the light cluster, turning through
1/4 turn;
remove the snap-fitted bulb and
replace.
159
IN AN EMERGENCY
REPLACING
INTERIOR BULBS
For the type of bulb and relevant power
rating, see “Replacing a bulb”.
175
F1A0207
For chassis cabs with platform
remove the bulb-holder on the rear
of the light cluster, turning through 1/4
turn;
remove the snap-fitted bulb and
replace.
FRONT CEILING LIGHT
To replace the bulbs, proceed as
follows:
operate in the point shown by the
arrow and remove roof light (A) fig. 176;
176
F1A0208
open protective flap (B) fig. 177;
replace the bulbs (C) fig. 177 by
releasing them from the side contacts
and making sure that the new bulbs
are correctly secured between the
contacts;
160
177
F1A0209
re-close the flap (B) fig. 177 and
fasten the ceiling light (A) fig. 176 in its
housing, making sure that it locks into
place.
LED LOAD
COMPARTMENT
COURTESY LIGHT
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Contact a Fiat Dealership for replacing
an LED front ceiling light.
REAR CEILING LIGHT
To replace the bulbs, proceed as
follows:
operate in the points shown by the
arrow and remove ceiling light (D)
fig. 178;
open protective flap (E) fig. 179;
change the bulb (F) fig. 179 releasing
it from the side contacts and making
sure the new bulb is correctly fastened
between the contacts;
close the protective flap E fig. 179
and re-insert the roof light (D) fig. 178
in its housing, making sure that it locks
into place.
REPLACING FUSES
DASHBOARD FUSEBOX
GENERAL INFORMATION
157) 158) 159) 160)
54)
178
F1A0210
Fuses protect the electrical system:
they intervene (blow) in the event
of a failure or improper action on
the system. Check the state of the
corresponding fuse when a device
does not work: the filament (A) fig. 180
should be intact. If it is not, replace the
blown fuse with another with the same
amperage (same colour).
(B) intact fuse.
(C) fuse with damaged filament.
181
179
F1A0211
180
F1A0214
To access the dashboard fusebox
fig. 181, loosen the screws (A) fig. 182
and remove the cover.
F1A0212
FUSE LOCATION
The vehicle fuses are grouped in three
control units located on the dashboard,
passenger compartment right pillar and
engine compartment.
161
IN AN EMERGENCY
182
F1A0213
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
FUSEBOX – OPTIONAL WIRING
MODULE
To gain access to the fuse fig. 184
- fig. 185 - fig. 186, remove the
protective cover fig. 183.
slowly rotate the screw anticlockwise
until resistance is encountered (do not
overtighten);
slowly release the screw;
opening is indicated by the entire
screw head coming out of its housing;
remove the cover.
To refit the cover proceed as follows:
join the cover with the box correctly;
fully tighten the captive screw using
the dedicated Phillips screwdriver
provided;
slowly rotate the screw clockwise
until resistance is encountered (do not
overtighten);
slowly release the screw;
closure is indicated by the inset of
the entire screw head in its housing.
Engine compartment fusebox
184
183
F1A0334
Proceed as follows:
fully tighten the captive screw using
the dedicated Phillips screwdriver
provided;
162
F1A0216
Wired module
(2.3 120 HP - 140 HP - 160 HP - 180
HP Multijet with AdBlue®)
185
WARNING
157) Never replace a fuse with another
with a higher amp rating; RISK OF FIRE.
If a general protection fuse (MEGA-FUSE,
MIDI-FUSE) is activated, contact a Fiat
Dealership.
158) Before replacing a fuse, make sure
that the ignition key has been removed
and that all the other services are switched
off and/or disengaged.
159) If the replaced fuse blows again,
contact a Fiat Dealership.
160) Contact Fiat Dealership if a safety
system (airbags, brakes), engine system
(engine, transmission) or steering system
general protection fuse blows.
F1A0458-1
Optional wired module
IMPORTANT
186
187
F1A0218
188
F1A0217
54) Never replace a faulty fuse with metal
wires or anything else.
F1A0455-1
RIGHT CENTRAL PILLAR
OPTIONAL FUSEBOX
(for versions/markets, where provided)
To gain access to the fuse box fig. 187,
remove the protective cover fig. 188.
163
IN AN EMERGENCY
164
Dashboard fusebox
Protected device
Fuse
Ampere
Right dipped beam headlight
F12
7.5
Left dipped headlight
F13
7.5
Engine compartment fusebox relay, dashboard control unit relay (+key)
F31
5
Lighting of roof lights in the passenger compartment (+battery)
F32
7.5
Battery monitoring sensor for Start&Stop versions (+battery)
F33
7.5
Minibus interior lights (emergency)
F34
7.5
Radio, Climate control system, Alarm, Tachograph, Battery disconnecting
control unit, Webasto timer (+battery), TPMS, Current stabiliser for radio setup
(S&S)
F36
10
Brake lights control (main), Instrument panel (+key), Gateway (for transformers)
F37
7.5
Door lock (+battery)
F38
20
Windscreen wiper (+key)
F43
20
Driver's side electric window
F47
20
Passenger side electric window
F48
20
Parking sensor control unit, radio, steering wheel controls, central control panel,
left control panel, auxiliary panel, battery disconnecting control unit (+key), Trailer
hook, Rain sensor, Current stabiliser (for S&S)
F49
5
Climate control system, power steering control unit, reversing lights, Tachograph
(+key), TOM TOM setup, Lane Departure Warning, Rear camera, Headlight
alignment corrector
F51
5
Instrument panel (+battery)
F53
7.5
Protected device
Fuse
Ampere
Not available
F89
–
Left main beam headlight
F90
7.5
Right main beam headlight
F91
7.5
Left fog light
F92
7.5
Right fog light
F93
7.5
165
IN AN EMERGENCY
2.3 120 HP - 140 HP - 160 HP - 180 HP Multijet versions with AdBlue®
189
F1A0472
TO: Engine compartment fusebox - B: Wired module - C: Optional wired module
Protected device
166
Fuse
Ampere
Wired module B power (+battery)
F05
50
Engine cooling high speed fan (+battery)
F06
40/60
Engine cooling low speed fan (+battery)
F07
40/50/60
Passenger compartment fan (+key)
F08
40
Rear power socket (+battery)
F09
15
Horn
F10
15
Power socket (+battery)
F14
15
Cigar lighter (+battery)
F15
15
Protected device
Fuse
Ampere
Air conditioning compressor
F19
7.5
Windscreen wiper
F20
30
Auxiliary control panel for mirror movement and folding (+key)
F24
7.5
Mirror demisting
F30
15
Webasto control unit
F61
30
Passenger compartment fan with Webasto
F62
20
Trailer hook socket
F63
20
Headlight washers
F64
30
Trailer control unit
F65
15
Trailer control unit
F66
15
Trailer hook socket
F67
20
Empty
F91
Empty
Empty
F92
Empty
Self-levelling suspension
F93
7.5
Empty
F94
Empty
SCR UREA (Urea control module)
F95
15
SCR UREA (Urea sensors)
F96
15
Automatic transmission control unit
F97
15
Automatic transmission lever
F98
5
167
IN AN EMERGENCY
3.0 140 Natural Power versions
190
F1A0490
TO: Engine compartment fusebox - B: Wired module (*) - C: Optional wired module
Protected device
168
Fuse
Ampere
Engine cooling high speed fan (+battery)
F06
40/60
Engine cooling low speed fan (+battery)
F07
40/50
Passenger compartment fan (+key)
F08
40
Rear power socket (+battery)
F09
15
Horn
F10
15
Power socket (+battery)
F14
15
Cigar lighter (+battery)
F15
15
Air conditioning compressor
F19
7.5
Windscreen wiper
F20
30
Protected device
Fuse
Ampere
Auxiliary control panel for mirror movement and folding (+key)
F24
7.5
Mirror demisting
F30
15
Trailer hook socket
F63
20
Headlight washers
F64
30
Trailer control unit
F65
15
Trailer control unit
F66
15
Trailer hook socket
F67
20
Methane tank valve (CNG)
F68
10
Methane relay solenoid valves
T51
30
(*) Not present on Natural Power versions, present only on versions with AdBlue®
169
IN AN EMERGENCY
Right central pillar optional fusebox
191
Protected device
170
F1A0475
Fuse
Ampere
Engine intake / ventilation fan (MBUS)
F54
15
Heated seats
F55
15
Rear passenger power socket
F56
15
Additional heater under the seat
F57
10
Left heated rear window
F58
15
Protected device
Fuse
Ampere
Right heated rear window
F59
15
Not available
F60
–
Not available
F61
–
Not available
F62
–
Additional passenger heater control
F63
10
Not available
F64
–
Additional passenger heater fan
F65
30
NOTE If the methane has run out, the control unit automatically manages the switch to running on petrol.
171
IN AN EMERGENCY
172
GATEWAY FMS
MODULE
The Gateway FMS Module provides
the interface between the vehicle data
network and the FMS standard.
FMS: The Fleet Management Systems
Interface (FMS) is a standard interface
that allows the digital electronic control
unit of the vehicle signals to be read.
The information in these signals can
be used to facilitate the personalisation
or special outfitting of the vehicle. The
Gateway FMS Module supports the
following FMS Standard versions:
FMS - Standard Interface description
Vers. 02 (available on http://www.fmsstandard.com/Truck/index.htm)
Bus FMS - Standard
Interface description Vers. 02
(available on http://www.fmsstandard.com/Bus/index.htm)
We advise having the Gateway FMS
Module installed by the Fiat Dealership
or specialist technicians. The fitting
instructions are in the Fitters/Installers
Manual on the HYPERLINK website
"http://www.fiatprofessionalconverters.com" www.fiatprofessionalconverters.com.
The following table shows all signals
available to control units interfaced with
the Gateway FMS Module.
Message
Signal
Description
Parking Brake Switch
Indicates parking brake engaged
Wheel based speed
Indicates vehicle speed
Clutch switch
Indicates clutch pedal pressed
Brake switch
Indicates brake pedal pressed
Cruise control active
Indicates Cruise Control active
Accelerator pedal position 1
Indicates accelerator pedal position
Engine Percent Load At Current Speed
Indicates percentage ratio between engine
torque and maximum indicated torque at
current engine speed
LFC
Engine total fuel used
Indicates total fuel used during vehicle
operation
DD
Fuel Level
Indicates ratio of fuel volume to total tank
volume
EEC1
Engine speed
Indicates engine speed
VDHR
High resolution total vehicle distance
Indicates total vehicle distance travelled
ET1
Engine coolant temperature
Indicates temperature of engine coolant
AMB
Ambient Air Temperature
Indicates temperature outside of vehicle
Fuel Rate
Indicates quantity of fuel used by engine per
time unit
Instantaneous Fuel Economy
Indicates ratio between quantity of fuel used
and current vehicle speed
CCVS
EEC2
LFE
173
IN AN EMERGENCY
Message
Description
SERV
Service distance
Indicates distance that can be travelled by
vehicle before scheduled servicing
HOURS
Total engine hours
Indicates total engine operating time
DC1
Position of doors
Indicates current door status
AS
Alternator Status 1
Indicates current alternator status
Selected Gear (1)
Indicates next awaited gear
Current Gear (1)
Indicates current gear
Minutes
Indicates minutes
Hours
Indicates hours
Month
Indicates month
Day
Indicates day
Year
Indicates year
High beam, main beam
Indicates active main beam headlight status
Low beam
Indicates active dipped headlight status
Turn signals
Indicates active direction indicator status
Hazard warning
Indicates active hazard warning light status
Parking Brake
Indicates parking brake engaged
Brake failure / brake system malfunction
Indicates braking system fault
Hatch open
Indicates rear door not shut
Fuel level
Indicates fuel reserve warning light on
ETC2
TD
FMS1 (2)
174
Signal
Message
FMS1 (2)
TC01
Signal
Description
Engine coolant temperature
Indicates engine coolant overheating warning
light on
Battery charging condition
Indicates insufficient battery charge warning
light on
Engine oil
Indicates insufficient engine oil pressure
warning light on
Position lights, side lights
Indicates active side light status
Front fog lights
Indicates active fog light status
Rear fog light
Indicates active rear fog light status
Engine / Mil indicator
Indicates EOBD/injection system failure warning
light on
Service, call for maintenance
Indicates scheduled service indicator displayed
Transmission failure / malfunction
Indicates transmission system fault
Anti-lock brake system failure
Indicates ABS failure warning light on
Worn brake linings
Indicates brake pad wear warning light on
Malfunction / general failure
Indicates general failure warning light on
Height Control (Levelling)
Indicates self-levelling suspension indicator
displayed
Engine Emission system failure (MIL indicator)
Indicates particulate filter blocked warning light
on
ESC indication
Indicates stability control warning light on
Tachogr. vehicle speed (3)
Indicates vehicle speed stored by
chronotachograph
175
IN AN EMERGENCY
Message
DC2
FMS
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
176
Signal
Description
Open Status Door 1
Indicates driver door status
Open Status Door 2
Indicates passenger door status
Open Status Door 3 (4)
Indicates rear door(s) status
Open Status Door 4 (4)
Indicates sliding side door status
Open Status Door 5 (4)
Indicates sliding side door status
Requests supported
Indicates whether Gateway FMS Module can
respond to requests from external FMS module
Diagnostics supported
Indicates whether Gateway FMS Module
supports requests for sending diagnosis
information
FMS-standard SW - version supported
Indicates the FMS Standard version supported
by the Gateway FMS Module
Available on vehicle versions with Comfort-Matic transmission
The signal values are derived from information shown on the instrument panel
The vehicle speed signal is still available even if there is no chronotachograph
If the content is not present, the signal value transmitted is ‘closed’
CHANGING A WHEEL
(E) - extension for spanner
(F) - screwdriver grip
(G) - screwdriver bit
GENERAL
INSTRUCTIONS
Wheel replacement and correct
use of the jack and spare wheel (for
versions/markets, where provided) call
for some precautions, which are listed
below.
161) 162) 163) 164) 165)
Please note that:
the jack weight is 4.5 kg;
the jack requires no adjustment;
the jack cannot be repaired: in the
event of a fault it must be replaced by
another original one;
no tool other than its cranking device
may be fitted on the jack.
166)
To change a wheel, proceed as
follows:
stop the vehicle in a position that is
not dangerous for oncoming traffic
where you can change the wheel
safely. The ground must be flat and
sufficiently compact;
192
F1A0168
switch off the engine and pull the
handbrake;
engage first gear or reverse;
wear the reflective safety jacket
(compulsory by law in certain countries)
before getting out of the vehicle;
indicate that the vehicle has broken
down using the devices required by the
law in the current country (e.g. warning
triangle, hazard lights, etc.);
in the event of a wheel change on a
slope or on unsurfaced roads, put any
object as stop under the wheels;
take the tool bag under the
passenger seat (see “Compartment
under front passenger seat” in the
“Know your vehicle” section).
The container includes these tools:
(A) - tow hook
(B) - rod for spanner
(C) - bolt spanner
(D) - jack
193
F1A0420
if the tool container is not provided,
for special trim versions, a bag
containing the above tools may be
provided;
for versions with alloy rims, remove
the press-fitted hub cap;
take the extension for spanner, the
bolt spanner and the rod for spanner
from the tool container;
with the tools assembled correctly,
loosen the fixing bolts for the wheel to
be changed by one turn;
turn the ring nut to partly extend the
jack;
position the jack at the lifting support
nearest the wheel to be replaced, at
the points shown in fig. 192. For short
wheelbase versions with retractable
footboard, the jack must be positioned
at the lift point shown in fig. 194 aligned
177
IN AN EMERGENCY
(45°) so that it does not interfere with
the retractable footboard;
195
194
F1A0169
warn all bystanders that the vehicle is
about to be lifted. They must stay clear
and not touch the vehicle until it is back
on the ground.
for versions equipped with selflevelling pneumatic suspension, before
using the jack to raise the vehicle,
press the buttons (A) and (B) fig. 195
simultaneously for at least 5 seconds.
The operating mode for raising the
vehicle is activated: the LEDs on the
buttons come on constantly.
To exit this mode, press buttons (A)
and (B) simultaneously for another 5
seconds; both LEDs on the buttons
will go out and full system operation
will be restored. This mode deactivates
automatically when the speed of
approx. 5 km/h is exceeded.
167)
178
F1A0170
lift the vehicle.
After lifting the vehicle:
for all versions, access the rear right
wheel arch, operate the screw (A)
fig. 196 on the spare wheel retaining
device, using the supplied wrench
assembled correctly with the dedicated
extension (B) fig. 196;
turn the tool anticlockwise fig. 197 to
allow the spare wheel to descend;
continue turning anticlockwise
until the stop point, indicated by the
stiffening of the manoeuvre or a click
from the clutch present in the device;
168) 169)
196
F1A0171
after unwinding the whole cable of
the spare wheel lifting device, remove
the wheel from the vehicle;
197
F1A0421
undo the retaining knob (D) fig. 198
and free the wheel by sliding out the
support (E).
supported in its housing beneath the
floor pan (D) fig. 197.
170)
198
F1A0174
with the tools assembled, undo the
bolts fig. 199 fully and remove the
wheel;
fit the spare wheel, aligning holes (G)
fig. 200 with the pins (H). When fitting
the spare wheel, ensure that the wheel
support surfaces are clean and free of
impurities that could later cause the
bolts to loosen;
screw in the 5 fastening bolts;
assemble the tools to tighten the
bolts fully, passing alternately from one
bolt to the diagonally opposite one,
following the scheme shown in fig. 200;
use the wheel removal wrench to
lower the vehicle and remove the jack;
199
F1A0422
At the end of the operation:
take the replaced wheel, reattach it
to the support (E) fig. 198 and tighten
the knob (D);
H
G
200
F1A0176
introduce the assembly tool fig. 197
provided with the suitable extension
(B) fig. 196 on the screw (A) fig. 196 of
the spare wheel housing manoeuvring
device and turn clockwise 2 to lift the
spare wheel back up until it is fully
201
F1A0430
For vehicles with alloy rims, proceed as
follows:
carry out the above described
operations for changing the wheel until
loading the punctured wheel on the
spare wheel lifting device;
take the kit from the tool bag, located
in the glove compartment;
the kit includes one bracket, three
special screws and one Allen spanner,
10 size;
go to the rear side of the vehicle
where the spare wheel is located;
make sure that all of the cable for
the spare wheel lifting device has been
unrolled, grip the bell and position it
inside the circular bracket fig. 202;
179
IN AN EMERGENCY
202
F1A0424
tighten the knob onto the screw to
secure the bracket fig. 203.
203
F1A0426
use the Allen key to tighten the three
special screws on the nuts of the
bracket fig. 205 and secure the rim;
F1A0425
rest the bracket on the inside of the
alloy rim fig. 204.
180
204
205
F1A0385
introduce the assembly tool fig. 197
provided with the suitable extension
(B) fig. 196 on the screw (A) fig. 196 of
the spare wheel housing manoeuvring
device and turn clockwise to lift the
spare wheel back up until it is fully
supported in its housing beneath the
floor pan (D) fig. 199.
check that the position of the
replaced wheel under the platform is
correct (the lifting system is equipped
with a clutch to limit the end of the
stroke, incorrect positioning may
jeopardise safety);
place the removal tools back in the
tool bag / compartment;
place the tool box / compartment in
its housing under the passenger seat.
171) 172)
WARNING
161) Use your hazard lights, warning
triangle, etc. to show that your vehicle is
stationary. Passengers should get out
of the vehicle, particularly if it is heavily
loaded, and wait for the wheel to be
changed away from the traffic. Apply the
handbrake. In the event of a wheel change
on a slope or on unsurfaced roads, put
any object as stop under the wheels.
162) The spare wheel supplied (for
versions/markets, where provided) is
specific for your vehicle. Therefore, it must
not be used on other models. Do not use
spare wheels of other models on your
vehicle. The wheel bolts are specific for
your vehicle: do not use them on different
models and do not use bolts from other
models on your vehicle.
163) Repair and refit the standard wheel
as soon as possible. Do not apply grease
to the bolt threads before fitting: they
could come unscrewed.
164) Use the jack only to replace wheels
on the vehicle with which it is supplied or
on other cars of the same model. Never
use the jack for other purposes, such as
lifting other vehicle models. Never use the
jack to carry out repairs under the vehicle.
Incorrect positioning of the jack may cause
the lifted vehicle to fall. Do not use the jack
for loads higher than the one shown on its
label.
165) Never tamper with the inflation valve.
Never introduce tools of any kind between
rim and tyre. Check tyre and spare wheel
pressure regularly, referring to the values
shown in the "Technical specifications"
section.
166) No tools other than the crank
provided should be used with the spare
wheel lifting device; it should be operated
by hand only.
167) On versions equipped with
self-levelling air suspension, never
introduce the head or hands in the wheel
arch. The vehicle could raise or lower
automatically depending on possible load
or temperature changes.
168) The device should only be operated
by hand, without using any type of
tool other than the crank provided like
pneumatic or electrical screwdrivers.
169) The moving components of the jack
(screws and joints) can also cause injuries:
avoid touching them. If you come into
contact with lubricating grease, clean
yourself thoroughly.
170) At the end of the operation of
raising/locking the spare wheel, after
having checked the correct positioning
of the wheel under the platform (yellow
notch inside the window on the device),
the spanner must be extracted, taking care
not to turn it in the wrong direction (as in
the figure) to facilitate the extraction of the
spanner itself, to prevent the attachment
device from being released and the wheel
assembly not being securely retained.
171) Each time the spare wheel is moved,
check that it is correctly positioned in its
housing under the platform. If it is not
correctly positioned, this could adversely
affect safety.
172) The spare wheel lifting device is
equipped with a clutch safety system for
its own protection; this could activated
if an excessive load is applied on the
manoeuvring screw.
FIX & GO
AUTOMATIC QUICK
TYRE REPAIR KIT
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The Fix & Go Automatic tyre repair kit
is positioned at the front of the vehicle
passenger compartment and includes
fig. 206:
206
F1A0180
a spray can (A) of liquid sealant,
complete with: clear filler hose (B);
black pressure top-up hose (E); sticker
(C) marked "max. 80 km/h", to be
affixed in a position in clear view of the
driver (on the instrument panel) after
the tyre has been repaired;
information leaflet (see fig. 207), to
be used for prompt and correct use of
the quick tyre repair kit and then to be
handed to the personnel charged with
handling the tyre treated with the tyre
repair kit;
compressor (D) complete with
pressure gauge and connectors;
a pair of protective gloves located
in the side compartment of the
compressor;
adaptors for inflating different
elements.
173) 174) 175)
55)
181
IN AN EMERGENCY
pressure" paragraph in the "Technical
specifications" section;
207
F1A0181
IMPORTANT
INFORMATION:
The sealing fluid of the quick repair kit
is effective at external temperatures of
between –20 °C and +50 °C.
The sealing fluid has an expiry date.
176) 177)
208
F1A0182
For a more accurate reading, it is
advisable to check the pressure on the
pressure gauge (F) fig. 209 with the
compressor off and without moving the
centre selector from the repair position;
the vehicle forwards by about 10
metres in order to distribute the sealing
fluid inside the tyre evenly, then repeat
the inflation operation;
if after this operation it is still
impossible after 10 minutes to reach
at least 3 bar, do not start driving
since the tyre is excessively damaged
and the quick tyre repair kit cannot
guarantee proper hold, contact a Fiat
Dealership;
if the tyre has been inflated to the
recommended pressure in the “Inflation
pressure" paragraph;
4)
INFLATION PROCEDURE
178) 179) 180) 181) 182)
Pull the handbrake. Unscrew the
tyre valve cap, take out the filler hose
(A)fig. 208and screw the ring nut
(B)onto the tyre valve;
insert the plug (E) fig. 210 in the
nearest 12V power socket and start
the engine. Turn the selector (D)
fig. 209 anticlockwise to the repair
position. Activate the kit by pressing
the on/off switch. Inflate the tyre to the
pressure specified in the "Inflation
182
210
209
F1A0183
if after 10 minutes it is still impossible
to reach at least 3 bar, release the
transparent filler pipe from the valve
and take out the 12 V plug, then move
F1A0335
after having driven for about 10
minutes, stop and re-check the tyre
pressure; remember to engage the
handbrake;
if a pressure value of at least 3 bar is
detected, restore the correct pressure
prescribed in the “Inflation pressure"
paragraph (with the engine running
and the handbrake engaged), resume
driving and drive with care to nearest
Fiat Dealership.
WARNING
173) Give the leaflet to the personnel
charged with handling the tyre treated with
the tyre repair kit.
174) Punctures on the sides of the tire
may not be repaired. Do not attempt to
use the quick repair kit if the tyre was
damaged as a result of being used when
underinflated.
175) Repairs are not possible in the case
of damage to the wheel rim (bad groove
distortion causing air loss). Do not remove
the foreign body (screws or nails) from the
tyre.
176) Never operate the compressor for
longer than 20 consecutive minutes. Risk
of overheating. Tyres repaired with the
quick tyre repair kit must only be used
temporarily, as the kit is not suitable for a
definitive repair.
177) The bottle contains ethylene glycol. It
contains latex that might cause allergic
reactions. It is harmful if swallowed. Eye
irritant. It may cause sensitisation if inhaled
or on contact. Avoid contact with eyes,
skin and clothes. In the case of contact,
wash immediately with plenty of water.
In the event that it is swallowed, do not
induce vomiting. Rinse out your mouth,
drink large quantities of water and seek
immediate medical attention. Keep out
of the reach of children. The product
must not be used by asthmatics. Do
not inhale the vapours during insertion
and suction. Call a doctor immediately
if allergic reactions are noted. Store the
bottle in its proper compartment, far from
sources of heat. The sealing fluid has
an expiry date. Replace the bottle if the
sealant has expired.
178) Put on the protective gloves provided
together with the quick tyre repair kit.
179) Apply the adhesive label where it can
be easily seen by the driver as a reminder
that the tyre has been treated with the
quick repair kit. Drive carefully, particularly
on bends. Do not exceed 80 km/h. Avoid
sudden acceleration or braking.
180) If the pressure falls below 3 bar,
do not drive any further: the Fix & Go
automatic quick tyre repair kit cannot
guarantee suitable sealing because the
tyre is too damaged. Contact a Fiat
Dealership.
181) Always indicate that the tyre was
repaired using the quick tyre repair kit.
Give the leaflet to the personnel charged
with handling the tyre treated with the tyre
repair kit.
182) If different tyres from the ones
supplied with the vehicle are used, it may
not be possible to carry out the repair. If
the tyres are replaced, it is advisable to
use those approved by the manufacturer.
Consult a Fiat Dealership.
IMPORTANT
4) Replace the bottle if the sealant has
expired. Dispose of the bottle and the
sealant properly. Have them disposed
of in compliance with national and local
regulations.
EMERGENCY
STARTING
Go to a Fiat Dealership immediately if
comes on steady on
warning light
the instrument panel.
JUMP STARTING
If the battery is flat, it is possible to start
the engine using an auxiliary battery
with the same capacity or a little higher
than the flat one.
It is advisable to contact a Fiat
Dealership to check/replace the
battery.
183)
IMPORTANT
55) In the event of a puncture caused by
foreign bodies, the kit may be used to
repair tyres showing damage on the tread
or shoulder up to max. 4 mm diameter.
211
F1A0351
183
IN AN EMERGENCY
Proceed as follows to start the vehicle:
lift the flap (A) fig. 211 to access the
positive battery terminal connection.
connect the positive terminals (+
mark near the terminal) of the two
batteries using a suitable cable;
use a second lead to connect the
negative terminal (–) of the auxiliary
battery to the earth point as shown in
fig. 212;
start the engine;
when the engine has been started,
remove the cables reversing the order
above.
vehicle, avoid any metal parts on the
latter and the vehicle with the flat
battery from accidentally coming into
contact.
BUMP STARTING
Never bump start the engine by
pushing, towing or driving downhill.
This could cause fuel to flow into the
catalytic converter and damage it
beyond repair.
WARNING
183) This starting procedure must be
performed by expert personnel because
incorrect actions could cause electrical
discharge of considerable intensity.
Furthermore, battery fluid is poisonous
and corrosive: avoid contact with skin and
eyes. Keep naked flames and lighted
cigarettes away from the battery and do
not cause sparks.
212
F1A0352
If after a few attempts the engine does
not start, do not persist but contact the
nearest Fiat Dealership.
WARNING Do not directly connect
the negative terminals of the two
batteries: sparks could ignite explosive
gas released from the battery. If the
auxiliary battery is installed on another
184
BATTERY
RECHARGING
WARNING The battery recharging
procedure is given as information only.
To carry out this operation contact a
Fiat Dealership.
WARNING After setting the ignition
device to STOP and having closed
the driver side door, wait at least
one minute before disconnecting the
electrical supply from the battery. When
reconnecting the electrical supply to
the battery, make sure that the ignition
device is in the STOP position and the
driver side door is closed.
WARNING Charging should be slow at
a low ampere rating for approximately
24 hours. Charging for a longer time
may damage the battery.
WARNING The cables of the electrical
system must be correctly reconnected
to the battery, i.e. the positive cable
(+) to the positive terminal and the
negative cable (–) to the negative
terminal. The battery terminals are
marked with the positive (+) and
negative (–) symbols, and are shown on
the battery cover. The battery terminals
must also be corrosion-free and firmly
secured to the terminals. If a "quick-
type" battery charger is used with the
battery fitted on the vehicle, disconnect
both battery leads before connecting
it. Do not use a "quick-type" battery
charger to provide the starting voltage.
turn on the charger;
at the end of the charging process,
switch the battery charger off;
after having disconnected the battery
charger, reconnect connector (A) to the
sensor (C) as shown fig. 213.
184) 185)
VERSIONS WITHOUT
START&STOP SYSTEM
To recharge, proceed as follows:
disconnect the terminal from the
negative battery pole;
connect the charger cables to the
battery terminals, observing the
polarity;
turn on the battery charger;
when it is recharged, turn the charger
off before disconnecting it from the
battery;
reconnect the terminal to the
negative battery pole.
VERSIONS WITH
START&STOP SYSTEM
To recharge, proceed as follows:
disconnect the connector (A)
(pressing the button (B)) from the
sensor (C) monitoring the battery
conditions, on the negative pole (D) of
the battery;
connect the positive cable of the
battery charger to the positive battery
terminal (E) and the negative cable (F)
to sensor terminal as shown in fig. 213;
213
F1A0219
WARNING
184) Battery fluid is poisonous and
corrosive: avoid contact with your skin and
eyes. The battery should be charged in a
well ventilated place, away from naked
flames or possible sources of sparks:
danger of explosion and fire.
185) Do not attempt to recharge a frozen
battery: first it must be thawed, otherwise
there is a risk of explosion. If freezing has
occurred, the battery should be checked
by specialised technicians to make sure
that the internal elements are not damaged
and that the body is not cracked, with the
risk of leaking poisonous and corrosive
acid.
FUEL CUT-OFF
SWITCH
The vehicle is fitted with a safety switch
that, in the event of a crash, comes
into operation by cutting off the fuel
supply and turning off the engine as a
consequence.
When the inertia switch cuts in, it cuts
off the fuel supply and also activates
the hazard warning lights, side lights
and courtesy lights while releasing all
the doors and displaying the relevant
message; they are deactivated by
pressing button (A). In the versions
where provided, there is also a safety
relay that activates in the event of
impact to cut off the electrical supply.
In this way, fuel wastage is prevented
following breakage of the lines and also
the formation of electrical sparks or
discharges after damage to the vehicle
electrical components.
186) 187)
WARNING After an accident,
remember to remove the key from the
ignition device to avoid draining the
battery. If no fuel leaks or damage to
electrical devices of the vehicle (e.g.
headlights) are detected after the
impact and the vehicle is able to set
off again, reactivate the automatic fuel
cut-off switch.
185
IN AN EMERGENCY
Restoring the fuel cut-off switch
Press the button to reactivate the fuel
cut-off switch (A) fig. 214.
214
F1A0086
WARNING
186) If, after a crash, you smell fuel or
notice leaks from the fuel supply system,
do not reset the switch to avoid fire risk.
187) Before reactivating the fuel cut-off
switch, carefully check for fuel leaks or
damage to the vehicle electrical devices
(e.g. headlights).
186
AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
GEAR LEVER
RELEASE
In the event of a failure, to move the
gear lever from P (Park), proceed as
follows:
turn off the engine and apply
the parking brake; lift the gaiter
upwards and release the trim from the
dashboard fig. 215 to access button
(A).
press and hold down the brake pedal
fully; press and hold down the release
button (A), bringing the gear lever to the
N (neutral) position;
refit the gear lever trim correctly.
215
F1A0468
KEY RELEASE
AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
56)
The ignition key (for versions with
key without remote control) can be
removed only if the gear lever is in
position P (Park).
If the vehicle battery is flat and the
ignition key is engaged, the latter is
locked in position.
To remove the key manually, proceed
as follows:
stop the vehicle in safe conditions,
engage a gear and the electric parking
brake;
using the key (A) fig. 216provided
(located in the container with the
vehicle documents), undo the fixing
screws (B) fig. 217 of the lower trim (C);
217
F1B0756
remove the lower steering column
trim (C) releasing it from its housing;
pull tab (D) fig. 218 downwards
using one hand and with the other one
remove the key, sliding it outwards;
218
F1A0469
once the key has been removed, refit
the lower trim (C) fig. 217, make sure
it locks correctly and fully tighten the
fixing screws (B).
IMPORTANT
216
F1A0477
56) It is advisable to contact a Fiat
Dealership to have the refitting procedure
carried out. If you would like to proceed
autonomously, special attention must
be paid to the correct coupling of the
187
IN AN EMERGENCY
retaining clips. Otherwise, noise might be
heard due to an incorrect fastening of the
lower cover with the upper cover.
TOWING THE
VEHICLE
188) 189) 190) 191) 192) 193) 194) 195) 196)
The vehicle is equipped with two rings
for attaching the tow hook.
221
F1A0344
The front ring is located in the tool box
beneath the passenger side seat.
On versions with Fix&Go kit and
without spare wheel, the tool box
is available only on request for
versions/markets where provided.
219
Open the flap (A) and remove it as
shown in fig. 219;
turn the lock knob (B) fig. 219
anticlockwise and remove it to allow
the compartment fig. 220 to be
removed;
take the screwdriver provided from
the box and prise up at the point
shown to raise the cap (C) fig. 222;
take the tow ring (D) from the box
and screw onto the threaded pin
fig. 222.
The rear ring (B) fig. 223 is located at
the point shown in the figure.
F1A0221
223
222
220
188
F1A0222
F1A0223
In the absence of the tool box the
vehicle front tow hook is housed in the
on-board documentation container,
together with the Owner Handbook.
To use it, proceed as follows:
VERSIONS WITH AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
Vehicles with AT9 automatic
transmission cannot be towed.
F1A0224
WARNING
188) Screw on the tow ring and check that
it stops at the end of travel position.
189) Before towing, switch off the steering
lock (see "Ignition switch" paragraph in the
"Knowing your vehicle" chapter).
190) The power brakes and power
steering will not operate while the vehicle
is being towed. More effort on the brake
pedal and steering wheel will therefore be
required.
191) Do not use flexible cables when
towing and avoid jerky movements. During
towing operations, make sure that the
fastened joint does not damage adjoining
components.
192) When towing the vehicle, it
is necessary to obey specific road
regulations which relate both to the towing
device as well as to the behaviour to adopt
on the road.
193) Do not start the engine whilst the
vehicle is being towed.
194) Towing must be made exclusively
on roads/streets; the device must not be
used to recover the vehicle if it got off the
road.
195) Towing must not be used in order to
get past significant obstacles on the road
(e.g. heaps of snow or material on the
road surface).
196) Towing must take place with the two
vehicles (one towing, the other towed)
aligned as much as possible. Towing by
roadside assistance vehicles, too, must
take place with the two vehicles aligned as
much as possible.
189
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
190
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
Correct maintenance permits the
performance of the vehicle to be
maintained over time, as well as limited
running costs and safeguarding the
efficiency of the safety systems.
This chapter explains how.
SCHEDULED SERVICING ...........
REGULAR CHECKS ...................
DEMANDING VEHICLE USE ........
SCHEDULED SERVICING
PLAN .......................................
CHECKING LEVELS ...................
AIR CLEANER/POLLEN
FILTER .....................................
BATTERY..................................
WINDSCREEN WIPER ................
LIFTING THE VEHICLE................
WHEELS AND TYRES.................
SNOW TYRES ...........................
SNOW CHAINS .........................
BODYWORK .............................
INTERIOR .................................
RUBBER HOSES .......................
191
191
191
193
199
204
205
206
207
207
208
209
209
210
211
SCHEDULED
SERVICING
Correct servicing is crucial for
guaranteeing a long life for the vehicle
under the best conditions.
This is why Fiat has planned a series
of checks and maintenance operations
every 48,000 km depending on the
engine version.
It is, however, important to remember
that scheduled servicing does not
completely cover all the requirements
of the vehicle: even in the initial
period before 48,000 km, and then
subsequently between one service
and another, ordinary care is always
required such as routine checks
involving topping up fluid level,
checking tyre pressures etc.
WARNING Scheduled Servicing
interventions are set out by the
Manufacturer. Failure to have them
carried out may invalidate the warranty.
Scheduled Servicing can be carried
out by any Fiat Dealership, at preestablished times.
If during each operation, in addition to
the ones scheduled, the need arises
for further replacements or repairs,
these may only be carried out with the
express agreement of the Customer.
WARNING It is advisable to inform a
Fiat Dealership of any small operating
irregularities without waiting for the
next service. If your vehicle is used
frequently for towing, the interval
between service coupons must be
reduced.
REGULAR CHECKS
Before long journeys, check and, if
necessary, restore:
engine coolant level;
brake fluid level;
control and top-up of level of
AdBlue® (UREA) Diesel emissions
additive (for versions/markets, where
provided);
windscreen washer fluid level;
tyre inflation pressure and condition;
operation of lighting system
(headlights, direction indicators, hazard
warning lights, etc.);
operation of screen washer/wiper
system and positioning/wear of
windscreen/rear window wiper blades.
To ensure that the vehicle is always
efficient and well maintained, it is
advisable to make sure that you carry
out the above operations regularly
(approximately every 1000 km and
every 3000 km for checking and
topping up engine oil is advisable).
DEMANDING
VEHICLE USE
If the vehicle is mostly used in one of
the following conditions:
towing a trailer or caravan;
dusty roads;
short, repeated journeys (less
than 7-8 Km) at sub-zero outdoor
temperatures;
engine often idling or driving long
distances at low speeds or long
periods of inactivity;
the following checks must be carried
out more often than indicated in the
Service Schedule:
check front disc brake pad condition
and wear;
check cleanliness of bonnet
and luggage compartment locks,
cleanliness and lubrication of linkage;
visually inspect conditions of:
engine, gearbox, transmission,
pipes and hoses (exhaust/fuel
system/brakes) and rubber elements
(gaiters/sleeves/bushes, etc.);
check battery charge and battery
fluid level (electrolyte);
visually inspect conditions of the
accessory drive belts;
check and, if necessary, change
engine oil and replace oil filter;
restore level of AdBlue® (UREA)
Diesel emissions additive (for
191
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
192
versions/markets, where applicable),
when the warning light comes on or
the message on the instrument panel
appears;
check and, if necessary, replace
pollen filter.
SCHEDULED SERVICING PLAN
after reaching 144,000 km/6 years, the checks listed in the Scheduled Servicing Plan must be repeated cyclically starting from
the first interval, thereby following the same intervals as before
Thousands of miles
30
60
90
120
150
Thousands of kilometres
48
96
144
192
240
Years
2
4
6
8
10
Check battery charge status and possibly recharge
Check tyre condition/wear and adjust pressure, if necessary; check the expiry
date of the “Fix&Go Automatic” repair kit (for versions/markets, where provided)
Check operation of lighting system (headlights, direction indicators, hazard
warning lights, boot, passenger compartment, glove compartment, instrument
panel warning lights, etc.)
Check operation of the windscreen wiper/washer system and adjust jets, if
necessary
Check windscreen/rearscreen wiper blade position/wear (for markets/versions,
where provided)
Check cleanliness of bonnet and luggage compartment locks, cleanliness and
lubrication of linkage
Visually inspect conditions of: exterior bodywork, underbody protection, pipes
and hoses (exhaust, fuel system, brakes), rubber elements (gaiters, sleeves,
bushes, etc.)
Check condition and wear of front disc brake pads and operation of pad wear
indicator
Check condition and wear of rear disc brake pads and operation of pad wear
indicator (for versions/markets where provided)
Check and fluid level top up, if required, in the engine compartment (1) (2)
193
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
Thousands of miles
30
60
90
120
150
Thousands of kilometres
48
96
144
192
240
Years
2
4
6
8
10
Visual checking the conditions of the belt/and accessories command (for
versions without automatic tensioner)
Check tension of accessory drive belt (versions without automatic tensioner) (7)
Inspect the conditions of toothed timing drive belt
Check handbrake lever travel and adjust, if necessary
Check exhaust emissions
Use the diagnosis socket to check fuel/engine management system operation
and engine oil decay (the latter for versions/markets, where provided)
Check cleanliness of sliding side door lower guides for versions with S.S.D. (or
every 6 months)
Replace fuel filter cartridge
Replace accessory drive belt/s
Replace toothed timing drive belt
(8)
Replace the air cleaner cartridge (3) (4)
194
Change engine oil and replace oil filter
(5)
Change the brake fluid
(6)
Thousands of miles
30
60
90
120
150
Thousands of kilometres
48
96
144
192
240
Years
2
4
6
8
10
Replace the passenger compartment filter
(1) Only ever use the fluids shown in the handbook for topping up, and only after checking that the system is intact.
(2) Consumption of AdBlue® (UREA) emissions additive depends on the condition of use of the vehicle and is indicated by a warning light and
message on the instrument panel (for versions/markets, where provided).
(3) If the vehicle is equipped with an air cleaner specially for dusty areas: check and clean filter every 20,000 km, change filter every 40,000 km
or change the air cleaner whenever the obstructed air cleaner indicator appears.
(4) For versions with automatic transmission (AT9), If the vehicle is used in dusty areas, you are advised to change this filter every 24,000 km.
(5) The actual interval for changing the oil and replacing the engine oil filter depends on the vehicle usage conditions and is signalled by the
warning light or message (if present) on the instrument panel (see “Warning lights and messages" paragraph) and must never exceed 24
months. Change engine oil and oil filter every 12 months if the vehicle is driven mainly in towns.
(6) The brake fluid replacement has to be done every two years, irrespective of the mileage.
(7) When the engine oil is changed for the first time, check the tension of the auxiliary drive belt
(8) Recommended maximum mileage 192,000 km. Irrespective of the mileage, the timing drive belt must be changed every 4 years for heavyduty use (cold climates, town use, long periods of idling) or at least every 5 years.
(*) NOTE Change automatic transmission oil (AT9) and replace oil filter every 240,000 km.
195
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
Natural Power versions
Thousands of miles
25
50
75
100
125
Thousands of kilometres
40
80
120
160
200
Years
2
4
6
8
10
Check battery charge status and possibly recharge
Check tyre conditions/wear and adjust pressure, if necessary
Check operation of lighting system (headlights, direction indicators, hazard
warning lights, boot, passenger compartment, glove compartment, instrument
panel warning lights, etc.)
Check operation of the windscreen wiper/washer system and adjust jets, if
necessary
Check the position/wear of the windscreen/rear window wiper blades
Check cleanliness of bonnet and luggage compartment locks, cleanliness and
lubrication of linkage
Visually inspect conditions of: exterior bodywork, underbody protection, pipes
and hoses (exhaust, fuel system, brakes), rubber elements (gaiters, sleeves,
bushes, etc.)
Visually inspect conditions and wear of front disc brake pads and operation of
pad wear indicator
Visually inspect condition and wear of rear disc brake pads and operation of
pad wear indicator (for versions/markets, where provided)
Check and, if necessary, top up fluid levels (engine coolant, hydraulic
clutch/brakes, windscreen washer, battery, etc.)
Visual checking the conditions of the belt/and accessories command (for
versions without automatic tensioner)
196
Thousands of miles
25
50
75
100
125
Thousands of kilometres
40
80
120
160
200
Years
2
4
6
8
10
Check tension of accessory drive belt (versions without automatic tensioner)
Check handbrake lever travel and adjust, if necessary
Check exhaust emissions
Check operation of engine management systems (using diagnosis socket)
Check cleanliness of sliding side door lower guides for versions with S.S.D. (or
every 6 months)
Spark plug replacement
Replace accessory drive belt/s
Replace air cleaner cartridge (1)
Replace engine oil and oil filter (2)
Change the brake fluid
(3)
Replace the passenger compartment filter
Visually inspect the condition of the methane pipes and fittings, methane tank
fastening, possible restoration
Check the pressure regulator and, if necessary, replace the internal filter
Check operation and parameters of fuel supply system using self-diagnosis
socket
Check tightening torque of cylinder fastening bands
Check pressure regulator heating piping seal
197
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
198
Thousands of miles
25
50
75
100
125
Thousands of kilometres
40
80
120
160
200
Years
2
4
6
8
10
Check correct assembly of injectors (positioning, clip effectiveness)
Check electrical connections and engine wiring integrity
(1) If the vehicle is equipped with an air filter specially for dusty areas: - every 20,000 km, check and clean the filter
(2) If the vehicle annual mileage is less than 10,000 km, the engine oil and filter must be replaced every 12 months.
(3) The brake fluid replacement has to be done every two years, irrespective of the mileage.
CHECKING LEVELS
2.3 120 HP Multijet - 140 HP Multijet - 160 HP Multijet - 180 HP Multijet versions
with AdBlue®
224
F1A0370
A. Engine oil filler plug B. Engine oil dipstick C. Engine coolant D. Windscreen washer fluid E. Brake fluid F. Power steering fluid
197) 198)
57)
199
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
3.0 140 Natural Power versions
225
F1A0375
A. Engine oil filler plug B. Engine oil dipstick C. Engine coolant D. Windscreen washer fluid E. Brake fluid F. Power steering fluid
197) 198)
57)
200
WARNING
197) Never smoke while working in the engine compartment: inflammable gases and vapours may be present, constituting a fire risk.
198) Be very careful working in the engine compartment when the engine is hot: you may get burned. Remember that the fan may start up if
the engine is hot: this could injure you. Scarves, ties and other loose clothing might be pulled by moving parts.
IMPORTANT
57) When topping up, take care not to mix up the various types of fluids: they are not compatible with each other and could seriously damage
the vehicle.
201
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
ENGINE OIL
58)
Check the oil level a few minutes after
stopping the engine (about 5 minutes)
with the vehicle parked on level ground.
Check the level is within the MIN
and MAX marks on the dipstick (B) fig. 224 - fig. 225.
The range between the MIN and MAX
marks corresponds to about 1 litre of
oil.
If the level of the oil is close to or below
the MIN mark, add oil through the
filler (A) - fig. 224 - fig. 225 using the
pipe provided, for versions/markets
where provided, until the MAX mark is
reached.
The oil level must never exceed the
MAX mark.
Engine oil consumption
The maximum engine oil consumption
is usually 400 grams every 1,000 km.
When the vehicle is new, the engine
needs to be run in, therefore the
engine oil consumption can only be
considered stabilised after the first
5,000–6,000 km.
WARNING The oil consumption
depends on driving style and the
conditions under which the vehicle is
used.
202
WARNING After adding or changing
the oil, let the engine turn over for a few
seconds and wait a few minutes after
turning it off before you check the level.
PARAFLUUP and 40% demineralised
water.
WARNING Always top up using engine
oil of the same specifications as that
already in the engine.
ENGINE COOLANT
199)
59)
The coolant level must be checked
when the engine is cold and must
range between the MIN and MAX
marks on the reservoir.
If the level is to low, operate as follows:
to access the reservoir filler, remove
the plastic cover (A) fig. 226 by turning
the locking screws (B) anticlockwise;
slowly pour through the filler (C)
- fig. 224 - fig. 225 the reservoir a
mixture of 50% demineralised water
and 50% PETRONAS LUBRICANTS
PARAFLUUP until the level is close to
MAX.
The mixture of 50% demineralised
water and 50% PARAFLU UP protects
against freezing down to -35°C.
When the vehicle is used in particularly
harsh weather conditions, we
recommend using a mixture of 60%
226
F1A0336
POWER STEERING FLUID
200)
60)
5)
Check that the liquid contained in the
tank is at the maximum level. This
operation must be carried out with the
vehicle level and with the engine off and
cold.
Proceed as follows:
to access the reservoir filler, remove
the plastic cover (A) fig. 226 by turning
the locking screws (B) anticlockwise;
check that the fluid level is at the
MAX mark on the dipstick attached to
the reservoir (F) - fig. 224 - fig. 225 (use
the level shown on the 20°C side of the
dipstick to check when cold).
If the level of the fluid in the tank is
lower than the specified level, top
up using only one of the products
indicated in the "Fluid and lubricants"
table in the "Technical data" chapter,
proceeding as follows:
Start the engine and wait for the fluid
level in the tank to stabilise.
With the engine running, turn the
steering wheel from right to left fully
several times.
Top up the fuel to the MAX level and
then retighten the cap.
PETRONAS DURANCE SC 35 and
50% water in winter. At temperatures
below -20°C, use undiluted
PETRONAS DURANCE SC 35 fluid.
WINDSCREEN/REAR
WINDOW WASHER FLUID
201) 202)
To add fluid:
remove the cap (D) - fig. 224 fig. 225, pulling the retaining tooth
outward;
pull the opening of the pipe upwards
to extract the telescopic funnel fig. 227.
WARNING To prevent the cap from
being damaged and interfering with
the adjacent mechanical parts, make
sure that it is correctly oriented as
shown in fig. 227before opening it.
Otherwise, turn it until it reaches the
correct position.Fill according to the
following instructions:Use a mixture of
water and PETRONAS DURANCE SC
35, in the following concentrations:
30% PETRONAS DURANCE SC
35 and 70% water in winter or 50%
227
F1A0396
To close the cap, proceed as follows:
push the funnel fully until it locks;
close the cap.
BRAKE FLUID
204) 205)
61)
Undo the cap (E) - fig. 224 - fig. 225
and check that the liquid contained in
the reservoir is at the maximum level.
The fluid level in the reservoir must
not exceed the MAX mark. When
topping up, you are advised to use the
brake fluid shown in the "Fluids and
lubricants" table of the "Technical data"
chapter.
NOTE Carefully clean the plug of
the reservoir and the surrounding
surface. Take great care to ensure that
impurities do not enter the reservoir
when the cap is opened. Always use a
funnel with a built-in filter with a mesh
of 0.12 mm or less.
WARNING Brake fluid absorbs
moisture. For this reason, if the vehicle
is mainly used in areas with a high
degree of atmospheric humidity, the
fluid should be replaced at more
frequent intervals than specified in the
“Scheduled Servicing Plan”.
203)
203
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
WARNING
IMPORTANT
199) The cooling system is pressurised.
If necessary, only replace the plug with
another original or the operation of the
system may be adversely affected. Do not
remove the reservoir plug when the engine
is hot: you risk scalding yourself.
200) Prevent power steering fluid from
coming into contact with hot engine parts:
it is flammable.
201) Do not travel with the windscreen
washer fluid reservoir empty: the
windscreen washer is essential for
improving visibility.
202) Some commercial windscreen
washer additives are flammable. The
engine compartment contains hot parts
which could start a fire if they come into
contact.
203) Do not release the cap from the
extension without previously extracting the
system using the ring.
204) Brake fluid is poisonous and highly
corrosive. In the event of accidental
contact, immediately wash the affected
parts with water and mild soap. Then rinse
thoroughly. Call a doctor immediately if
swallowed.
205) The symbol , on the brake fluid
container indicates if a brake fluid is
synthetic or mineralbased. Use of mineral
type fluids will damage the special rubber
seals of the braking system beyond repair.
58) Used engine oil and replaced oil filters
contain substances which are harmful to
the environment. To change oil and filters,
we advise you to contact a Fiat Dealership.
59) PARAFLU UP anti-freeze fluid is used
in the cooling system. Use fluid of the
same type as that contained in the cooling
system for any top-ups. PARAFLU UP
liquid cannot be mixed with any other
type of fluid. If this occurs, do not start the
engine and contact your Fiat Dealership
immediately.
60) Do not press on the power steering
end of travel with engine on for more than
8 consecutive seconds, since noise is
produced and there is a risk of system
damages.
61) Prevent brake fluid, which is highly
corrosive, from coming into contact
with painted parts. Should it happen,
immediately wash with water.
AIR
CLEANER/POLLEN
FILTER
Have the air cleaner replaced by a Fiat
Dealership.
AIR CLEANER – DUSTY
ROADS
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The air cleaner for dusty areas,
except for versions with automatic
transmission, is equipped with a visual
filter clogging indicator device (A)
fig. 228.
IMPORTANT
5) Power steering fluid consumption is
extremely low; if another top-up is required
after only a short period of time, have
the system checked for leaks at a Fiat
Dealership.
228
F1A0238
Check the reading of the blockage
sensor at intervals (Refer to the
"Service Schedule").
WARNING To blow the filter use an
air jet, do not use water or liquid
detergents. Since this cleaner is
204
specific to versions designed for dusty
areas, it is advisable to contact a Fiat
Dealership to change the cleaner.
BATTERY
The battery is located inside the
passenger compartment, in front of the
pedals. Remove the protective cover to
gain access to it.
206) 207)
REPLACING THE
BATTERY
If required, replace the battery with
an original spare part with the same
specifications.
If a battery with different specifications
is fitted, the service intervals given in
the “Scheduled Servicing Plan” will no
longer be valid.
Follow the battery manufacturer's
instructions for maintenance.
208) 209)
62) 63)
6)
USEFUL ADVICE FOR
EXTENDING THE LIFE OF
YOUR BATTERY
To avoid draining your battery and
make it last longer, observe the
following instructions:
when you park the vehicle, ensure
that the doors, tailgate and bonnet
are closed properly, to prevent any
roof lights from remaining on inside the
passenger's compartment;
switch off all roof lights inside
the vehicle: the vehicle is however
equipped with a system which
switches all internal lights off
automatically;
do not keep accessories (e.g. radio,
hazard warning lights, etc.) switched on
for a long time when the engine is not
running;
before carrying out any operation
on the electrical system, disconnect
the negative battery cable through the
suitable terminal;
completely tighten the battery
terminals.
WARNING After turning the ignition
key to STOP and having closed
the driver side door, wait at least
one minute before disconnecting the
electrical supply from the battery. When
reconnecting the electrical supply to
the battery, make sure that the ignition
key is in the STOP position and the
driver side door is closed.
WARNING If the charge level remains
under 50% for a long time, the battery
is damaged by sulphation, reducing its
capacity and efficiency at start-up.The
battery is also more prone to the risk
of freezing (at temperatures as high
as -10°C).Refer to the paragraph "Car
inactivity" in "Starting and driving" if the
car is left parked for a long time.
If, after buying the vehicle, you want
to install electrical accessories which
require permanent electric supply
(alarm, etc.) or accessories that in any
case burden the electrical supply,
contact a Fiat Dealership, whose
qualified personnel, in addition
to suggesting the most suitable
devices from Lineaccessori MOPAR,
will evaluate the overall electrical
consumption, checking whether the
vehicle electrical system is capable of
withstanding the load required, or
whether it should be integrated with a
more powerful battery. Since some of
these devices continue to consume
electricity even when the engine is off,
they gradually run down the battery.
WARNING If a tachograph is fitted, if
the vehicle is parked for a long period
of 5 days, it is advisable to disconnect
the negative battery terminal to
maintain its charge.If the vehicle is
equipped with a battery disconnection
function (disconnector), see the
description of the procedure in the
205
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
"Controls" paragraph in the "Knowing
your vehicle" section.
weather conditions, remove the battery
and store it in a heated area to prevent it
from freezing.
WARNING
IMPORTANT
206) Battery fluid is poisonous and
corrosive: avoid contact with your skin and
eyes. The battery should be charged in a
well ventilated place, away from naked
flames or possible sources of sparks:
danger of explosion and fire.
207) Using the battery with low fluid will
irreparably damage the battery and may
cause an explosion.
208) Before performing any operation
on the electrical system, disconnect the
negative battery cable through the suitable
terminal, after having waited at least one
minute from turning the ignition key to
STOP.
209) Always wear appropriate goggles to
protect your eyes when working on or near
the battery.
6) Batteries contain substances which are
very harmful for the environment. You are
recommended to go to a Fiat Dealership
to have the battery replaced where the old
battery will be disposed of respecting both
the environment and the laws in force.
Proceed as follows:
raise the wiper arm, press tab (A)
fig. 229 of the attachment spring and
remove the blade from the arm;
fit the new blade, inserting the tab
into the special slot in the arm, making
sure that it is locked;
lower the wiper arm onto the
windscreen.
NOZZLES
Windscreen (washer) fig. 230
WINDSCREEN
WIPER
REPLACING THE
WINDSCREEN WIPER
BLADES
210)
64)
230
IMPORTANT
62) Incorrect installation of electric and
electronic devices may cause severe
damage to your vehicle. After purchasing
your vehicle, if you wish to install any
accessories (anti-theft, radio phone, etc.),
go to a Fiat Dealership, which will suggest
the most suitable devices and advise you
whether a higher capacity battery needs to
be installed.
63) If the vehicle will be unused for an
extended period of time in extremely cold
206
229
F1A0241
F1A0242
If there is no jet, first check that there is
fluid in the reservoir.
Then check that the nozzle holes are
not clogged:
use a needle to unblock them if
necessary.
The washer jets should be positioned
by adjusting the angle of the sprays
using a small straight-headed
screwdriver.
The jets should be directed at about a
third of the height from the top edge of
the windscreen.
HEADLIGHT WASHERS
Check the correct condition and
cleanliness of nozzles at regular
intervals.
The headlight washers come on
automatically when the windscreen
washer is operated with the low beams
on.
LIFTING THE
VEHICLE
WHEELS AND TYRES
If the vehicle needs to be lifted, go to a
Fiat Dealership which is equipped with
the arm hoist or workshop lift.
Lift the vehicle exclusively by
positioning the jack arms or the shop
jack in the points shown in fig. 231.
WARNING
210) Driving with worn windscreen/rear
window wiper blades is a serious risk,
because visibility is reduced in bad
weather.
IMPORTANT
64) Do not operate the windscreen wiper
with the blades lifted from the windscreen.
231
F1A0366
Check the pressure of each
tyre including the spare wheel,
approximately every two weeks and
before long journeys: the pressure
should be checked with the tyre rested
and cold.
It is normal for the pressure to increase
when the vehicle is used; for the
correct tyre inflation pressure, see the
"Wheels" paragraph in the "Technical
specifications" chapter.
Incorrect pressure causes abnormal
tyre wear fig. 232:
A normal pressure: tread evenly worn;
B low pressure: tread particularly worn
at the edges;
C high pressure: tread particularly worn
in the centre.
The tyres must be replaced when the
tread is less than 1.6 mm thick. In any
case, follow the laws in force in the
country where you are driving.
211) 212) 213)
207
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
208
232
F1A0240
IMPORTANT NOTES
As far as possible, avoid sharp
braking, screech starts and violent
shocks against pavements, potholes or
other hard obstacles.
Driving for long stretches over uneven
roads can damage the tyres;
periodically check that the tyres have
no cuts in the side wall, abnormal
swelling or irregular tyre tread wear. Go
to a Fiat Dealership if required;
avoid overloading the car when
travelling: this may cause serious
damage to the wheels and tyres;
if a tyre is punctured, stop
immediately and replace it to
avoid damage to the tyre, the rim,
suspension and steering system;
tyres age even if they are not used
much. Cracks in the tread and on
the sidewalls are a sign of ageing. In
any event, have the tyres checked by
specialised technicians if they have
been fitted for longer than 6 years.
Remember to check the spare wheel
very carefully;
in the case of replacement, always fit
new tyres, avoiding those of unknown
origin;
if a tyre is changed, also change the
inflation valve;
to allow even wear between the front
and rear tyres, it is advisable to change
them over every 10–15 thousand
kilometres, keeping them on the same
side of the vehicle so as not to reverse
the direction of rotation.
WARNING Replacing a tyre, check that
the tyre pressure monitoring (TPMS)
sensor is also taken from the previous
rim, together with the valve.
SNOW TYRES
The performance of these tyres is
considerably reduced when the tread
depth is less than 4 mm. Replace them
in this case.
WARNING When using snow tyres
with a maximum speed index below
the one that can be reached by the
vehicle (increased by 5%), place a
notice in the passenger compartment,
plainly in view, which states the
maximum speed allowed by the snow
tyres (as per EC Directive).All four
tyres should be the same (brand
and track) to ensure greater safety
when driving and braking as well as a
good manoeuvrability.Remember that
you should not change the rotation
direction of the tyres.
WARNING
214)
211) If tyre pressure is too low, the tyre
may overheat and be severely damaged as
a result.
212) Do not switch tyres from the
righthand side of the vehicle to the
lefthand side, and vice versa.
213) Do not repaint alloy wheel rims at
temperatures higher than 150°C. The
mechanical features of the wheels could
be compromised.
WARNING
214) The maximum speed for snow tyres
marked “Q" is 160 km/h, while it is 190
km/h for “T" tyres and 210 km/h for "H"
tyres. You should, however, always stick to
the speed limits of the highway code.
SNOW CHAINS
The use of snow chains should be in
compliance with local regulations of
each country.
Snow chains can be fitted to the tyres
of the front wheels (drive wheels) only.
Use of Lineaccessori MOPAR snow
chains is recommended. Check the
tension of the snow chains after the
first few metres have been driven.
65)
WARNING With snow chains, use
the accelerator with extreme care
to prevent, or to limit as much as
possible, slipping of the drive wheels
that could cause chain breakage,
resulting in damage to the vehicle body
or mechanical components.
WARNING For versions fitted with
225/75 R16 tyre, use snow chains with
max. thickness 16 mm.When travelling
on snowy roads with snow chains, it
may be helpful to turn the ASR off: in
fact, in these conditions, the drive
wheels skidding when setting off gives
you better traction.
IMPORTANT
65) Keep the vehicle speed down when
snow chains are fitted; never exceed 50
km/h. Avoid potholes, do not drive over
steps or pavements, and do not drive long
distances over roads without snow, to
avoid damaging both your vehicle and the
road surface.
BODYWORK
PROTECTION AGAINST
ATMOSPHERIC AGENTS
The main causes of corrosion are the
following:
atmospheric pollution;
salty air and humidity (coastal areas,
or hot humid climates);
seasonal environmental conditions.
ADVICE FOR
PRESERVING THE
BODYWORK
Paintwork
Paintwork does not only serve an
aesthetic purpose, but also protects
the underlying sheet metal.
You are advised to touch up abrasions
and scratches immediately to prevent
rust formation. Use only original
paint products for touch-ups (see
“Bodywork paint identification plate” in
the “Technical specifications” section).
Normal maintenance of paintwork
consists in washing the vehicle: the
frequency depends on the conditions
and environment where the vehicle is
used.
For example, it is advisable to wash the
vehicle more often in areas with high
levels of environmental pollution or on
roads spread with salt.
To correctly wash the vehicle, proceed
as follows:
wash the bodywork using a low
pressure jet of water;
wipe a sponge with a slightly soapy
solution over the bodywork, frequently
rinsing the sponge;
rinse well with water and dry with a
jet of air or a chamois leather.
If you put the vehicle through a vehicle
wash, follow these recommendations:
remove the aerial from the roof so it
does not get damaged;
the vehicle should be washed with
water added to a soapy solution;
rinse thoroughly to avoid soap marks
remaining on the bodywork or less
visible parts.
Windows
To clean glasses, use specific cleaning
products. Use clean cloths to avoid
209
MAINTENANCE AND CARE
scratching the glass or altering the
transparency.
WARNING Wipe the rear window
inside gently with a cloth following
the direction of the filaments to avoid
damaging the heating device.
Headlights
WARNING Never use aromatic
substances (e.g. petrol) or ketones (e.g.
acetone) for cleaning the plastic lenses
of the headlights.
66)
7)
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
WASHING
67)
If the engine compartment is washed
(at low pressure, e.g. in very dusty
areas), this must be done with the
engine cold and with ignition device
turned to STOP. Take care not to direct
the water jet straight at the electronic
control modules or the wiper motors.
Have this operation performed by a
specialised workshop. After washing,
check that the various protective
components (e.g. rubber guards and
caps) have not been removed or
damaged.
210
IMPORTANT
66) Some automatic systems equipped
with old generation blades and/or with a
poor maintenance can damage the paint,
promoting the creation of microscoring
which give an opaque/coated appearance
to the paint, especially on dark colours. In
this case, just lightly polish with specific
products.
67) A high pressure jet cleaner should
not be used for cleaning the engine
compartment. The appropriate
precautions have been taken to protect all
parts and connections, but the pressures
generated by these devices are so high
that complete protection against water
seepages cannot be guaranteed.
IMPORTANT
7) Detergents pollute the water. The
vehicle should be washed in areas
equipped for collecting and purifying the
liquid used in the washing process.
INTERIOR
Regularly check that water is not
trapped under the mats (due to water
dripping off shoes, umbrellas, etc.), as
this could cause oxidation of the sheet
metal.
215) 216)
FABRIC SEATS AND
PARTS
Remove dust with a soft brush or a
vacuum cleaner. It is advisable to use a
moist brush on velvet upholstery.
Rub the seats with a sponge
moistened with a solution of water and
neutral detergent.
PLASTIC PARTS
It is advisable to clean interior plastic
parts with a moist cloth and a solution
of water and non-abrasive mild soap.
Use specific products for cleaning
plastic, without solvents and specifically
designed to prevent damage to the
appearance and colour of the treated
parts, to remove grease and tough
stains.
WARNING Do not use alcohol, petrols
or derivatives to clean the instrument
panel glass.
LEATHER STEERING
WHEEL/GEAR LEVER
KNOB/HANDBRAKE
(for versions/markets, where provided)
These components must be cleaned
with mild soap and water only. Never
use alcohol or alcohol-based products.
WARNING
RUBBER HOSES
With regards to the maintenance of the
brake system and fuel system rubber
hoses, carefully follow the "Service
Schedule”.
Ozone, high temperatures and
prolonged lack of fluid in the system
may cause hardening and cracking of
the hoses, with possible leaks. Careful
checking is therefore necessary.
215) Never use flammable products, such
as petroleum ether or modified petrol,
to clean the inside of the vehicle. The
electrostatic charges which are generated
by rubbing during the cleaning operation
may cause a fire.
216) Do not keep aerosol cans in the
vehicle: they might explode. Aerosol cans
must not be exposed to temperatures
higher than 50°C. Temperatures may
greatly exceed this value inside a vehicle
exposed to direct sunlight.
211
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
212
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Everything you may find useful for
understanding how your vehicle is
made and works is contained in this
chapter and illustrated with data, tables
and graphics. For the enthusiasts and
the technician, but also just for those
who want to know every detail of their
vehicle.
IDENTIFICATION DATA ...............
ENGINE CODES - BODYWORK
VERSION ..................................
ENGINE ....................................
STEERING ................................
WHEELS...................................
DIMENSIONS ............................
PERFORMANCE ........................
WEIGHTS AND LOADS...............
REFUELLING.............................
FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS .........
FUEL CONSUMPTION AND
CO2 EMISSIONS .......................
213
215
217
219
220
225
235
238
242
245
249
IDENTIFICATION
DATA
It is advisable to take note of the
identification codes. Identification
codes are printed and shown on the
plates as indicated below, together
with the positions:
VIN plate.
Chassis marking.
Bodywork paint identification plate.
Engine marking.
VEHICLE
IDENTIFICATION
NUMBER (VIN) PLATE
233
(E) Maximum permitted weight of
vehicle fully laden.
(F) Maximum permitted weight of
vehicle fully laden plus trailer.
(G) Maximum permitted weight on first
axle (front).
(H) Maximum permitted weight on
second axle (rear).
(I) Engine type.
(L) Bodywork version code.
(M) Spare part number.
(N) Correct value of smoke coefficient
(for diesel engines).
CHASSIS MARKING
They are located respectively: one
on the passenger side interior wheel
housing (A) fig. 234 , the other on the
lower part of the windscreen fig. 235.
The marking includes:
type of vehicle;
chassis serial number.
235
F1A0365
BODYWORK PAINT
IDENTIFICATION PLATE
This plate is fitted to the engine
compartment front crossmember and
contains the following identification
data fig. 236:
(A) Paint manufacturer.
(B) Colour name.
(C) Fiat colour code.
(D) Respray and touch-up colour code.
F1A0243
This plate is fitted to the engine
compartment front crossmember and
contains the following data fig. 233:
(A) Name of manufacturer.
(B) Type-approval number.
(C) Vehicle type identification code.
(D) Chassis number.
234
F1A0244
236
F1A0369
213
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE MARKING
It is stamped on the cylinder block and
includes the type and the engine serial
number.
CYLINDER MARKING
Each methane cylinder is identified in
the plant by information stamped on
the cylinder cone.
237
F0N0405M
The other plates provided by the
Dealership with the vehicle documents
show the date when the first cylinder
inspection/test is due.
68)
SYSTEM INSPECTION
The cylinders must be inspected, in
accordance with ECE Regulation
Procedure no. 110, every 4 years from
the vehicle registration date or in
accordance with specific regulations in
individual countries.
214
IMPORTANT
68) If the vehicle has been registered in a
country other than Italy, the certification
data, identification and inspection
procedures for the methane cylinders
should conform to the legislation in
that country. In any case, it should be
remembered that the life of the cylinders is
20 years from the production date as set
out in ECE Regulation 110.
ENGINE CODES - BODYWORK VERSION
Version
Engine code
2.3 120 HP Multijet with AdBlue ®
F1AGL4114
2.3 140 HP Multijet with AdBlue ®
F1AGL4113
2.3 160 HP Multijet with AdBlue ®
F1AGL4112
2.3 180 HP Multijet with AdBlue ®
F1AGL4111
3.0 140 Natural Power
F1CFA401A
215
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
There is an example of a bodywork
version code below by way of
explanation with a key which is valid for
all bodywork version codes.
Example:
250 A M M F A DX
250 MODEL
A GVW
M ENGINE
M ENGINE AXLES/TRANSMISSION
F BODYWORK
A WHEELBASE
DX VERSION
GVW
A 3000 kg
B 3300 kg
C 3500 kg
D 3500 kg MAXI
E 3995/4005/4250 kg MAXI
F 2800 kg
G 3650 kg
H 3510 kg MAXI
L 3510 kg
M 4400 kg MAXI
ENGINE
D 2.3 120 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
E 2.3 140 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
F 2.3 160 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
G 2.3 180 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
H 3.0 140 Natural Power
216
L 2.3 180 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
and automatic transmission AT9
TRANSMISSION
N Mechanical gearbox
B Automatic transmission AT9
WHEELBASE
A Short wheelbase
B Medium wheelbase
C Long wheelbase
D Medium-long wheelbase
U All wheelbases (incomplete vehicles)
BODYWORK
A Cab chassis
B Chassis without cab
C Cab floor
D Caisson
F Van
G Extended cab caisson
H Extended cab chassis
M Minibus
P Panorama
R Combi 6/9-seater
ENGINE
2.3 120 HP Multijet
with AdBlue ®
2.3 140 HP Multijet
with AdBlue ®
2.3 160 HP Multijet
with AdBlue ®
2.3 180 HP Multijet with
AdBlue ®
F1AGL4114
F1AGL4113
F1AGL4112
F1AGL4111
Diesel
Diesel
Diesel
Diesel
Number and position of
cylinders
4 in line
4 in line
4 in line
4 in line
Piston bore and stroke
(mm)
88 × 94
88 × 94
88 × 94
88 × 94
2287
2287
2287
2287
16.2 : 1
16.2 : 1
16.2 : 1
16.2 : 1
Maximum power (EC) (kW)
88
103
118
130
Maximum power (EEC)
(HP)
120
140
160
180
Corresponding engine
speed (rpm)
3600
3600
3500
3500
Maximum torque (EEC)
(Nm)
320
350
380
400
Corresponding engine
speed (rpm)
1400
1400
1500
1500
General information
Engine code
Cycle
Total displacement (cm³)
Compression ratio
Fuel
Diesel for motor vehicles (EN590 Specification)
217
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
General information
Engine code
Cycle
Number and position of cylinders
Piston bore and stroke (mm)
Total displacement (cm³)
Compression ratio
F1CFA401A
Otto
4 in line
95.8 × 104
2999
12.5 ± 0.5:1
Maximum power (EC) (kW)
100
Maximum power (EEC) (HP)
136
Corresponding engine speed (rpm)
3500
Maximum torque (EEC) (Nm)
350
Corresponding engine speed (rpm)
1500
Plugs
Fuel
218
3.0 140 Natural Power
Champion RC7BYC – NGK IFRF-D
Methane
STEERING
Versions
Kerb-to-kerb turning circle (m)
Short wheelbase
11.06
Medium wheelbase
12.46
Medium-long wheelbase
13.54
Long wheelbase
14.28
Extra-long wheelbase
15.3
Type
Rack and pinion with hydraulic power steering.
219
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
WHEELS
RIMS AND TYRES
Alloy or pressed steel rims. Tubeless
radial carcass tyres.
All approved tyres are listed in the
registration document.
WARNING If there are any
discrepancies between the Owner
Handbook and the Registration
Document, take the information from
the latter. To ensure driving safety,
make sure that all the wheels are fitted
with tyres of the same make and type.
WARNING Do not use air chambers
with tubeless tyres.
SPARE WHEEL
Pressed steel rim.
Tubeless tyre.
WHEEL GEOMETRY
Front wheels toe-in measured between
rims: -1 ±1 mm.
The values refer to the vehicle in
running order.
220
RIMS AND TYRES PROVIDED
Rims for versions with manual gearbox
VERSION
TYRES
PAYLOAD
(Size/Load index and speed)
RIM
3000
LIGHT 15”
3300
215/70 R15 C
(109/107 S)
225/70 R15C
(112/110 S)
3500
–
3000
LIGHT TEMPO
LIBERO 15"
3300
215/70 R15 CP
(109/107 Q)
LIGHT TEMPO
LIBERO 16"
3300
3500
3300
3500/3650
215/75 R16 C
(116/114 R)
225/75 R16 CP
(116/114 Q)
3500
215/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
4000/4250
215/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
excluding PTT 4250
MAXI
3500
MAXI TEMPO
LIBERO
4000/4250
4400
6 Jx15-68
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R) M+S
6 Jx16-68
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R) M+S
6 Jx16-68
–
–
3500/3650
LIGHT 16''
225/70 R15C
(112/110 R) M+S
225/75 R16 CP
(116/114 Q)
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
–
–
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
–
–
221
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Rims for versions with automatic transmission
TYRES
VERSION
PAYLOAD
LIGHT 15''
3000
215/70 R15 C
(109/107 S)
225/70 R15C
(112/110 S)
3000
215/70 R15 CP
(109/107 Q)
–
215/75 R16 C
(116/114 R)
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
3300/3500/3650
225/75 R16 CP
(116/114 Q)
–
3500
215/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
4000/4250
215/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
excluding PTT
4250kg
LIGHT TEMPO
LIBERO 15"
LIGHT 16''
LIGHT TEMPO
LIBERO 16"
3300
3500
MAXI
(Size/Load index and speed)
3500
MAXI TEMPO
LIBERO
4000/4250
4400
222
225/75 R16 CP
(116/114 Q)
RIM
225/70 R15C
(112/110 R) M+S
6 Jx15-68
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R) M+S
6 Jx16-68
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R) M+S
6 Jx16-68
225/75 R16C
(116/114 R)
–
–
If using M+S winter tyres with speed index lower than “S" for 15" wheels and “R" for 16" wheels, respect the max. vehicle speed
indicated in the table: Maximum speed index.
WARNING Only use the tyres indicated on the vehicle Registration document.If using class C tyres on a Camping vehicle,
always use wheels with a metal inflation valve. When replacing, it is always advisable to use Camping tyres.
COLD TYRE INFLATION PRESSURE (bar)
Tyres provided
Front
Rear
3000 PTT (*) with basic tyres, except
PANORAMA
4.0
4.0
3300 GVW (*) / 3500 PTT (*) with basic tyres
4.1
4.5
PANORAMA with basic tyres
4.1
4.5
3000 PTT (*) with oversized tyres, except
PANORAMA
4.0
4.0
3300 GVW (*) / 3500 GVW (*) with oversized
tyres
4.1
4.5
225/70 R15 C
Winter and All-Seasons tyres
4.1
4.5
225/70 R15 C
PANORAMA with oversized tyres
4.1
4.5
Vehicles with Camping tyres
5.0
5.5
215/75 R16 C
For all versions/trim levels
4.5
5.0
225/75 R16 C
For all versions/trim levels, except for Winter and
All-Seasons tyres
4.5
5.0
225/75 R16 C
Winter tyres
4.5
4.8
215/70 R15 C
215/70 R15 C
225/70 R15 C
215/70 R15 CP
223
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
224
Tyres provided
Front
Rear
All-Seasons tyres
4.5
5.0
225/75 R16 CP
Vehicles with Camping tyres
5.5
5.5
225/75 R16 CP
Maxi 4400 GVW (*) with Camping tyres (for
versions/markets, where provided)
5.5
5.5
225/75 R16 C
(*) Gross Vehicle Weight
The pressure value can be up to +1.0 bar more than the recommended one when the tyres are warm. However, recheck that
the value is correct with the tyre cold.
DIMENSIONS
PANORAMA / COMBI VERSION
Dimensions are expressed in mm and refer to the vehicle fitted with standard tyres.
Height is measured with vehicle unladen.
238
F1A0367
225
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
COMBI - PANORAMA
CH1
MH2
LH2
A
948
948
948
B
3000
3450
4035
C
1015
1015
1015 - 1380 (*)
D
4963
5413
5998 - 6363 (*)
E
2254
2524
2524
F
1810
1810
1810
G
2050
2050
2050
I
1790
1790
1790
* MINIBUS version, 16 + 1 seats
The sizes vary according to the various versions within the limits indicated above.
226
VAN VERSION
Dimensions are expressed in mm and refer to the vehicle fitted with standard tyres.
Height is measured with vehicle unladen.
239
F1A0328
227
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
VAN
CH1 - CH2
MH1 - MH2
LH2 - LH3
XLH2 - XLH3
A
948
948
948
948
B
3000
3450
4035
4035
C
1015
1015
1015
1380
D
4963
5413
5998
6363
E
2254 - 2524
2254 - 2524 (*)
2524 - 2764 (**)
2524 - 2764
F
1810
1810
1810
1810
G
2050
2050
2050
2050
I
1790
1790
1790
1790
* MAXI 2269 - 2539 version
** MAXI 2539 - 2774 version
The sizes vary according to the various versions within the limits indicated above.
228
TRUCK VERSION
Dimensions are expressed in mm and refer to the vehicle fitted with standard tyres.
Height is measured with vehicle unladen.
240
F1A0329
229
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
TRUCK BODY
CHASSIS CAB
CH1
MH1
LH1
XLH1
CH1
MH1 MLH1
LH1
XLH1
XXLH1
A
948
948
948
948
948
948
948
948
948
B
3000
3450
4035
4035
3000
3450 3800
4035
4035
4300
C
1345
1345
1345
1710
960
960
960
1325
1590
D
5293
5743
6328
6693
4908
5358 5708
5943
6308
6573
E
2798
3248
3833
4198
–
–
–
–
–
F
2424
2424
2424
2424
2254
2254
2254
2254
2519
G
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
H
1790
1790
1790
1790
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 - 1980
L
2100
2100
2100
2100
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
The sizes vary according to the various versions within the limits indicated above.
230
CHASSIS COWL
SPECIAL CAB VAN
CH1
MH1 MLH1
LH1
XLH1
XXLH1
CH1
MH1 MLH1
LH1
XLH1
XXLH1
A
925
925
925
925
925
948
948
948
948
948
B
3000
3450 3800
4035
4035
4300
3000
3450 3800
4035
4035
4300
C
860
860
860
1225
1490
880
880
880
1245
1510
D
4785
5235 5585
5820
6125
6390
4828
5278 5628
5863
6228
6493
E
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
F
–
–
–
–
–
2254
2254
2254
2254
2254
G
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
H
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
1790 1980
L
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
The sizes vary according to the various versions within the limits indicated above.
231
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
232
SPECIAL CHASSIS COWL
CH1
MH1 - MH2
LH1
XLH1
XXLH1
A
925
925
925
925
925
B
3000
3450 - 3800
4035
4035
4300
C
880
880
880
1245
1510
D
4805
5255 - 5605
5840
6205
6470
G
1810
1810
1810
1810
1810
H
1790 - 1980
1790 - 1980
1790 - 1980
1790 - 1980
1790 - 1980
L
2050
2050
2050
2050
2050
The sizes vary according to the various versions within the limits indicated above.
CREW CAB VERSION
Dimensions are expressed in mm and refer to the vehicle fitted with standard tyres.
Height is measured with vehicle unladen.
241
F1A0368
233
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
CREW CAB
MH1
LH1
XLH1
A
948
948
948
B
3450
4035
4035
C
1340
1245
1695
D
5798
6228
6678
E
2424
2424
2424
F
1810
1810
1810
G
2100
2100
2100
I
1790
1790
1790
The sizes vary according to the various versions within the limits indicated above.
234
PERFORMANCE
Top permitted speed after initial vehicle use in km/h.
Versions with manual gearbox
BODYWORK VERSION
2.3 120 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
2.3 140 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
Heavy
2.3 160 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
2.3 180 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
3.0 140 Natural
Power
Light
Heavy
Light
(*)
Heavy
(**)
–
LOW roof (H1)
148
156
163
162
170 (*)
161 (**)
161
159
MEDIUM roof (H2)
143
153
159
158
165 (*)
161 (**)
161
155
HIGH roof (H3)
138
149
154
153
161
156
153
TRAILER
TRUCK / CAB
CHASSIS /
CHASSIS
COWLS /
PLATFORMS
(excluding
Tempo Libero
version)
LOW roof (H1)
148
156
163
162
170 (*)
161 (**)
161
159
CAB CHASSIS
/ CHASSIS
COWLS (Tempo
Libero version)
LOW roof (H1)
148
152
VAN (excluding
Tempo Libero
version)
152
152
–
235
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
236
BODYWORK VERSION
2.3 120 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
VAN (Tempo
Libero version)
2.3 140 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
Heavy
2.3 160 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
Heavy
2.3 180 HP
Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
(*)
Heavy
(**)
3.0 140 Natural
Power
–
LOW roof (H1)
148
152
152
152
–
MEDIUM roof (H2)
146
152
152
152
–
HIGH roof (H3)
141
149
152
152
–
(*) Versions with 15" rims
(**) Versions with 16" rims
Versions with automatic
transmission
2.3 140 HP Multijet with
AdBlue ®
BODYWORK VERSION
Light
Heavy
2.3 160 HP Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
Heavy
2.3 180 HP Multijet with
AdBlue ®
Light
Heavy
LOW roof (H1)
155
162 (R15)
161 (R16)
169 (R15)
161 (R16)
161
MEDIUM roof (H2)
152
158
164 (R15)
161 (R16)
161
HIGH roof (H3)
148
153
TRAILER TRUCK
/ CAB CHASSIS /
CHASSIS COWLS
/ PLATFORMS
(excluding Tempo
Libero version)
LOW roof (H1)
155
162 (R15)
161 (R16)
CAB CHASSIS /
CHASSIS COWLS
(Tempo Libero
version)
LOW roof (H1)
152
152
152
LOW roof (H1)
152
152
152
MEDIUM roof (H2)
152
152
152
HIGH roof (H3)
148
152
152
VAN (excluding
Tempo Libero version)
VAN (Tempo Libero
version)
160
169 (R15)
161 (R16)
161
NOTE N2-category vehicles are limited to 90 km/h by type-approval requirements.
NOTE M2-category vehicles are limited to 100 km/h by type-approval requirements.
Speed limiter type-approved for 171 km/h for complete/incomplete No Tempo Libero with 15”
(*) Speed limiter type-approved for 161 km/h for complete/incomplete No Tempo Libero with 16”
(**) Speed limiter type-approved for 152 km/h for Tempo Libero
237
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
WEIGHTS AND
LOADS
To identify the weights and loads
for your vehicle, refer to the plate
shown in fig. 242 and described in the
“Vehicle identification number (VIN)
plate" chapter or refer to the vehicle
registration certificate showing the
type-approved weights (for markets,
where provided).
WARNING Do not exceed the indicated
trailer and towable weights.
WARNING Respect the vehicle towing
capacities.
The tables show the towable weight for
engine version.
242
F1A0245
(E) Maximum permitted weight of fully
laden vehicle (GVW).
(F) Maximum permitted weight of the
vehicle (GVW) fully laden plus trailer. If
there is no value in the field or if there
is a dash, it means that the vehicle
cannot tow
(G) Maximum permitted weight on first
axle (front).
(H) Maximum permitted weight on
second axle (rear).
238
To calculate the towable weight with
a braked trailer, take the difference
between values (F) and (E) shown on
the plate.
E.g.: F = 6000 kg - E = 3500 kg
Braked trailer = 2500 kg
TOWABLE WEIGHTS (kg)
Key:
A = TOWABLE WEIGHT
B = UNBRAKED TRAILER
C = LOAD ON TOW HOOK
VERSION (GVW)
A
B
C
2000
750
100
2500
750
100
2500
750
100
2500
750
100
2.3 160 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
2500
750
100
2.3 180 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
2500
750
100
3.0 140 Natural Power
2500
750
100
3000(*)
750
120(*)
3000
750
100
2500
750
100
4250
2250
750
100
3500
3000(*)
750
120(*)
3000
750
100
2500
750
100
2250
750
100
2800
3000/3300/3500/3650
3000/3300/3500/3510
LIGHT
3650 (T.L. Tempo Libero)
3000/3300/3500/3510/3650
3500
ENGINE
2.3 120 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
2.3 140 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
3500
3510
3995/4005/4400
MAXI
3510
3995/4005
4250
2.3 140 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
2.3 160 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
239
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
VERSION (GVW)
ENGINE
A
B
C
2.3 160 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
2100
750
100
3500
3000(*)
750
120(*)
3510
3000
750
100
2500
750
100
4250
2250
750
100
4400
2100
750
100
3500
3000
750
100
2500
750
100
2250
750
100
2250/2200(°)
750
100
4400
3995/4005
MAXI
2.3 180 HP Multijet with AdBlue®
3995/4005
3.0 140 Natural Power
3820
4250
(*) For Special T.L. 2500 Kg (towable weight = 100 Kg)
(°) Increased suspension
NOTE The following vehicles are excluded from the table:
Key:
A = TOWABLE WEIGHT
B = UNBRAKED TRAILER
C = LOAD ON TOW HOOK
ENGINE
ALL
240
BODYWORK VERSION
MINIBUS / BASE
MINIBUS
ALL
GVW
A
B
C
4005 / 4250 / 4300
–
–
–
ENGINE
BODYWORK VERSION
GVW
A
B
C
2.3 180 HP Multijet
with AdBlue® (*)
Heavy
4250/4300
2250 - 2200
750
–
(*) AT9 automatic transmission
NOTE For vehicles with tow hook: the vertical static load on the tow hook must be within the maximum permitted weight
declared for the vehicle.
MAX (Maximum permitted weight + TOWABLE WEIGHT) = 6500 kg
241
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
REFUELLING
2.3 120 HP -140 HP -160 HP -180 HP
Multijet with AdBlue ®
Fuel tank (litres):
75 (*)
Including a reserve of (litres):
10/12
UREA tank (where provided) approx. capacity
(litres):
19
Prescribed fuels and original lubricants
Automotive Diesel
(EN590 specifications)
AdBlue® (water-UREA solution) standard DIN
70 070 and ISO 22241-1
217) 218)
(*) A 90 litre tank is available on request for all versions (with reserve of 12 litres). With the "Tempo Libero" option a 60 litre tank is available on
request (with reserve of 9 litres).
WARNING
217) Use AdBlue® only according to DIN 70 070 and ISO 22241-1. Other fluids may cause damage to the system: also exhaust emissions
would no longer comply with the law.
218) The distribution companies are responsible for the compliance of their product. Observe the precautions of storage and servicing, in
order to preserve the initial qualities. The manufacturer of the vehicle does not recognise any guarantee in case of malfunctions and damage
caused to the vehicle due to the use urea (AdBlue®) not in accordance with regulations.
242
2.3 120 HP -140 HP -160 HP -180 HP
Multijet with AdBlue ®
Engine cooling system:
10 (**)
Engine sump (litres):
5.7
Engine sump and filter (litres):
6.3
Transmission/differential casing (litres):
2.7 (MLGU gearbox)
Transmission/differential casing (litres):
2.9 (M40 gearbox)
Prescribed fuels and original lubricants
50% mixture of distilled water and
PARAFLUUP (***)
SELENIA WR Forward 0W-30
TUTELA TRANSMISSION EXPERYA
TUTELA TRANSMISSION GEARTECH
Automatic transmission casing AT9 (litres):
6.0
TUTELA TRANSMISSION AS8
Hydraulic braking circuit with ABS (kg):
0.6
Hydraulic braking circuit with ASR/ESC (kg):
0.62
Hydraulic power steering:
1.5
TUTELA TRANSMISSION GI/E
Windscreen/headlight washer reservoir:
5.5
Mixture of water and liquid PETRONAS
DURANCE SC 35
TUTELA TOP 4/S
(**) With Webasto: + 1/4 litre - Underseat heating 600 cc: + 1 litre - Underseat heating 900cc: + 1.5 litres - Underseat heating + Webasto: +
1.25 litres - Underseat heating + Webasto: +1.75 litres
(***) When the vehicle is used in particularly harsh weather conditions, we recommend using a 60% mixture of PARAFLUUP and 40%
demineralised water.
243
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
3.0 140 Natural Power
Fuel tank (litres):
Including a reserve of (litres):
Engine cooling system:
Petrol: 14.5
Methane (kg): 36 (°) (°°)
Petrol: 8
10 (***)
Engine sump (litres):
8
Engine sump and filter (litres):
9
Prescribed fuels and original lubricants
Petrol with an octane number (RON) no lower
than 95 (EN228 specification)
Automotive methane and bio-methane
(EN16723 specification)
50% mixture of distilled water and
PARAFLUUP (****)
SELENIA MULTIPOWER GAS 5W-40
Gearbox/differential casing (litres):
2.9
TUTELA TRANSMISSION GEARTECH
Hydraulic braking circuit with ASR/ESC (kg):
0.62
TUTELA TOP 4/S
Hydraulic power steering:
1.5
TUTELA TRANSMISSION GI/E (red)
(°) Range on methane: 400 km
(°°) The amount of methane depends on the outside temperature, the supply pressure, the quality of the gas and the type of refuelling system.
The total volume of the cylinders is about 220 litres (218.5 nominal) for all versions
(***) With Webasto: + 1/4 litre - Underseat heating 600 cc: + 1 litre - Underseat heating 900 cc: + 1.5 litres - Underseat heating + Webasto: +
1.25 litres - Underseat heating + Webasto: +1.75 litres
(****) In particularly harsh weather conditions, we recommend using a 60% mixture of PARAFLUUP and 40% demineralised water
IMPORTANT It should be remembered that when using a fuel such as methane the range is very variable because it also depends on the
temperature of the gas in the cylinder, as well as on driving conditions and vehicle maintenance. The methane actually heats up during the
refuelling and cools down whilst driving, undergoing variations in pressure that reduce the quantity that can be used.
244
FLUIDS AND LUBRICANTS
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil that has been thoroughly developed and tested in order to meet the requirements
of the Scheduled Servicing Plan. Constant use of the prescribed lubricants guarantees the fuel consumption and emission
specifications. Lubricant quality is crucial for engine operation and duration.
69)
PRODUCT SPECIFICATIONS
Use
Diesel engine lubricants
Lubricants for
petrol/methane engines
Features
SAE 0W-30 ACEA C2
SAE 5W-40 ACEA C3
Specification
Original fluids and
lubricants
9.55535-DS1
SELENIA WR
FORWARD 0W-30
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F842.F13
According to Service
Schedule
9.55535-T2
SELENIA
MULTIPOWER GAS
5W-40
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F922.E09
According to Service
Schedule
Replacement interval
If lubricants conforming to the required specification are not available, products that meet the indicated specifications can be
used to top up; in this case optimal performance of the engine is not guaranteed.
245
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Use
Specification
Original fluids and
lubricants
9.55550-MZ2
TUTELA
TRANSMISSION
EXPERYA
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F002.F13
Mechanical transmission
and differential (MLGU
transmission)
9.55550-MZ3
TUTELA
TRANSMISSION
GEARTECH
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F704.C08
Manual gearbox and
differential
9.55550-AV5
TUTELA
TRANSMISSION AS8
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F139.I11
Lubricant for versions with
AT9 automatic gearbox
Molybdenum disulphide
grease, for use at
high temperatures.
Consistency NLGI 1-2
9.55580 - GRAS II
TUTELA ALL STAR
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F702.G07
Wheel side constant
velocity joints
Low friction coefficient
grease for constant
velocity joints.
Consistency NLGI 0-1
9.55580 - GRAS II
TUTELA STAR 700
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F701.C07
Differential side constant
velocity joints
9.55550-AG2
TUTELA
TRANSMISSION GI/E
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F001.C94
Hydraulic power steering
Features
SAE 75W grade synthetic
lubricant
Synthetic base lubricant
SAE 75W-85 grade
Lubricants and greases
for drive transmission
Synthetic lubricant
Lubricant for power
steering. Exceeds
"ATF DEXRON III"
specifications
246
Replacement interval
Use
Features
Brake fluid
Synthetic fluid for brake
and clutch systems.
Exceeds specifications:
FMVSS n° 116 DOT 4,
ISO 4925, SAE J 1704.
Protective agent for
radiators
Red protective with
antifreeze action, based
on inhibited monoethyl
glycol with organic
formula.
Exceeds CUNA NC
956-16, ASTM D 3306
specifications.
Diesel fuel additive
Additive for diesel
antifreeze, protecting
diesel engines.
AdBlue® (UREA) additive
for diesel emissions
Water-AdBlue® (UREA)
solution
Windscreen washer fluid
Mixture of spirits and
surfactants. Exceeds
the CUNA NC 956-II
specification
Specification
Original fluids and
lubricants
Replacement interval
MS.90039
TUTELA TOP 4/S
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F005.F15
Hydraulic brakes and
hydraulic clutch controls
9.55523 or MS.90032
PARAFLUUP
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F101.M01
Cooling circuits. Use rate
50% up to -35°C. Mixture
with different formulation
products not allowed. (*)
–
PETRONAS DURANCE
DIESEL ART
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F601.L06
To be mixed with diesel
(25 cc per 10 litres)
AdBlue ® (UREA)
To be used for filling the
AdBlue® (UREA) tank
on vehicles equipped
with Selective Catalytic
Reduction (SCR) system
PETRONAS DURANCE
SC 35
Contractual Technical
Reference N° F001.D16
To be used neat or dilute
in screen washer systems.
DIN 70 070 and ISO
22241-1
MS.90043
(*) When the vehicle is used in particularly harsh weather conditions, we recommend using a 60% mixture of PARAFLUUP and 40%
demineralised water.
247
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
248
IMPORTANT
69) The use of products with specifications other than those indicated above could cause damage to the engine not covered by the warranty.
FUEL CONSUMPTION AND CO2 EMISSIONS
The fuel consumption and CO2 emission figures declared by the manufacturer are determined on the basis of the type-approval
tests laid down by the applicable standards in the country where the vehicle is registered.
The type of route, traffic situations, weather conditions, driving style, general conditions of the vehicle, trim
level/equipment/accessories, climate control system, vehicle load, roof rack, other situations that affect aerodynamics or air
drag may lead to different fuel consumption levels than those measured. The fuel consumption will only become more regular
after driving the first 3000 km.
To find the specific fuel consumption and CO2 emission figures for this vehicle, please refer to the data in the Certificate of
Conformity, and the related documentation that accompanies the vehicle.
249
MULTIMEDIA
250
MULTIMEDIA
This chapter describes the main
functions of the Uconnect™ Radio,
Uconnect™ 5" Radio and Uconnect™
5" Radio Nav infotainment systems that
can be fitted on the vehicle.
RADIO ......................................
TIPS, CONTROLS AND
GENERAL INFORMATION ...........
Uconnect™ RADIO ....................
OPERATION ..............................
Uconnect™ 5" RADIO –
Uconnect™ 5" RADIO NAV .........
OPERATION ..............................
OFFICIAL TYPE APPROVALS ......
251
251
254
259
263
268
272
RADIO
TIPS, CONTROLS
AND GENERAL
INFORMATION
(for versions/markets, where provided)
For radio operation, consult the
Supplement attached to this Owner
Handbook.
SETUP
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The system consists of:
radio supply leads;
front speaker connection cables;
aerial supply lead;
2 tweeters (A) located in the front
doors (30W max power each) fig. 243;
2 mid-woofers (B) located in the front
doors (165 mm diameter, 40W max
power each) fig. 244;
2 full range located on the rear sides
(40W max. power each) (for Panorama
versions);
radio aerial lead;
aerial.
The radio must be installed in the
place occupied by the central storage
compartment, where you will find the
wiring.
219)
ROAD SAFETY
Learn how to use the various system
functions before setting off. Read the
instructions for the system carefully
before setting off.
243
F1A0139
220) 221)
RECEPTION
CONDITIONS
Reception conditions change
constantly while driving. Reception may
be interfered with by the presence
of mountains, buildings or bridges,
especially when you are far away from
the broadcaster.
244
F1A0140
WARNING
219) For connection to the existing
devices supplied in the vehicle contact
Fiat Dealership to prevent any trouble that
could impair vehicle safety.
WARNING The volume may be
increased when receiving traffic
information and news.
CARE AND
MAINTENANCE
Observe the following precautions to
ensure the system is fully operational:
the display lens should not come into
contact with pointed or rigid objects
which could damage its surface; use a
soft, dry anti-static cloth to clean and
do not press.
251
MULTIMEDIA
never use alcohol, petrols and
derivatives to clean the display lens.
Prevent any liquid from entering the
system: this could damage it beyond
repair.
70) 71)
ANTITHEFT PROTECTION
The system is equipped with an
anti-theft protection system based on
the exchange of information with the
electronic control unit (Body Computer)
on the vehicle.
This guarantees maximum safety and
prevents the secret code from being
entered after the power supply has
been disconnected.
If the check has a positive outcome,
the system will start to operate,
whereas if the comparison codes are
not the same or if the electronic control
unit (Body Computer) is replaced,
the system will ask the user to enter
the secret code according to the
procedure described in the paragraph
below.
Entering the secret code
When the system is switched on, if the
code is requested, the display will show
"Please enter Anti-Theft Code" followed
by the screen showing a keypad to
enter the secret code.
The secret code is made up of four
digits from 0 to 9.
252
Uconnect™ Radio:
The secret code is made up of four
digits, from 0 to 9: to insert the code,
turn the "BROWSE ENTER" right knob
and press to confirm.
Uconnect™ 5" Radio – Uconnect™
5" Radio NAV:
The secret code is made up of four
digits, from 1 to 9: to insert the
first number of the code press the
corresponding key on the display. Enter
the other code digits in the same way.
After inserting the fourth digit, move
the cursor to "OK" and press the
"BROWSE/ENTER" right knob: the
system will start to operate.
If an incorrect code is entered, the
system displays "Incorrect Code" to
notify the user of the need to enter the
correct code.
After the 3 available attempts to
enter the code, the system displays
"Incorrect Code. Radio locked. Wait
for 30 minutes". After the text has
disappeared it is possible to start the
code entering procedure again.
Vehicle radio passport
This document certifies ownership of
the system. The vehicle radio passport
shows the system model, serial
number and secret code.
In the case of loss of the radio
passport, contact the Fiat Dealership,
taking an ID document and the vehicle
ownership documents.
WARNING Keep the vehicle radio
passport in a safe place so that you
can give the information to the relevant
authorities if the system is stolen.
WARNINGS
Look at the screen only and when it
is necessary and safe. If you need to
look at the screen for a long time, pull
over to a safe place so as not to be
distracted while driving.
Immediately stop using the system
in the event of a fault. Otherwise the
system might be damaged.
Contact a Fiat Dealership as soon as
possible to have the system repaired.
WARNING
220) Follow the safety rules here below:
otherwise serious injuries may occur to
the occupants or the system may be
damaged.
221) If the volume is too loud this can
be dangerous. Adjust the volume so that
you can still hear background noises (e.g.
horns, ambulances, police vehicles, etc.).
IMPORTANT
70) Only clean the front panel and the
display lens with a soft, clean, dry,
anti-static cloth. Cleaning and polishing
products may damage the surface. Never
use alcohol, petrols and derivatives.
71) Do not use the display as a base for
supports with suction pads or adhesives
for external navigators or smartphones or
similar devices.
253
MULTIMEDIA
Uconnect™ RADIO
CONTROLS ON FRONT PANEL
245
254
F0N0890
FRONT CONTROL PANEL SUMMARY TABLE
Button
Functions
Mode
Ignition
Short button press
Switching off
Short button press
Volume adjustment
Turning the knob clockwise/anticlockwise
Volume activation/deactivation (Mute/Pause)
Short button press
Exit the selection/return to previous screen
Short button press
Scrolling the list or tuning to a radio station or
select previous/next track
Turning the knob clockwise/anticlockwise
Confirmation of the option displayed
Short button press
Confirmation of the option displayed
Display mode selection (Radio, Media Player)
PHONE
Access to the Phone mode
Short button press
MENU
Access to the Infotainment System/Settings menu
Short button press
MEDIA
USB source selection
Short button press
RADIO
Access to the Radio mode
Short button press
Store current radio station
Long button press
Stored radio station recall
Short button press
Selection of the group of radio presets or selection
of the desired letter in each list
Short button press
BROWSE ENTER
INFO
1-2-3-4-5-6
A-B-C
255
MULTIMEDIA
256
Button
Functions
Mode
Search for previous radio station or selection of
USB previous track
Short button press
Scan of lower frequencies until released/Fast
rewind of USB track
Long button press
Search for next radio station or selection of USB
next track
Short button press
Scan of higher frequencies until released/Fast
forward of USB track
Long button press
Shuffle of USB tracks
Short button press
USB loop
Short button press
CONTROLS ON THE STEERING WHEEL
(for versions/markets, where provided)
The controls for the main system functions are present on the steering wheel to make control easier.
The activation of the function selected is controlled, in some cases, by how long the button is pressed (short or long press) as
described in the table below.
246
F1A0348
STEERING WHEEL CONTROL SUMMARY TABLE
Button
Interaction (pressure/rotation)
Acceptance of incoming call
Acceptance of the second incoming call and putting the active call on hold
Rejection of incoming call
Ending of call in progress
Deactivation/reactivation of the microphone during a phone conversation
Activation/deactivation of the USB source Pause
Activation/deactivation of the radio source Mute function
257
MULTIMEDIA
258
Button
Interaction (pressure/rotation)
+/–
Turning left wheel upwards or downwards: audio volume adjustment
Short press: volume increase/decrease in single steps
Long press: volume continuous increase/decrease until released
Turning right wheel upwards or downwards:
Short press (Radio mode): selection of next/previous station
Long press (Radio mode): scan higher/lower frequencies until released
Short press (USB mode): selection of previous/next track
Long press (USB mode): fast forward/rewind until released
OPERATION
SWITCHING THE SYSTEM
ON/OFF
The system is switched on/off by
pressing the button/knob .
The electronic volume adjustment
control rotates continuously (360°) in
both directions, without stop positions.
Turn the button/knob clockwise
to increase the radio volume or
anticlockwise to decrease it.
RADIO (TUNER) MODE
The system is equipped with the
following tuners: AM, FM and DAB (for
versions/markets, where provided).
Radio mode selection
Press the RADIO button on the front
panel to activate radio mode.
Selecting a frequency band
The different tuning modes can be
selected by pressing the RADIO button
on the front panel.
Displayed information
After the desired radio station is
selected on the display, the following
information is shown (INFO mode
activated):
In the upper part: the preset station,
the time and the other active radio
settings are highlighted (e.g.: TA).
In the central part: the name of the
current station, the frequency and
the radio text information (if any) are
highlighted.
FM station list
Press the BROWSE ENTER
button/knob to display the complete list
of the FM stations that can be received.
The A-B-C button can be used,
depending on the chosen letter, to
jump alphabetically to the first of the
FM/DAB stations available for that
letter.
AM/FM radio station storage
(where provided)
The preset stations are available in all
system modes and are selected by
touching one of the presetting buttons
1-2-3-4-5-6 on the front panel.
If you are tuned to a radio station
that you wish to store, hold down
the button on the display which
corresponds to the desired preset
until an acoustic confirmation signal is
emitted.
The system can store up to 18 radio
stations in each mode.
AM/FM radio station selection
To search for the desired radio station
or
or use the
press buttons
wheel of the steering wheel controls
knob.
, or turn the "BROWSE/ENTER"
Previous/next radio station search
Press briefly the
or
button or
use the wheel of the steering wheel
controls
: when the button is
released the previous or next radio
station is displayed.
When searching forwards, if the system
reaches the end of the band, it will
automatically stop on the station where
the search has started from.
Previous/next radio station fast
search
or
button to
Hold down the
start the fast search: when the button
is released, the first tunable radio is
played.
DAB station list
Press the BROWSE ENTER
button/knob to display:
the list of all DAB stations;
the list of stations filtered by
"Genres";
the list of stations filtered by
"Ensembles" (broadcast group).
Within each list, the "ABC" button
allows the user to skip to the desired
letter in the list.
Radio station alphabetic selection
The A-B-C button on the front panel
can be used, depending on the chosen
259
MULTIMEDIA
letter, to jump alphabetically to the first
of the DAB stations available for that
letter.
MEDIA MODE
Interaction modes for USB operation.
Audio source selection
Press the MEDIA button to select the
USB audio source.
Change track (next/previous)
button or turn
Briefly press the
the BROWSE ENTER button/knob
clockwise to play the next track, or
briefly press the
button or turn
the BROWSE ENTER button/knob
anticlockwise to return to the beginning
of the selected track or to the
beginning of the previous track if the
current one has been played for less
than 3 seconds.
Fast forward/rewind through tracks
Press and hold down the
button to
fast forward the selected track or keep
the
button pressed to fast rewind
the track.
The fast forward/rewind will stop once
the
/
button is released or when
the previous/next track is reached.
Track selection (browse)
Use this function to scroll through and
select the tracks on the active device.
260
The choices available depend on the
device connected.
For example, on a USB device, you
can also use the BROWSE ENTER
button/knob to scroll through the list of
artists, genres and albums available
on the device, depending on the
information available in the tracks.
Within each alphabetical list, the A-BC button on the front panel allows the
user to skip to the desired letter in the
list.
NOTE This button might be disabled for
some Apple® devices.
Press the BROWSE ENTER button
to activate this function on the source
being played.
Turn the BROWSE ENTER button/knob
to select the desired category and then
press the button/knob to confirm the
selection.
button to cancel the
Press the
function.
NOTE The indexing time of a USB
device can vary according to the media
inserted (in some cases it can take a
few minutes).
Track information display
Press the INFO button to select the
information displayed while playing
(Artist, Album, Genre, Name, Folder,
File name).
Press the button to exit from the
screen.
Shuffle
Press the button to play the tracks
on USB in a random order.
The corresponding icon is displayed.
Press again to deactivate the function.
Repeat
Press the
button to activate this
function. The corresponding icon is
displayed.
Press again to deactivate the function.
USB SOURCE
To activate USB mode, connect the
corresponding USB device to the
vehicle USB port.
222)
If a USB device is connected to the
system on, this starts playing the tracks
present on the device.
NOTE The Uconnect™ system may
not support some USB keys: in this
case, it may not automatically switch
from "Radio” mode to "Media” mode.
If the device used does not play, verify
its compatibility by selecting Media
operation: a dedicated message will
appear on the Uconnect™ system
display.
WARNING After using a USB
recharging socket, we recommend
disconnecting the device (smartphone),
always removing the cable from the
vehicle socket first, never from the
device. Cables left flying or connected
incorrectly could compromise correct
recharging and/or the USB socket
condition.
NOTE The USB ports handle
data transmission from the Pen
Drive/Smartphone, etc. and slow
recharging of an external device, which
is not guaranteed as it depends on the
device type/brand.
PHONE MODE
Phone mode activation
Press the PHONE button on the front
panel to activate the Phone mode.
The available commands can be used
to:
dial the wished phone number;
display and call the contacts in the
mobile phone phonebook;
display and call contacts from the
registers of previous calls;
pair up to 8 phones to make access
and connection easier and quicker;
transfer calls from the system to
the mobile phone and vice versa and
deactivate the microphone audio for
private conversations.
The mobile phone audio is transmitted
through the audio system of the
vehicle; the system automatically mutes
the radio when the Phone function is
used.
Shown on display
When a phone is connected to the
system, the display shows various
information (if available):
status of roaming;
network signal intensity;
mobile phone battery charge;
mobile phone name.
Pairing a mobile phone
To pair the mobile phone, proceed as
follows:
activate the Bluetooth® function on
the mobile phone;
press the PHONE button on the
front panel;
if no phone is paired with the system
yet, the display shows a dedicated
screen;
select "Connect Phone" to start
the pairing procedure then search for
the Uconnect™ device on the mobile
phone (if "No" is selected, the Phone
main screen is displayed);
when prompted by the mobile
phone, use its keypad to enter the PIN
code shown on the system display or
confirm on the mobile phone the PIN
displayed;
from the "Settings" menu you
can always pair a mobile phone by
selecting "Phone menu/Add phone",
then proceed as described above;
during the pairing stage a screen is
displayed showing the progress of the
operation;
NOTE The priority for the automatic
reconnection is determined according
to the order of connection. The last
phone connected will have the highest
priority.
Making a phone call
The operations described below can
only be accessed if supported by the
mobile phone in use.
For all functions available, refer to the
mobile phone owner's handbook.
A call can be made by:
selecting "Contacts" (Phonebook
......);
selecting "Recent Calls list";
selecting "Keypad".
Dialling the phone number using
the "keypad" on the display
Enter the phone number using the
graphic keypad displayed. Proceed as
follows:
press the PHONE button on the front
panel;
select "Keypad" on the display and
use the right "BROWSE/ENTER" knob
to enter the number
261
MULTIMEDIA
select the icon to make the call.
Dialling the phone number using
the mobile phone
It is possible to dial a phone number
with the mobile phone and continue
using the system (never allow yourself
to be distracted while driving).
When a phone number is dialled with
the keypad of the mobile phone, the
audio of the call is played over your
vehicle's sound system.
WARNING
222) When connecting a USB device to
the USB port, make sure that it does not
obstruct the operation of the handbrake
lever.
262
Uconnect™ 5" RADIO – Uconnect™ 5" RADIO NAV
CONTROLS ON FRONT PANEL
247
F1A0478
263
MULTIMEDIA
FRONT CONTROL PANEL SUMMARY TABLE
Button
Functions
Mode
Ignition
Short button press
Switching off
Short button press
Volume adjustment
Left/right rotation of knob
2-
Volume activation/deactivation (Mute/Pause)
Short button press
3-
Display on/off
Short button press
4-
Settings
Short button press
5-
Exit the selection/return to previous screen
Short button press
Scrolling the list or tuning to a radio station
Left/right rotation of knob
Confirmation of the option displayed
Short button press
7- MORE
Access to the additional functions (display of Time, Trip
Computer, Outside temperature)
Short button press
8- PHONE
Phone data display
Short button press
TRIP
9- (Uconnect™ 5"
Radio)
Access to the Trip menu
Short button press
1-
6- BROWSE ENTER
264
Button
Functions
Mode
NAV
9- (Uconnect™ 5"
Radio Nav)
Access to the Navigation menu
Short button press
10-MEDIA
Support selection: USB, Bluetooth®
Short button press
11-RADIO
Access to the Radio mode
Short button press
265
MULTIMEDIA
CONTROLS ON THE STEERING WHEEL
The controls for the main system functions are present on the steering wheel to make control easier.
The activation of the function selected is controlled, in some cases, by how long the button is pressed (short or long press) as
described in the table below.
248
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS SUMMARY TABLE
Button
Interaction (pressure/rotation)
Acceptance of incoming call
Acceptance of the second incoming call and putting the active call on hold
Activation of voice recognition for Phone function
Interruption of the voice message in order to give a new voice command
Interruption of voice recognition
Rejection of incoming call
Ending of call in progress
deactivation/reactivation of the microphone during a phone conversation
activation/deactivation of the USB, Bluetooth® source Pause
activation/deactivation of radio Mute function
266
F0N0891
Button
Interaction (pressure/rotation)
+/–
Turning the left wheel upwards or downwards: adjust audio volume; hands-free; SMS message reader; voice
announcements and music sources
Short press: volume increase/decrease in single steps
Long press: volume continuous increase/decrease until released
Activation of voice recognition
Interruption of the voice message in order to give a new voice command
Interruption of voice recognition
Turning right wheel upwards or downwards:
Short press (Radio mode): selection of next/previous station
Long press (Radio mode): scan higher/lower frequencies until released
Short press (USB, Bluetooth®): selection of previous/next track
Long press (USB, Bluetooth®): fast forward/rewind until released
267
MULTIMEDIA
OPERATION
SWITCHING THE SYSTEM
ON/OFF
The system is switched on/off by
pressing the button/knob.
Turn the button/knob clockwise
to increase the radio volume or
anticlockwise to decrease it.
Radio (Tuner) mode
After the desired radio station is
selected, the following information is
shown on the display:
At the top: the list of radio stations
stored (preset) is displayed; the station
currently playing is highlighted.
In the middle: display of the name
of the current radio station and the
buttons for selecting the previous or
next radio station. At the bottom:
display of the following buttons:
"Browse": list of the radio stations
available;
"AM/FM", "AM/DAB", "FM/DAB":
selection of the desired frequency band
(button reconfigurable according to the
band selected: AM, FM or DAB);
“Tune": manual radio station tuning
(not available for DAB radio);
"Info": additional information on the
source being listened to;
“Audio”: access to the “Audio
Settings” screen.
268
Audio menu
To access the “Audio" menu, press the
button on the front panel, scroll
through the menu, then select and
press the “Audio" option on the display.
The following adjustments can be
carried out using the "Audio" menu:
"Equalizer" (for versions/markets,
where provided);
"Balance/Fade" (left/right and
front/rear audio balance adjustment);
"Volume/Speed" (excluding versions
with Hi-Fi system) speed-dependent
automatic volume adjustment;
"Loudness" (for versions/markets,
where provided);
"Auto-On Radio";
"Radio Off Delay".
To exit the "Audio" menu, press the
/Done button.
on the device, depending on the
information available in the tracks.
MEDIA MODE
Press the "Source" button to select
the desired audio source among those
available: USB or Bluetooth®.
Bluetooth® SOURCE
This mode is activated by pairing a
Bluetooth® device containing music
tracks with the system.
Track selection (browse)
Use this function to scroll through and
select the tracks on the active device.
The choices available depend on the
device connected.
For example, on a USB or Bluetooth®
device, you can scroll through the list of
artists, genres and albums available
PAIRING A Bluetooth® AUDIO
DEVICE
To pair a Bluetooth® audio device,
proceed as follows:
activate the Bluetooth® function on
the device;
press the MEDIA button on the front
panel;
WARNING A few Bluetooth® devices
do not offer the possibility of scrolling
tracks through all categories.
Within each list, the "ABC" button
allows the user to skip to the desired
letter in the list.
NOTE This button might be disabled for
some Apple® devices.
Press the "Browse" button to activate
this function on the source being
played.
Turn the BROWSE ENTER button/knob
to select the desired category and
then press the button/knob to confirm
the selection. Press the "X" button to
cancel the function.
if the "Media" source is active, press
the "Source" button;
select the Bluetooth® Media
source;
press the "Add Device" button;
search for Uconnect™ on the
Bluetooth® audio device (during the
pairing stage a screen is displayed
showing the progress of the operation);
when requested by the audio device,
enter the PIN code shown on the
system display or confirm on the device
the PIN displayed;
if the pairing procedure is completed
successfully, a screen is displayed.
Answer “Yes" to the question to pair
the Bluetooth® audio device as
favourite (the device will have priority
over all other devices to be paired
subsequently). If “No” is selected, the
priority is determined according to the
order of connection. The last device
connected will have the highest priority;
an audio device can also be
paired by pressing the
button
on the front panel and selecting
"Phone/Bluetooth®".
WARNING If the Bluetooth®
connection between mobile phone
and system is lost, consult the mobile
phone handbook.
USB SOURCE
To enable USB mode, insert an
appropriate USB device into the USB
port on the vehicle.
222)
If a USB device is inserted with the
system on, it will start playing the
tracks found on the device.
NOTE The Uconnect™ system may
not support some USB keys: in this
case, it may not automatically switch
from "Radio” mode to "Media” mode.
If the device used does not play, verify
its compatibility by selecting Media
operation: a dedicated message will
appear on the Uconnect™ system
display.
WARNING After using a USB
recharging socket, we recommend
disconnecting the device (smartphone),
always removing the cable from the
vehicle socket first, never from the
device. Cables left flying or connected
incorrectly could compromise correct
recharging and/or the USB socket
condition.
NOTE The USB ports handle
data transmission from the Pen
Drive/Smartphone, etc. and slow
recharging of an external device, which
is not guaranteed as it depends on the
device type/brand.
PHONE MODE
PHONE MODE ACTIVATION
Press the PHONE button on the front
panel to activate the Phone mode.
Use the buttons on the display to:
dial the phone number (using the
graphic keypad on the display);
display and call the contacts in the
mobile phone phonebook;
display and call contacts from the
registers of previous calls;
pair up to 10 phones/audio device
to make access and connection easier
and quicker;
transfer calls from the system to
the mobile phone and vice versa and
deactivate the microphone audio for
private conversations.
The mobile phone audio is transmitted
through the audio system of the
vehicle; the system automatically mutes
the radio when the Phone function is
used.
PAIRING A MOBILE PHONE
WARNING Carry out this operation only
with vehicle stationary and in safety
conditions; this function is deactivated
when the vehicle is moving.
The pairing procedure for a mobile
phone is described below: always
269
MULTIMEDIA
270
consult the handbook for the mobile
phone in any case.
To pair the mobile phone, proceed as
follows:
activate the Bluetooth® function on
the mobile phone;
press the PHONE button on the front
panel;
if no phone is paired with the system
yet, the display shows a dedicated
screen;
select “Yes" to start the pairing
procedure, then search for the
Uconnect™ device on the mobile
phone (if "No" is selected, the Phone
main screen is displayed);
when prompted by the mobile
phone, use its keypad to enter the PIN
code shown on the system display or
confirm on the mobile phone the PIN
displayed;
from the "Phone" screen you can
always pair a mobile phone by pressing
the "Settings" button: press the
"Add Device" button and proceed as
described above;
during the pairing stage a screen is
displayed showing the progress of the
operation;
when the pairing procedure is
completed successfully, a screen
is displayed: answer "Yes" to the
question to pair the mobile phone as
favourite (the mobile phone will have
priority over all other mobile phones
to be paired subsequently). If no other
devices are paired, the system will
consider the first associated device as
favourite.
NOTE The priority is determined
according to the order of connection
for mobile phones which are not set as
favourites. The last phone connected
will have the highest priority.
NOTE On some mobile phones, to
make the SMS voice reading function
available, the SMS notification option
on the phone must be enabled; this
option is usually available on the phone,
in the Bluetooth® connections menu
for a device registered as Uconnect™.
Making a phone call
The operations described below can
only be accessed if supported by the
mobile phone in use.
For all functions available, refer to the
mobile phone owner's handbook.
A call can be made by:
selecting the
icon (mobile phone
phonebook);
selecting "Recent Calls";
selecting the
icon;
pressing the "Redial" button.
Text message reader
The system can read the messages
received by the mobile phone.
To use this function the mobile phone
must support the SMS exchange
function through Bluetooth®.
If this function is not supported by the
phone, the corresponding graphic
button
is deactivated (greyed out).
When a text message is received, the
display will show a screen where the
options "Listen", "Call" or "Ignore" can
be selected.
button to access the
Press the
list of SMS messages received by
the mobile phone (the list displays a
maximum of 60 messages received).
SETTINGS
Press the
button on the front panel
to display the "Settings" main menu.
NOTE The menu items displayed vary
according to the versions.
The menu includes the following items:
Display;
Clock & Date;
Safety/Assistance (for
versions/markets, where provided);
Lights (for versions/markets where
provided);
Doors & Locks;
Audio;
Phone/Bluetooth;
Radio;
Restore Default Settings.
Safety/Assistance
(for versions/markets, where provided)
Rain sensor
The sensitivity of the rain sensor can
be adjusted with this function (for
versions/markets, where provided).
Lights
(for versions/markets, where provided)
This function can be used to carry out
the following adjustments:
Headlamp sensor
adjustment of the headlight activation
sensitivity;
"Automatic High Beam/High Beam
Control" (for versions/markets where
provided): activation/deactivation of
automatic main beam headlights.
"Daytime Running Lights" (DRL) (for
versions/markets, where provided):
activation/deactivation of daytime
running lights;
"Cornering lights" (for
versions/markets, where provided):
activation/deactivation of the cornering
lights; Doors and Door locks. This
function activates/deactivates
automatic door locking when the
vehicle is in motion ("Autoclose"
function).
"MORE" MODE
Press the MORE button on the front
panel to display the operating settings:
Outside temperature
Clock
Compass (only for Uconnect™ 5"
Radio Nav)
Trip Computer (only for Uconnect™
5" Radio Nav)
Settings (only for Uconnect™ 5"
Radio Nav)
NAVIGATION
224)
(Only for Uconnect™ 5" Radio Nav)
Planning a route
WARNING In the interest of safety and
to reduce distractions while you are
driving, you should always plan a route
before you start driving.
Using the destination search function,
it is possible to find and reach
your destinations in different ways:
searching for a specific address, a
partial address, a specific type of
location (for example a service station
or a restaurant), a postal code, a POI
(Point Of Interest) near your current
position (for example, a restaurant with
the search type set to "nearby"), a pair
of latitude and longitude coordinates,
or by selecting a point on the map.
Select “Search” in the Main menu
and set the search for a destination.
While entering the information, the list
displays the corresponding addresses
and POIs in two separate lists.
The corresponding address and city
are displayed in the Address list and
the POI, the type of POIs and the
locations are displayed in the Point of
Interest lists.
To plan a route towards the
destination, select the “Guide” button.
A route is planned and you are guided
to your destination, using spoken
instructions and on-screen directions.
VOICE
NOTE For languages not supported
by the system, voice controls are not
available.
To use the voice commands, press
button ("Voice" button) or
the
("Phone" button) on the steering wheel
and give the command you want to
activate, out loud.
Global
The following voice commands can be
given after pressing the button on the
steering wheel
:
Help
Cancel
Repeat
Voice Prompts
271
MULTIMEDIA
Phone
The following voice commands can be
given after pressing the button on the
:
steering wheel
Call
Dial
Redial
Call back
Recent calls
Outgoing calls
Missed calls
Incoming calls
PhoneBook
Search
Show SMS
Send an SMS
Show messages
Radio
The following voice commands can be
given after pressing the button on the
steering wheel
:
Tune to FM "frequency"
Tune to AM "frequency"
Tune to "radio name" FM
Tune to "radio name"
Media
The following voice commands can be
given after pressing the button on the
steering wheel
:
Play song...
Play album…
272
Play artist…
Play genre…
Play playlist…
Play podcast…
Play audiobook…
Play the track number...
Select the source...
View...
Navigation
(only for Uconnect™ 5" Nav)
The following voice commands can be
given after pressing the button on the
steering wheel
:
Drive Home
2D vision
3D vision
Clear route
Add Favourite
Repeat instruction
WARNING
223) When connecting a USB device to
the USB port, make sure that it does not
obstruct the operation of the handbrake
lever.
224) In the interest of safety and to reduce
distractions while you are driving, you
should always plan a route before you start
driving.
OFFICIAL TYPE
APPROVALS
Radio devices
All radio equipment supplied with the
vehicle complies with the 2014/53/EU
directive.
For further information visit
the www.mopar.eu/owner or
http://aftersales.fiat.com/elum/
websites.
Radio frequency
devices
All radio frequency devices comply with
the regulations in force in the countries
in which they are sold.
For further information go
to www.mopar.eu/owner or
http://aftersales.fiat.com/elum.
IMPORTANT
LUGGAGE CARRIER
Follow the instructions contained in the assembly kit carefully. Assembly must be performed by qualified personnel.
After travelling for a few kilometres, check to ensure that the fixing screws for the attachments are well tightened. Distribute the load
evenly and pay attention to side winds when driving.
Fully comply with the regulations in force concerning maximum clearance. Never exceed the maximum permitted loads (see chapter
"Technical specifications").
ACCESSORIES PURCHASED BY THE OWNER
Take care when fitting additional spoilers, alloy wheels or non-standard wheel hubs: they could reduce the ventilation of the brakes and
affect efficiency under sharp, repeated braking or on long descents. Make sure that nothing obstructs the pedal stroke (mats, etc.).
PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT
The Diesel particulate filter (DPF) reaches high temperatures during normal operation. Do not park the vehicle on flammable material
(grass, dry leaves, pine needles etc.): fire hazard.
RIM PROTECTOR TYRES
DO NOT fit wheel hub caps when using integral hub caps fixed (with springs) to the steel rim and after sale tyres provided with a Rim
Protector. Use of unsuitable tyres and wheel caps may cause sudden decrease of tyre pressure.
INTERIOR FITTINGS
Never place potentially dangerous items in the open compartment on the dashboard; in the event of a collision may be flung into the
passenger compartment and injure the occupants.
273
Oil change? The experts recommend PETRONAS Selenia
The engine of your car is factory filled with PETRONAS Selenia. This is an engine oil range which
satisfies the most advanced international specifications. Its superior technical characteristics allow
PETRONAS Selenia to guarantee the highest performance and protection of your engine.
The PETRONAS Selenia range includes a number of technologically advanced products:
PETRONAS Selenia K Power
Fully synthetic lubricant developed for American design
petrol engines.
PETRONAS Selenia Multipower Gas
Fully synthetic lubricant for petrol engines supplied with methane
or LPG. Protection against valve wear.
PETRONAS Selenia WR Forward
Fully synthetic Low SAPS lubricant for Euro 6 diesel
engines. High fuel economy.
PETRONAS Selenia Multipower C3
Synthetic lubricant for petrol and diesel engines. Fuel economy
characteristics.
PETRONAS Selenia Digitek Pure Energy
Fully synthetic lubricant for petrol engines. High fuel
economy characteristics.
The range also includes Selenia K, Selenia 20K, Selenia Turbo Diesel, Selenia Sport,
Selenia Sport Power, Selenia Racing, Selenia WR, Selenia WR Pure Energy.
For further information on PETRONAS Selenia products visit the web site www.pli-petronas.com
MAINTAIN YOUR VEHICLE IN
TIP TOP CONDITIONS WITH
Mopar Vehicle Protection offers a series of service contracts that are designed to give all our customers the
pleasure of driving their vehicle without any hitch's and concerns.
Our product portfolio consists of a wide and flexible range of extended warranty and maintenance plans
endorsed by FCA. Each with a series of different coverage tiers, in terms of durability and mileage, built to
accommodate you’re driving needs.
Service contracts are made by experts that know every part of your vehicle, and commit themselves
to maintain it in tip top conditions. Our knowledge and passion is tailored around designing
products that promises all our drivers “worry-free driving”.
Only with Mopar Vehicle Protection you are ensured that all service operations are performed
by highly qualified and specialized technicians in authorized FCA repair facilities, using the right tools,
equipment and only original parts, all over Europe.
Check which Service Contract plans are available on your market today and choose the
Service Contract that suits your driving habits best.
Ask your local dealer for further information.
NOTES
CONTENTS
4-Seater bench seat (Crew Cab Van
versions) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
A BS
...................
ABS (system) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Additional heater . . . . . . . . . . .
Additional rear climate control
(Panorama/Combi) . . . . . . . .
Additional rear heating
(Panorama/Combi) . . . . . . . .
Additive for diesel emissions
AdBlue (UREA) . . . . . . . . . .
Advice for extending battery
life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Air filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Air suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ASR (system) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ASR system . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic climate control
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic headlight sensor . . . .
Automatic main beam
headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic transmission . . . . . . .
Automatic transmission gear lever
release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . 79
. . 79
. . 38
. . 38
. . 38
. 141
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Battery
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery (disconnector) . . . . . . . . .
Battery (recharging) . . . . . . . . . .
Battery disconnector . . . . . . . . .
Battery replacement . . . . . . . . . .
Bodywork
Advice for preserving the
bodywork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Protection from atmospheric
agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bodywork paint identification
plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bodywork version . . . . . . . . . . .
Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BSA (system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BSA system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
184 Compatibility of vehicle seats with
Isofix child seats . . . . . . . . .
. 30
Conditions
of use . . . . . . . . . . .
205
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . .
209 Cylinder marking . . . . . . . . . . .
209
213
215
. 42
199
. 84
. 84
183
205
204
. 46
. 80 Cargo Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
. 80 Carrying children safely
Arrangement possibilities for child
. 37
restraint systems . . . . . . . . . . . 97
. 25
Child restraint systems . . . . . . . 97
Safety regulations . . . . . . . . . . 97
. 25 Ceiling lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
122 Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Chassis marking . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
186
Checking levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
CO2 emissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
205 Compartment beneath passenger
. 30
side front seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
.
.
.
.
.
101
137
. 30
126
213
D aytime running lights
. . . . . . . . . 25
Dead Lock device . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Demanding vehicle use . . . . . . . . 191
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Dipped beam headlights . . . . . . . . 25
Direction indicators . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Display
Standard screen . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Door locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Double rear swing door . . . . . . . . . 11
Drive Mode function . . . . . . . . . . 125
Driving assistance systems . . . . . . 84
Driving style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
E lectric windows
.
Electronic alarm . .
Emergency starting
Engine . . . . . . . .
Engine codes . . .
Engine coolant . .
Engine Idle Preset
Engine marking . .
...
...
..
...
...
...
...
...
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 42
. 10
183
217
215
199
128
213
CONTENTS
Engine oil . . . . . . . .
Engine oil level gauge
ESC (system) . . . . .
Exterior lights . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Fiat Code system
...........
Flap on bench . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flashing the headlights . . . . . . . .
Flex Floor rear seat . . . . . . . . . . .
Fluids and lubricants . . . . . . . . . .
Fog lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Follow Me Home device . . . . . . .
Front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front airbag driver's side . . . . .
Manually deactivating the front
airbag and side bag . . . . . . . .
Passenger's front airbag . . . . .
Front light clusters . . . . . . . . . . .
Front roof light (changing a
bulb) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel cut-off switch . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel tank cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Full Brake Control system . . . . . .
Fuses (replacement) . . . . . . . . . .
Gateway FMS module
Gear Shift Indicator
........
..........
Hazard warning lights
........
199 HBA (Hydraulic Brake Assist)
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
. 53
HBA
(system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
. 80
Head
restraints
. 25
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
.. 8
Headlight alignment corrector . . . . 29
. 16
Headlight washers . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
. 25
Headlights
. 16
Headlight alignment
245
corrector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
. 30
Light beam alignment . . . . . . . . 29
. 25
Heated rear window . . . . . . . . . . . 30
110
Heating and ventilation . . . . . . . . . 35
110
Heating and ventilation
controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
110
Hill Descent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
110
Hill Descent Control System . . . . . 80
155
Hill Holder (system) . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Hill Holder system . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
160
249 I dentification data . . . . . . . . . . . 213
185 Ignition device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
137 Independent additional heater . . . . 38
133 Inflation pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
161 Inflation procedure . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
172
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
. 53
Interior fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
. 30
Isofix child restraint systems (setup)
Arrangement possibilities for
child restraint system on seats of
vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
J ump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K ey release automatic
183
transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
L ane Departure Warning (Driving
Advisor) (system) . . . . . . . . . .
Lifting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . .
Light beam alignment . . . . . . . . .
Light bulbs
types of bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lights off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Loading advice . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. 89
207
. 29
M ain beam headlights
. 25
........
Maintenance and care - Regular
checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance and care - Scheduled
Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance and care - Service
Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Manual climate control system . . .
Manually deactivating the front
airbag and side bag . . . . . . . .
Moving footboard . . . . . . . . . . .
MSR (system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
MSR system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
152
. 25
143
191
191
193
. 36
110
. 11
. 79
. 79
Multifunction display
Refuelling the vehicle . . . . . . . . .
Control buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Replacing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Replacing an exterior bulb . . . . . .
Dipped beam headlights . . . . .
Nozzles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Direction indicators . . . . . . . .
Number plate lights . . . . . . . . . . 155
Fog lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Occupant protection systems . . . . 94
Main beam headlights . . . . . . .
On-board instruments . . . . . . . . . . 49
Side/tail lights . . . . . . . . . . . .
Open storage compartment . . . . . . 44
Replacing interior bulbs . . . . . . . .
Parking lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Replacing the windscreen wiper
blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Revolving seat with seat belts . . .
Pollen filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Rims and tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Rubber hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
137
152
155
155
155
155
155
155
160
Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Snow tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Speed block . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Speed Limiter . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sprung seat . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Start&Stop system . . . . . . . . .
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . .
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . .
206 Supplementary restraint system
. 16
(SRS) - AIRBAG . . . . . . . . .
220 System inspection . . . . . . . . .
211 T ablet holder . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . 199 Saving fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Pre-tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 SBR system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Prolonged vehicle inactivity . . . . . 150 Seat base plastic covers . . . . . . . . 16
Seat belts
Quick repair kit
Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Fix&Go Automatic tyres . . . . . . 181
Seat with revolving base . . . . . . . . 16
R adio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Rain sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Seats (Combi versions) . . . . . . . . . 16
Rear ceiling light (changing a
bulb) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Seats (Panorama version) . . . . . . . 16
Rear fog lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Seats with adjustable armrests . . . . 16
Rear footboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Setup for Isofix child restraint
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Rear view camera . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Side bags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Rear-view mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Side lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25, 155
Refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Sliding door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
209
208
220
129
126
. 16
125
118
219
. 23
. . 110
. . 213
. . . 44
Tachograph . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Third brake lights . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Tips, controls and general
information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Towing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Towing trailers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
TPMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Traction Plus system . . . . . . . . . . 83
Traffic Sign Recognition
(system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Tray under the seat . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Trip computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
CONTENTS
Uconnect 5" Radio – Uconnect 5"
Radio Nav . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Uconnect Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Version with methane system
(Natural Power) . . . . . . . . . . . 142
VIN plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Warning lights and messages
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . 56
. . 238
. . 220
. . 220
. . 207
. . . 33
33, 206
Weights and loads . . . . . . . .
Wheel geometry . . . . . . . . .
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wheels and tyres . . . . . . . . .
Window washing . . . . . . . . .
Windscreen wiper . . . . . . . .
Windscreen/rear window washer
fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
FCA Italy S.p.A. - MOPAR - Technical Service Operations - Service Engineering
Largo Senatore G. Agnelli, 3 - 10040 Volvera - Torino (Italy)
Print no. 603.85.089 - 12/2019 - 1st Edition
WHY CHOOSING
GENUINE PARTS
We really know your vehicle because we invented,
designed and built it: we really know every single detail. At Fiat Professional Service authorised workshops
you can find technicians directly trained by us, offering quality and professionalism for all service operations.
Fiat Professional workshops are always close to you for the regular servicing operations, season checks and practical
recommendations by our experts.
With Fiat Professional Genuine Parts you keep the reliability, comfort and performance features of your
new vehicle unchanged in time: that's why you bought it for.
Always ask for Genuine Parts for the components used on our vehicles; we recommend them because they come from
our steady commitment in research and development of highly innovative technologies.
For all these reasons: rely on Genuine Parts,
because they are the only ones designed by Fiat Professional for your vehicle.
SAFETY: BRAKING
SYSTEM
ENVIRONMENT: PARTICULATE FILTERS,
CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
COMFORT:
SUSPENSION AND WINDSCREEN WIPERS
PERFORMANCE:
SPARK PLUGS, INJECTORS AND
BATTERIES
LINEACCESSORI:
ROOF RACK BARS, WHEEL RIMS
ENGLISH
The data contained in this publication is intended merely as a guide. FCA Italy S.p.A. reserves the right to modify
the models and versions described in this booklet at any time for technical and commercial reasons.
If you have any further questions please consult your FIAT dealer.
Printed in recycled paper without chlorine.